3 @setfilename coreutils.info
4 @settitle GNU Coreutils
5 @documentencoding UTF-8
11 @include constants.texi
13 @c Define new indices.
17 @c Put everything in one index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index).
27 * Coreutils: (coreutils). Core GNU (file, text, shell) utilities.
28 * Common options: (coreutils)Common options.
29 * File permissions: (coreutils)File permissions. Access modes.
30 * Date input formats: (coreutils)Date input formats.
33 @c FIXME: the following need documentation
34 @c * [: (coreutils)[ invocation. File/string tests.
35 @c * pinky: (coreutils)pinky invocation. FIXME.
37 @dircategory Individual utilities
39 * arch: (coreutils)arch invocation. Print machine hardware name.
40 * base32: (coreutils)base32 invocation. Base32 encode/decode data.
41 * base64: (coreutils)base64 invocation. Base64 encode/decode data.
42 * basename: (coreutils)basename invocation. Strip directory and suffix.
43 * cat: (coreutils)cat invocation. Concatenate and write files.
44 * chcon: (coreutils)chcon invocation. Change SELinux CTX of files.
45 * chgrp: (coreutils)chgrp invocation. Change file groups.
46 * chmod: (coreutils)chmod invocation. Change access permissions.
47 * chown: (coreutils)chown invocation. Change file owners and groups.
48 * chroot: (coreutils)chroot invocation. Specify the root directory.
49 * cksum: (coreutils)cksum invocation. Print POSIX CRC checksum.
50 * comm: (coreutils)comm invocation. Compare sorted files by line.
51 * coreutils: (coreutils)Multi-call invocation. Multi-call program.
52 * cp: (coreutils)cp invocation. Copy files.
53 * csplit: (coreutils)csplit invocation. Split by context.
54 * cut: (coreutils)cut invocation. Print selected parts of lines.
55 * date: (coreutils)date invocation. Print/set system date and time.
56 * dd: (coreutils)dd invocation. Copy and convert a file.
57 * df: (coreutils)df invocation. Report file system disk usage.
58 * dir: (coreutils)dir invocation. List directories briefly.
59 * dircolors: (coreutils)dircolors invocation. Color setup for ls.
60 * dirname: (coreutils)dirname invocation. Strip last file name component.
61 * du: (coreutils)du invocation. Report on disk usage.
62 * echo: (coreutils)echo invocation. Print a line of text.
63 * env: (coreutils)env invocation. Modify the environment.
64 * expand: (coreutils)expand invocation. Convert tabs to spaces.
65 * expr: (coreutils)expr invocation. Evaluate expressions.
66 * factor: (coreutils)factor invocation. Print prime factors
67 * false: (coreutils)false invocation. Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
68 * fmt: (coreutils)fmt invocation. Reformat paragraph text.
69 * fold: (coreutils)fold invocation. Wrap long input lines.
70 * groups: (coreutils)groups invocation. Print group names a user is in.
71 * head: (coreutils)head invocation. Output the first part of files.
72 * hostid: (coreutils)hostid invocation. Print numeric host identifier.
73 * hostname: (coreutils)hostname invocation. Print or set system name.
74 * id: (coreutils)id invocation. Print user identity.
75 * install: (coreutils)install invocation. Copy files and set attributes.
76 * join: (coreutils)join invocation. Join lines on a common field.
77 * kill: (coreutils)kill invocation. Send a signal to processes.
78 * link: (coreutils)link invocation. Make hard links between files.
79 * ln: (coreutils)ln invocation. Make links between files.
80 * logname: (coreutils)logname invocation. Print current login name.
81 * ls: (coreutils)ls invocation. List directory contents.
82 * md5sum: (coreutils)md5sum invocation. Print or check MD5 digests.
83 * mkdir: (coreutils)mkdir invocation. Create directories.
84 * mkfifo: (coreutils)mkfifo invocation. Create FIFOs (named pipes).
85 * mknod: (coreutils)mknod invocation. Create special files.
86 * mktemp: (coreutils)mktemp invocation. Create temporary files.
87 * mv: (coreutils)mv invocation. Rename files.
88 * nice: (coreutils)nice invocation. Modify niceness.
89 * nl: (coreutils)nl invocation. Number lines and write files.
90 * nohup: (coreutils)nohup invocation. Immunize to hangups.
91 * nproc: (coreutils)nproc invocation. Print the number of processors.
92 * numfmt: (coreutils)numfmt invocation. Reformat numbers.
93 * od: (coreutils)od invocation. Dump files in octal, etc.
94 * paste: (coreutils)paste invocation. Merge lines of files.
95 * pathchk: (coreutils)pathchk invocation. Check file name portability.
96 * pr: (coreutils)pr invocation. Paginate or columnate files.
97 * printenv: (coreutils)printenv invocation. Print environment variables.
98 * printf: (coreutils)printf invocation. Format and print data.
99 * ptx: (coreutils)ptx invocation. Produce permuted indexes.
100 * pwd: (coreutils)pwd invocation. Print working directory.
101 * readlink: (coreutils)readlink invocation. Print referent of a symlink.
102 * realpath: (coreutils)realpath invocation. Print resolved file names.
103 * rm: (coreutils)rm invocation. Remove files.
104 * rmdir: (coreutils)rmdir invocation. Remove empty directories.
105 * runcon: (coreutils)runcon invocation. Run in specified SELinux CTX.
106 * seq: (coreutils)seq invocation. Print numeric sequences
107 * sha1sum: (coreutils)sha1sum invocation. Print or check SHA-1 digests.
108 * sha2: (coreutils)sha2 utilities. Print or check SHA-2 digests.
109 * shred: (coreutils)shred invocation. Remove files more securely.
110 * shuf: (coreutils)shuf invocation. Shuffling text files.
111 * sleep: (coreutils)sleep invocation. Delay for a specified time.
112 * sort: (coreutils)sort invocation. Sort text files.
113 * split: (coreutils)split invocation. Split into pieces.
114 * stat: (coreutils)stat invocation. Report file(system) status.
115 * stdbuf: (coreutils)stdbuf invocation. Modify stdio buffering.
116 * stty: (coreutils)stty invocation. Print/change terminal settings.
117 * sum: (coreutils)sum invocation. Print traditional checksum.
118 * sync: (coreutils)sync invocation. Synchronize memory to disk.
119 * tac: (coreutils)tac invocation. Reverse files.
120 * tail: (coreutils)tail invocation. Output the last part of files.
121 * tee: (coreutils)tee invocation. Redirect to multiple files.
122 * test: (coreutils)test invocation. File/string tests.
123 * timeout: (coreutils)timeout invocation. Run with time limit.
124 * touch: (coreutils)touch invocation. Change file timestamps.
125 * tr: (coreutils)tr invocation. Translate characters.
126 * true: (coreutils)true invocation. Do nothing, successfully.
127 * truncate: (coreutils)truncate invocation. Shrink/extend size of a file.
128 * tsort: (coreutils)tsort invocation. Topological sort.
129 * tty: (coreutils)tty invocation. Print terminal name.
130 * uname: (coreutils)uname invocation. Print system information.
131 * unexpand: (coreutils)unexpand invocation. Convert spaces to tabs.
132 * uniq: (coreutils)uniq invocation. Uniquify files.
133 * unlink: (coreutils)unlink invocation. Removal via unlink(2).
134 * uptime: (coreutils)uptime invocation. Print uptime and load.
135 * users: (coreutils)users invocation. Print current user names.
136 * vdir: (coreutils)vdir invocation. List directories verbosely.
137 * wc: (coreutils)wc invocation. Line, word, and byte counts.
138 * who: (coreutils)who invocation. Print who is logged in.
139 * whoami: (coreutils)whoami invocation. Print effective user ID.
140 * yes: (coreutils)yes invocation. Print a string indefinitely.
144 This manual documents version @value{VERSION} of the GNU core
145 utilities, including the standard programs for text and file manipulation.
147 Copyright @copyright{} 1994-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
150 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
151 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
152 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
153 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
154 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
155 Free Documentation License''.
160 @title GNU @code{Coreutils}
161 @subtitle Core GNU utilities
162 @subtitle for version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}
163 @author David MacKenzie et al.
166 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
179 @cindex core utilities
180 @cindex text utilities
181 @cindex shell utilities
182 @cindex file utilities
185 * Introduction:: Caveats, overview, and authors
186 * Common options:: Common options
187 * Output of entire files:: cat tac nl od base32 base64
188 * Formatting file contents:: fmt pr fold
189 * Output of parts of files:: head tail split csplit
190 * Summarizing files:: wc sum cksum md5sum sha1sum sha2
191 * Operating on sorted files:: sort shuf uniq comm ptx tsort
192 * Operating on fields:: cut paste join
193 * Operating on characters:: tr expand unexpand
194 * Directory listing:: ls dir vdir dircolors
195 * Basic operations:: cp dd install mv rm shred
196 * Special file types:: mkdir rmdir unlink mkfifo mknod ln link readlink
197 * Changing file attributes:: chgrp chmod chown touch
198 * Disk usage:: df du stat sync truncate
199 * Printing text:: echo printf yes
200 * Conditions:: false true test expr
202 * File name manipulation:: dirname basename pathchk mktemp realpath
203 * Working context:: pwd stty printenv tty
204 * User information:: id logname whoami groups users who
205 * System context:: date arch nproc uname hostname hostid uptime
206 * SELinux context:: chcon runcon
207 * Modified command invocation:: chroot env nice nohup stdbuf timeout
208 * Process control:: kill
210 * Numeric operations:: factor numfmt seq
211 * File permissions:: Access modes
212 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
213 * Opening the software toolbox:: The software tools philosophy
214 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
215 * Concept index:: General index
218 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
222 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure
223 * Backup options:: Backup options
224 * Block size:: Block size
225 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation
226 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals
227 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp, chown, chroot, id: user and group syntax
228 * Random sources:: Sources of random data
229 * Target directory:: Target directory
230 * Trailing slashes:: Trailing slashes
231 * Traversing symlinks:: Traversing symlinks to directories
232 * Treating / specially:: Treating / specially
233 * Standards conformance:: Standards conformance
234 * Multi-call invocation:: Multi-call program invocation
236 Output of entire files
238 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files
239 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse
240 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files
241 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats
242 * base32 invocation:: Transform data into printable data
243 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data
245 Formatting file contents
247 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text
248 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing
249 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
251 Output of parts of files
253 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files
254 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files
255 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces
256 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces
260 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts
261 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts
262 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
263 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests
264 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests
265 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests
267 Operating on sorted files
269 * sort invocation:: Sort text files
270 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files
271 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files
272 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line
273 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents
274 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort
276 @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
278 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior
279 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations
280 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection
281 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields
282 * Compatibility in ptx:: The GNU extensions to @command{ptx}
286 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines
287 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files
288 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field
290 Operating on characters
292 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
293 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces
294 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs
296 @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
298 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters
299 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another
300 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting
304 * ls invocation:: List directory contents
305 * dir invocation:: Briefly list directory contents
306 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely list directory contents
307 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for @command{ls}
309 @command{ls}: List directory contents
311 * Which files are listed:: Which files are listed
312 * What information is listed:: What information is listed
313 * Sorting the output:: Sorting the output
314 * Details about version sort:: More details about version sort
315 * General output formatting:: General output formatting
316 * Formatting the file names:: Formatting the file names
320 * cp invocation:: Copy files and directories
321 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file
322 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes
323 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files
324 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories
325 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely
329 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
330 * ln invocation:: Make links between files
331 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories
332 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
333 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files
334 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
335 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories
336 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via unlink syscall
338 Changing file attributes
340 * chown invocation:: Change file owner and group
341 * chgrp invocation:: Change group ownership
342 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions
343 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps
347 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage
348 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage
349 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status
350 * sync invocation:: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
351 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file
355 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text
356 * printf invocation:: Format and print data
357 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted
361 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
362 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully
363 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values
364 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions
366 @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
368 * File type tests:: File type tests
369 * Access permission tests:: Access permission tests
370 * File characteristic tests:: File characteristic tests
371 * String tests:: String tests
372 * Numeric tests:: Numeric tests
374 @command{expr}: Evaluate expression
376 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
377 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
378 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
379 * Examples of expr:: Examples of using @command{expr}
383 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
385 File name manipulation
387 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
388 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component
389 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability
390 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory
391 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names
395 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory
396 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics
397 * printenv invocation:: Print all or some environment variables
398 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input
400 @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
402 * Control:: Control settings
403 * Input:: Input settings
404 * Output:: Output settings
405 * Local:: Local settings
406 * Combination:: Combination settings
407 * Characters:: Special characters
408 * Special:: Special settings
412 * id invocation:: Print user identity
413 * logname invocation:: Print current login name
414 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID
415 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in
416 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in
417 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in
421 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name
422 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time
423 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors
424 * uname invocation:: Print system information
425 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name
426 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier
427 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load
429 @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
431 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
432 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
433 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
434 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
435 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock
436 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time
437 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
438 * Examples of date:: Examples
442 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
443 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
445 Modified command invocation
447 * chroot invocation:: Run a command with a different root directory
448 * env invocation:: Run a command in a modified environment
449 * nice invocation:: Run a command with modified niceness
450 * nohup invocation:: Run a command immune to hangups
451 * stdbuf invocation:: Run a command with modified I/O buffering
452 * timeout invocation:: Run a command with a time limit
456 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
460 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time
464 * factor invocation:: Print prime factors
465 * numfmt invocation:: Reformat numbers
466 * seq invocation:: Print numeric sequences
470 * Mode Structure:: Structure of file mode bits
471 * Symbolic Modes:: Mnemonic representation of file mode bits
472 * Numeric Modes:: File mode bits as octal numbers
473 * Directory Setuid and Setgid:: Set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories
477 * General date syntax:: Common rules
478 * Calendar date items:: 19 Dec 1994
479 * Time of day items:: 9:20pm
480 * Time zone items:: EST, PDT, UTC, @dots{}
481 * Combined date and time of day items:: 1972-09-24T20:02:00,000000-0500
482 * Day of week items:: Monday and others
483 * Relative items in date strings:: next tuesday, 2 years ago
484 * Pure numbers in date strings:: 19931219, 1440
485 * Seconds since the Epoch:: @@1078100502
486 * Specifying time zone rules:: TZ="America/New_York", TZ="UTC0"
487 * Authors of parse_datetime:: Bellovin, Eggert, Salz, Berets, et al.
489 Opening the software toolbox
491 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
492 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
493 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
494 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
495 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
496 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
497 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
501 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
508 @chapter Introduction
510 This manual is a work in progress: many sections make no attempt to explain
511 basic concepts in a way suitable for novices. Thus, if you are interested,
512 please get involved in improving this manual. The entire GNU community
516 The GNU utilities documented here are mostly compatible with the
518 @cindex bugs, reporting
519 Please report bugs to @email{bug-coreutils@@gnu.org}. Remember
520 to include the version number, machine architecture, input files, and
521 any other information needed to reproduce the bug: your input, what you
522 expected, what you got, and why it is wrong. Diffs are welcome, but
523 please include a description of the problem as well, since this is
524 sometimes difficult to infer. @xref{Bugs, , , gcc, Using and Porting GNU CC}.
530 @cindex MacKenzie, D.
533 This manual was originally derived from the Unix man pages in the
534 distributions, which were written by David MacKenzie and updated by Jim
535 Meyering. What you are reading now is the authoritative documentation
536 for these utilities; the man pages are no longer being maintained. The
537 original @command{fmt} man page was written by Ross Paterson. Fran@,{c}ois
538 Pinard did the initial conversion to Texinfo format. Karl Berry did the
539 indexing, some reorganization, and editing of the results. Brian
540 Youmans of the Free Software Foundation office staff combined the
541 manuals for textutils, fileutils, and sh-utils to produce the present
542 omnibus manual. Richard Stallman contributed his usual invaluable
543 insights to the overall process.
546 @chapter Common options
550 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
553 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
554 @cindex backups, making
555 @xref{Backup options}.
556 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
559 @macro optBackupSuffix
560 @item -S @var{suffix}
561 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
564 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}.
565 @xref{Backup options}.
568 @macro optTargetDirectory
569 @item -t @var{directory}
570 @itemx --target-directory=@var{directory}
572 @opindex --target-directory
573 @cindex target directory
574 @cindex destination directory
575 Specify the destination @var{directory}.
576 @xref{Target directory}.
579 @macro optNoTargetDirectory
581 @itemx --no-target-directory
583 @opindex --no-target-directory
584 @cindex target directory
585 @cindex destination directory
586 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
587 symbolic link to a directory. @xref{Target directory}.
591 @cindex output NUL-byte-terminated lines
592 Output a zero byte (ASCII NUL) at the end of each line,
593 rather than a newline. This option enables other programs to parse the
594 output even when that output would contain data with embedded newlines.
613 @macro optZeroTerminated
615 @itemx --zero-terminated
617 @opindex --zero-terminated
618 @cindex process zero-terminated items
619 Delimit items with a zero byte rather than a newline (ASCII LF).
620 I.e., treat input as items separated by ASCII NUL
621 and terminate output items with ASCII NUL.
622 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
623 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
624 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
625 or other special characters).
632 Append an SI-style abbreviation to each size, such as @samp{M} for
633 megabytes. Powers of 1000 are used, not 1024; @samp{M} stands for
634 1,000,000 bytes. This option is equivalent to
635 @option{--block-size=si}. Use the @option{-h} or
636 @option{--human-readable} option if
637 you prefer powers of 1024.
640 @macro optHumanReadable
642 @itemx --human-readable
644 @opindex --human-readable
645 @cindex human-readable output
646 Append a size letter to each size, such as @samp{M} for mebibytes.
647 Powers of 1024 are used, not 1000; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
648 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=human-readable}.
649 Use the @option{--si} option if you prefer powers of 1000.
652 @macro optStripTrailingSlashes
653 @item --strip-trailing-slashes
654 @opindex --strip-trailing-slashes
655 @cindex stripping trailing slashes
656 Remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument.
657 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
660 @macro mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{cmd}
661 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
662 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
663 Due to shell aliases and built-in @command{\cmd\} functions, using an
664 unadorned @command{\cmd\} interactively or in a script may get you
665 different functionality than that described here. Invoke it via
666 @command{env} (i.e., @code{env \cmd\ @dots{}}) to avoid interference
671 @macro multiplierSuffixes{varName}
672 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
673 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
675 @samp{b} => 512 ("blocks")
676 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
677 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
678 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
679 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
680 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
681 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
683 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
686 @c FIXME: same as above, but no ``blocks'' line.
687 @macro multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{varName}
688 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
689 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
691 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
692 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
693 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
694 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
695 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
696 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
698 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
701 @cindex common options
703 Certain options are available in all of these programs. Rather than
704 writing identical descriptions for each of the programs, they are
705 described here. (In fact, every GNU program accepts (or should accept)
708 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
709 Normally options and operands can appear in any order, and programs act
710 as if all the options appear before any operands. For example,
711 @samp{sort -r passwd -t :} acts like @samp{sort -r -t : passwd}, since
712 @samp{:} is an option-argument of @option{-t}. However, if the
713 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, options must appear
714 before operands, unless otherwise specified for a particular command.
716 A few programs can usefully have trailing operands with leading
717 @samp{-}. With such a program, options must precede operands even if
718 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set, and this fact is noted in the
719 program description. For example, the @command{env} command's options
720 must appear before its operands, since in some cases the operands
721 specify a command that itself contains options.
723 Most programs that accept long options recognize unambiguous
724 abbreviations of those options. For example, @samp{rmdir
725 --ignore-fail-on-non-empty} can be invoked as @samp{rmdir
726 --ignore-fail} or even @samp{rmdir --i}. Ambiguous options, such as
727 @samp{ls --h}, are identified as such.
729 Some of these programs recognize the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
730 options only when one of them is the sole command line argument. For
731 these programs, abbreviations of the long options are not always recognized.
738 Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully.
742 @cindex version number, finding
743 Print the version number, then exit successfully.
747 @cindex option delimiter
748 Delimit the option list. Later arguments, if any, are treated as
749 operands even if they begin with @samp{-}. For example, @samp{sort --
750 -r} reads from the file named @file{-r}.
754 @cindex standard input
755 @cindex standard output
756 A single @samp{-} operand is not really an option, though it looks like one. It
757 stands for a file operand, and some tools treat it as standard input, or as
758 standard output if that is clear from the context. For example, @samp{sort -}
759 reads from standard input, and is equivalent to plain @samp{sort}. Unless
760 otherwise specified, a @samp{-} can appear as any operand that requires a file
764 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
765 * Backup options:: -b -S, in some programs.
766 * Block size:: BLOCK_SIZE and --block-size, in some programs.
767 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation.
768 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals using the --signal option.
769 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp, chown, chroot, id: user and group syntax
770 * Random sources:: --random-source, in some programs.
771 * Target directory:: Specifying a target directory, in some programs.
772 * Trailing slashes:: --strip-trailing-slashes, in some programs.
773 * Traversing symlinks:: -H, -L, or -P, in some programs.
774 * Treating / specially:: --preserve-root and --no-preserve-root.
775 * Special built-in utilities:: @command{break}, @command{:}, @dots{}
776 * Standards conformance:: Conformance to the POSIX standard.
777 * Multi-call invocation:: Multi-call program invocation.
785 An exit status of zero indicates success,
786 and a nonzero value indicates failure.
789 Nearly every command invocation yields an integral @dfn{exit status}
790 that can be used to change how other commands work.
791 For the vast majority of commands, an exit status of zero indicates
792 success. Failure is indicated by a nonzero value---typically
793 @samp{1}, though it may differ on unusual platforms as POSIX
794 requires only that it be nonzero.
796 However, some of the programs documented here do produce
797 other exit status values and a few associate different
798 meanings with the values @samp{0} and @samp{1}.
799 Here are some of the exceptions:
800 @command{chroot}, @command{env}, @command{expr}, @command{nice},
801 @command{nohup}, @command{numfmt}, @command{printenv}, @command{sort},
802 @command{stdbuf}, @command{test}, @command{timeout}, @command{tty}.
806 @section Backup options
808 @cindex backup options
810 Some GNU programs (at least @command{cp}, @command{install},
811 @command{ln}, and @command{mv}) optionally make backups of files
812 before writing new versions.
813 These options control the details of these backups. The options are also
814 briefly mentioned in the descriptions of the particular programs.
819 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
822 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
823 @cindex backups, making
824 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
825 Without this option, the original versions are destroyed.
826 Use @var{method} to determine the type of backups to make.
827 When this option is used but @var{method} is not specified,
828 then the value of the @env{VERSION_CONTROL}
829 environment variable is used. And if @env{VERSION_CONTROL} is not set,
830 the default backup type is @samp{existing}.
832 Note that the short form of this option, @option{-b} does not accept any
833 argument. Using @option{-b} is equivalent to using @option{--backup=existing}.
835 @vindex version-control @r{Emacs variable}
836 This option corresponds to the Emacs variable @samp{version-control};
837 the values for @var{method} are the same as those used in Emacs.
838 This option also accepts more descriptive names.
839 The valid @var{method}s are (unique abbreviations are accepted):
844 @opindex none @r{backup method}
849 @opindex numbered @r{backup method}
850 Always make numbered backups.
854 @opindex existing @r{backup method}
855 Make numbered backups of files that already have them, simple backups
860 @opindex simple @r{backup method}
861 Always make simple backups. Please note @samp{never} is not to be
862 confused with @samp{none}.
866 @item -S @var{suffix}
867 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
870 @cindex backup suffix
871 @vindex SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX
872 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}. If this
873 option is not specified, the value of the @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX}
874 environment variable is used. And if @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX} is not
875 set, the default is @samp{~}, just as in Emacs.
884 Some GNU programs (at least @command{df}, @command{du}, and
885 @command{ls}) display sizes in ``blocks''. You can adjust the block size
886 and method of display to make sizes easier to read. The block size
887 used for display is independent of any file system block size.
888 Fractional block counts are rounded up to the nearest integer.
890 @opindex --block-size=@var{size}
893 @vindex DF_BLOCK_SIZE
894 @vindex DU_BLOCK_SIZE
895 @vindex LS_BLOCK_SIZE
896 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT@r{, and block size}
898 The default block size is chosen by examining the following environment
899 variables in turn; the first one that is set determines the block size.
904 This specifies the default block size for the @command{df} command.
905 Similarly, @env{DU_BLOCK_SIZE} specifies the default for @command{du} and
906 @env{LS_BLOCK_SIZE} for @command{ls}.
909 This specifies the default block size for all three commands, if the
910 above command-specific environment variables are not set.
913 This specifies the default block size for all values that are normally
914 printed as blocks, if neither @env{BLOCK_SIZE} nor the above
915 command-specific environment variables are set. Unlike the other
916 environment variables, @env{BLOCKSIZE} does not affect values that are
917 normally printed as byte counts, e.g., the file sizes contained in
920 @item POSIXLY_CORRECT
921 If neither @env{@var{command}_BLOCK_SIZE}, nor @env{BLOCK_SIZE}, nor
922 @env{BLOCKSIZE} is set, but this variable is set, the block size
927 If none of the above environment variables are set, the block size
928 currently defaults to 1024 bytes in most contexts, but this number may
929 change in the future. For @command{ls} file sizes, the block size
932 @cindex human-readable output
935 A block size specification can be a positive integer specifying the number
936 of bytes per block, or it can be @code{human-readable} or @code{si} to
937 select a human-readable format. Integers may be followed by suffixes
938 that are upward compatible with the
939 @uref{http://www.bipm.org/en/publications/si-brochure/chapter3.html,
941 for decimal multiples and with the
942 @uref{http://physics.nist.gov/cuu/Units/binary.html, ISO/IEC 80000-13
943 (formerly IEC 60027-2) prefixes} for binary multiples.
945 With human-readable formats, output sizes are followed by a size letter
946 such as @samp{M} for megabytes. @code{BLOCK_SIZE=human-readable} uses
947 powers of 1024; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
948 @code{BLOCK_SIZE=si} is similar, but uses powers of 1000 and appends
949 @samp{B}; @samp{MB} stands for 1,000,000 bytes.
952 A block size specification preceded by @samp{'} causes output sizes to
953 be displayed with thousands separators. The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale
954 specifies the thousands separator and grouping. For example, in an
955 American English locale, @samp{--block-size="'1kB"} would cause a size
956 of 1234000 bytes to be displayed as @samp{1,234}. In the default C
957 locale, there is no thousands separator so a leading @samp{'} has no
960 An integer block size can be followed by a suffix to specify a
961 multiple of that size. A bare size letter,
962 or one followed by @samp{iB}, specifies
963 a multiple using powers of 1024. A size letter followed by @samp{B}
964 specifies powers of 1000 instead. For example, @samp{1M} and
965 @samp{1MiB} are equivalent to @samp{1048576}, whereas @samp{1MB} is
966 equivalent to @samp{1000000}.
968 A plain suffix without a preceding integer acts as if @samp{1} were
969 prepended, except that it causes a size indication to be appended to
970 the output. For example, @samp{--block-size="kB"} displays 3000 as
973 The following suffixes are defined. Large sizes like @code{1Y}
974 may be rejected by your computer due to limitations of its arithmetic.
978 @cindex kilobyte, definition of
979 kilobyte: @math{10^3 = 1000}.
983 @cindex kibibyte, definition of
984 kibibyte: @math{2^{10} = 1024}. @samp{K} is special: the SI prefix is
985 @samp{k} and the ISO/IEC 80000-13 prefix is @samp{Ki}, but tradition and
986 POSIX use @samp{k} to mean @samp{KiB}.
988 @cindex megabyte, definition of
989 megabyte: @math{10^6 = 1,000,000}.
992 @cindex mebibyte, definition of
993 mebibyte: @math{2^{20} = 1,048,576}.
995 @cindex gigabyte, definition of
996 gigabyte: @math{10^9 = 1,000,000,000}.
999 @cindex gibibyte, definition of
1000 gibibyte: @math{2^{30} = 1,073,741,824}.
1002 @cindex terabyte, definition of
1003 terabyte: @math{10^{12} = 1,000,000,000,000}.
1006 @cindex tebibyte, definition of
1007 tebibyte: @math{2^{40} = 1,099,511,627,776}.
1009 @cindex petabyte, definition of
1010 petabyte: @math{10^{15} = 1,000,000,000,000,000}.
1013 @cindex pebibyte, definition of
1014 pebibyte: @math{2^{50} = 1,125,899,906,842,624}.
1016 @cindex exabyte, definition of
1017 exabyte: @math{10^{18} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1020 @cindex exbibyte, definition of
1021 exbibyte: @math{2^{60} = 1,152,921,504,606,846,976}.
1023 @cindex zettabyte, definition of
1024 zettabyte: @math{10^{21} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}
1027 @math{2^{70} = 1,180,591,620,717,411,303,424}.
1029 @cindex yottabyte, definition of
1030 yottabyte: @math{10^{24} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1033 @math{2^{80} = 1,208,925,819,614,629,174,706,176}.
1038 @opindex --block-size
1039 @opindex --human-readable
1042 Block size defaults can be overridden by an explicit
1043 @option{--block-size=@var{size}} option. The @option{-k}
1044 option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}, which
1045 is the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is
1046 set. The @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable} option is equivalent to
1047 @option{--block-size=human-readable}. The @option{--si} option is
1048 equivalent to @option{--block-size=si}. Note for @command{ls}
1049 the @option{-k} option does not control the display of the
1050 apparent file sizes, whereas the @option{--block-size} option does.
1052 @node Floating point
1053 @section Floating point numbers
1054 @cindex floating point
1055 @cindex IEEE floating point
1057 Commands that accept or produce floating point numbers employ the
1058 floating point representation of the underlying system, and suffer
1059 from rounding error, overflow, and similar floating-point issues.
1060 Almost all modern systems use IEEE-754 floating point, and it is
1061 typically portable to assume IEEE-754 behavior these days. IEEE-754
1062 has positive and negative infinity, distinguishes positive from
1063 negative zero, and uses special values called NaNs to represent
1064 invalid computations such as dividing zero by itself. For more
1065 information, please see David Goldberg's paper
1066 @uref{http://@/www.validlab.com/@/goldberg/@/paper.pdf, What Every
1067 Computer Scientist Should Know About Floating-Point Arithmetic}.
1070 Commands that accept floating point numbers as options, operands or
1071 input use the standard C functions @code{strtod} and @code{strtold} to
1072 convert from text to floating point numbers. These floating point
1073 numbers therefore can use scientific notation like @code{1.0e-34} and
1074 @code{-10e100}. Commands that parse floating point also understand
1075 case-insensitive @code{inf}, @code{infinity}, and @code{NaN}, although
1076 whether such values are useful depends on the command in question.
1077 Modern C implementations also accept hexadecimal floating point
1078 numbers such as @code{-0x.ep-3}, which stands for @minus{}14/16 times
1079 @math{2^-3}, which equals @minus{}0.109375. The @env{LC_NUMERIC}
1080 locale determines the decimal-point character. @xref{Parsing of
1081 Floats,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
1083 @node Signal specifications
1084 @section Signal specifications
1085 @cindex signals, specifying
1087 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
1088 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
1089 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
1090 @samp{SIG}@. The case of the letters is ignored. The following signal names
1091 and numbers are supported on all POSIX compliant systems:
1097 2. Terminal interrupt.
1103 9. Kill (cannot be caught or ignored).
1111 Other supported signal names have system-dependent corresponding
1112 numbers. All systems conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001 also
1113 support the following signals:
1117 Access to an undefined portion of a memory object.
1119 Child process terminated, stopped, or continued.
1121 Continue executing, if stopped.
1123 Erroneous arithmetic operation.
1125 Illegal Instruction.
1127 Write on a pipe with no one to read it.
1129 Invalid memory reference.
1131 Stop executing (cannot be caught or ignored).
1135 Background process attempting read.
1137 Background process attempting write.
1139 High bandwidth data is available at a socket.
1141 User-defined signal 1.
1143 User-defined signal 2.
1147 POSIX 1003.1-2001 systems that support the XSI extension
1148 also support the following signals:
1154 Profiling timer expired.
1158 Trace/breakpoint trap.
1160 Virtual timer expired.
1162 CPU time limit exceeded.
1164 File size limit exceeded.
1168 POSIX 1003.1-2001 systems that support the XRT extension
1169 also support at least eight real-time signals called @samp{RTMIN},
1170 @samp{RTMIN+1}, @dots{}, @samp{RTMAX-1}, @samp{RTMAX}.
1172 @node Disambiguating names and IDs
1173 @section chown, chgrp, chroot, id: Disambiguating user names and IDs
1174 @cindex user names, disambiguating
1175 @cindex user IDs, disambiguating
1176 @cindex group names, disambiguating
1177 @cindex group IDs, disambiguating
1178 @cindex disambiguating group names and IDs
1180 Since the @var{user} and @var{group} arguments to these commands
1181 may be specified as names or numeric IDs, there is an
1183 What if a user or group @emph{name} is a string of digits?
1184 @footnote{Using a number as a user name is common in some environments.}
1185 Should the command interpret it as a user name or as an ID@?
1186 POSIX requires that these commands
1187 first attempt to resolve the specified string as a name, and
1188 only once that fails, then try to interpret it as an ID@.
1189 This is troublesome when you want to specify a numeric ID, say 42,
1190 and it must work even in a pathological situation where
1191 @samp{42} is a user name that maps to some other user ID, say 1000.
1192 Simply invoking @code{chown 42 F}, will set @file{F}s owner ID to
1193 1000---not what you intended.
1195 GNU @command{chown}, @command{chgrp}, @command{chroot}, and @command{id}
1196 provide a way to work around this, that at the same time may result in a
1197 significant performance improvement by eliminating a database look-up.
1198 Simply precede each numeric user ID and/or group ID with a @samp{+},
1199 in order to force its interpretation as an integer:
1203 chgrp +$numeric_group_id another-file
1207 The name look-up process is skipped for each @samp{+}-prefixed string,
1208 because a string containing @samp{+} is never a valid user or group name.
1209 This syntax is accepted on most common Unix systems, but not on Solaris 10.
1211 @node Random sources
1212 @section Sources of random data
1214 @cindex random sources
1216 The @command{shuf}, @command{shred}, and @command{sort} commands
1217 sometimes need random data to do their work. For example, @samp{sort
1218 -R} must choose a hash function at random, and it needs random data to
1219 make this selection.
1221 By default these commands use an internal pseudo-random generator
1222 initialized by a small amount of entropy, but can be directed to use
1223 an external source with the @option{--random-source=@var{file}} option.
1224 An error is reported if @var{file} does not contain enough bytes.
1226 For example, the device file @file{/dev/urandom} could be used as the
1227 source of random data. Typically, this device gathers environmental
1228 noise from device drivers and other sources into an entropy pool, and
1229 uses the pool to generate random bits. If the pool is short of data,
1230 the device reuses the internal pool to produce more bits, using a
1231 cryptographically secure pseudo-random number generator. But be aware
1232 that this device is not designed for bulk random data generation
1233 and is relatively slow.
1235 @file{/dev/urandom} suffices for most practical uses, but applications
1236 requiring high-value or long-term protection of private data may
1237 require an alternate data source like @file{/dev/random} or
1238 @file{/dev/arandom}. The set of available sources depends on your
1241 To reproduce the results of an earlier invocation of a command, you
1242 can save some random data into a file and then use that file as the
1243 random source in earlier and later invocations of the command.
1245 Rather than depending on a file, one can generate a reproducible
1246 arbitrary amount of pseudo-random data given a seed value, using
1253 openssl enc -aes-256-ctr -pass pass:"$seed" -nosalt \
1254 </dev/zero 2>/dev/null
1257 shuf -i1-100 --random-source=<(get_seeded_random 42)
1260 @node Target directory
1261 @section Target directory
1263 @cindex target directory
1265 The @command{cp}, @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv}
1266 commands normally treat the last operand specially when it is a
1267 directory or a symbolic link to a directory. For example, @samp{cp
1268 source dest} is equivalent to @samp{cp source dest/source} if
1269 @file{dest} is a directory. Sometimes this behavior is not exactly
1270 what is wanted, so these commands support the following options to
1271 allow more fine-grained control:
1276 @itemx --no-target-directory
1277 @opindex --no-target-directory
1278 @cindex target directory
1279 @cindex destination directory
1280 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
1281 symbolic link to a directory. This can help avoid race conditions in
1282 programs that operate in a shared area. For example, when the command
1283 @samp{mv /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no guarantee that
1284 @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}: it could have been
1285 renamed to @file{/tmp/dest/source} instead, if some other process
1286 created @file{/tmp/dest} as a directory. However, if @file{mv
1287 -T /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no
1288 question that @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}.
1290 In the opposite situation, where you want the last operand to be
1291 treated as a directory and want a diagnostic otherwise, you can use
1292 the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option.
1294 @item -t @var{directory}
1295 @itemx --target-directory=@var{directory}
1296 @opindex --target-directory
1297 @cindex target directory
1298 @cindex destination directory
1299 Use @var{directory} as the directory component of each destination
1302 The interface for most programs is that after processing options and a
1303 finite (possibly zero) number of fixed-position arguments, the remaining
1304 argument list is either expected to be empty, or is a list of items
1305 (usually files) that will all be handled identically. The @command{xargs}
1306 program is designed to work well with this convention.
1308 The commands in the @command{mv}-family are unusual in that they take
1309 a variable number of arguments with a special case at the @emph{end}
1310 (namely, the target directory). This makes it nontrivial to perform some
1311 operations, e.g., ``move all files from here to ../d/'', because
1312 @code{mv * ../d/} might exhaust the argument space, and @code{ls | xargs ...}
1313 doesn't have a clean way to specify an extra final argument for each
1314 invocation of the subject command. (It can be done by going through a
1315 shell command, but that requires more human labor and brain power than
1318 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option allows the @command{cp},
1319 @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv} programs to be used
1320 conveniently with @command{xargs}. For example, you can move the files
1321 from the current directory to a sibling directory, @code{d} like this:
1324 ls | xargs mv -t ../d --
1327 However, this doesn't move files whose names begin with @samp{.}.
1328 If you use the GNU @command{find} program, you can move those
1329 files too, with this command:
1332 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 \
1336 But both of the above approaches fail if there are no files in the
1337 current directory, or if any file has a name containing a blank or
1338 some other special characters.
1339 The following example removes those limitations and requires both
1340 GNU @command{find} and GNU @command{xargs}:
1343 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 -print0 \
1344 | xargs --null --no-run-if-empty \
1351 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) and
1352 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T})
1353 options cannot be combined.
1355 @node Trailing slashes
1356 @section Trailing slashes
1358 @cindex trailing slashes
1360 Some GNU programs (at least @command{cp} and @command{mv}) allow you to
1361 remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument before
1362 operating on it. The @option{--strip-trailing-slashes} option enables
1365 This is useful when a @var{source} argument may have a trailing slash and
1366 @c FIXME: mv's behavior in this case is system-dependent
1367 specify a symbolic link to a directory. This scenario is in fact rather
1368 common because some shells can automatically append a trailing slash when
1369 performing file name completion on such symbolic links. Without this
1370 option, @command{mv}, for example, (via the system's rename function) must
1371 interpret a trailing slash as a request to dereference the symbolic link
1372 and so must rename the indirectly referenced @emph{directory} and not
1373 the symbolic link. Although it may seem surprising that such behavior
1374 be the default, it is required by POSIX and is consistent with
1375 other parts of that standard.
1377 @node Traversing symlinks
1378 @section Traversing symlinks
1380 @cindex symbolic link to directory, controlling traversal of
1382 The following options modify how @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1383 @c FIXME: note that 'du' has these options, too, but they have slightly
1384 @c different meaning.
1385 traverse a hierarchy when the @option{--recursive} (@option{-R})
1386 option is also specified.
1387 If more than one of the following options is specified, only the final
1389 These options specify whether processing a symbolic link to a directory
1390 entails operating on just the symbolic link or on all files in the
1391 hierarchy rooted at that directory.
1393 These options are independent of @option{--dereference} and
1394 @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-h}), which control whether to modify
1395 a symlink or its referent.
1402 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse if on the command line
1403 If @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}) is specified and
1404 a command line argument is a symbolic link to a directory, traverse it.
1411 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is encountered
1412 In a recursive traversal, traverse every symbolic link to a directory
1413 that is encountered.
1420 @cindex symbolic link to directory, never traverse
1421 Do not traverse any symbolic links.
1422 This is the default if none of @option{-H}, @option{-L},
1423 or @option{-P} is specified.
1430 @node Treating / specially
1431 @section Treating @file{/} specially
1433 Certain commands can operate destructively on entire hierarchies.
1434 For example, if a user with appropriate privileges mistakenly runs
1435 @samp{rm -rf / tmp/junk}, that may remove
1436 all files on the entire system. Since there are so few
1437 legitimate uses for such a command,
1438 GNU @command{rm} normally declines to operate on any directory
1439 that resolves to @file{/}. If you really want to try to remove all
1440 the files on your system, you can use the @option{--no-preserve-root}
1441 option, but the default behavior, specified by the
1442 @option{--preserve-root} option, is safer for most purposes.
1444 The commands @command{chgrp}, @command{chmod} and @command{chown}
1445 can also operate destructively on entire hierarchies, so they too
1446 support these options. Although, unlike @command{rm}, they don't
1447 actually unlink files, these commands are arguably more dangerous
1448 when operating recursively on @file{/}, since they often work much
1449 more quickly, and hence damage more files before an alert user can
1450 interrupt them. Tradition and POSIX require these commands
1451 to operate recursively on @file{/}, so they default to
1452 @option{--no-preserve-root}, but using the @option{--preserve-root}
1453 option makes them safer for most purposes. For convenience you can
1454 specify @option{--preserve-root} in an alias or in a shell function.
1456 Note that the @option{--preserve-root} option also ensures
1457 that @command{chgrp} and @command{chown} do not modify @file{/}
1458 even when dereferencing a symlink pointing to @file{/}.
1460 @node Special built-in utilities
1461 @section Special built-in utilities
1463 Some programs like @command{nice} can invoke other programs; for
1464 example, the command @samp{nice cat file} invokes the program
1465 @command{cat} by executing the command @samp{cat file}. However,
1466 @dfn{special built-in utilities} like @command{exit} cannot be invoked
1467 this way. For example, the command @samp{nice exit} does not have a
1468 well-defined behavior: it may generate an error message instead of
1471 Here is a list of the special built-in utilities that are standardized
1472 by POSIX 1003.1-2004.
1475 @t{.@: : break continue eval exec exit export readonly
1476 return set shift times trap unset}
1479 For example, because @samp{.}, @samp{:}, and @samp{exec} are special,
1480 the commands @samp{nice . foo.sh}, @samp{nice :}, and @samp{nice exec
1481 pwd} do not work as you might expect.
1483 Many shells extend this list. For example, Bash has several extra
1484 special built-in utilities like @command{history}, and
1485 @command{suspend}, and with Bash the command @samp{nice suspend}
1486 generates an error message instead of suspending.
1488 @node Standards conformance
1489 @section Standards conformance
1491 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
1492 In a few cases, the GNU utilities' default behavior is
1493 incompatible with the POSIX standard. To suppress these
1494 incompatibilities, define the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment
1495 variable. Unless you are checking for POSIX conformance, you
1496 probably do not need to define @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}.
1498 Newer versions of POSIX are occasionally incompatible with older
1499 versions. For example, older versions of POSIX required the
1500 command @samp{sort +1} to sort based on the second and succeeding
1501 fields in each input line, but starting with POSIX 1003.1-2001
1502 the same command is required to sort the file named @file{+1}, and you
1503 must instead use the command @samp{sort -k 2} to get the field-based
1506 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
1507 The GNU utilities normally conform to the version of POSIX
1508 that is standard for your system. To cause them to conform to a
1509 different version of POSIX, define the @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}
1510 environment variable to a value of the form @var{yyyymm} specifying
1511 the year and month the standard was adopted. Three values are currently
1512 supported for @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}: @samp{199209} stands for
1513 POSIX 1003.2-1992, @samp{200112} stands for POSIX
1514 1003.1-2001, and @samp{200809} stands for POSIX 1003.1-2008.
1515 For example, if you have a newer system but are running software
1516 that assumes an older version of POSIX and uses @samp{sort +1}
1517 or @samp{tail +10}, you can work around any compatibility problems by setting
1518 @samp{_POSIX2_VERSION=199209} in your environment.
1520 @c This node is named "Multi-call invocation", not the usual
1521 @c "coreutils invocation", so that shell commands like
1522 @c 'info coreutils "touch invocation"' work as expected.
1523 @node Multi-call invocation
1524 @section @command{coreutils}: Multi-call program
1528 @cindex calling combined multi-call program
1530 The @command{coreutils} command invokes an individual utility, either
1531 implicitly selected by the last component of the name used to invoke
1532 @command{coreutils}, or explicitly with the
1533 @option{--coreutils-prog} option. Synopsis:
1536 coreutils @option{--coreutils-prog=PROGRAM} @dots{}
1539 The @command{coreutils} command is not installed by default, so
1540 portable scripts should not rely on its existence.
1542 @node Output of entire files
1543 @chapter Output of entire files
1545 @cindex output of entire files
1546 @cindex entire files, output of
1548 These commands read and write entire files, possibly transforming them
1552 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
1553 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
1554 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
1555 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
1556 * base32 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1557 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1560 @node cat invocation
1561 @section @command{cat}: Concatenate and write files
1564 @cindex concatenate and write files
1565 @cindex copying files
1567 @command{cat} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1568 standard input if none are given, to standard output. Synopsis:
1571 cat [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
1574 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1582 Equivalent to @option{-vET}.
1585 @itemx --number-nonblank
1587 @opindex --number-nonblank
1588 Number all nonempty output lines, starting with 1.
1592 Equivalent to @option{-vE}.
1597 @opindex --show-ends
1598 Display a @samp{$} after the end of each line.
1604 Number all output lines, starting with 1. This option is ignored
1605 if @option{-b} is in effect.
1608 @itemx --squeeze-blank
1610 @opindex --squeeze-blank
1611 @cindex squeezing empty lines
1612 Suppress repeated adjacent empty lines; output just one empty line
1617 Equivalent to @option{-vT}.
1622 @opindex --show-tabs
1623 Display TAB characters as @samp{^I}.
1627 Ignored; for POSIX compatibility.
1630 @itemx --show-nonprinting
1632 @opindex --show-nonprinting
1633 Display control characters except for LFD and TAB using
1634 @samp{^} notation and precede characters that have the high bit set with
1639 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1640 @command{cat} normally reads and writes in binary mode. However,
1641 @command{cat} reads in text mode if one of the options
1642 @option{-bensAE} is used or if @command{cat} is reading from standard
1643 input and standard input is a terminal. Similarly, @command{cat}
1644 writes in text mode if one of the options @option{-bensAE} is used or
1645 if standard output is a terminal.
1652 # Output f's contents, then standard input, then g's contents.
1655 # Copy standard input to standard output.
1660 @node tac invocation
1661 @section @command{tac}: Concatenate and write files in reverse
1664 @cindex reversing files
1666 @command{tac} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1667 standard input if none are given, to standard output, reversing the
1668 records (lines by default) in each separately. Synopsis:
1671 tac [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1674 @dfn{Records} are separated by instances of a string (newline by
1675 default). By default, this separator string is attached to the end of
1676 the record that it follows in the file.
1678 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1686 The separator is attached to the beginning of the record that it
1687 precedes in the file.
1693 Treat the separator string as a regular expression.
1695 @item -s @var{separator}
1696 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
1698 @opindex --separator
1699 Use @var{separator} as the record separator, instead of newline.
1703 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1704 @command{tac} reads and writes in binary mode.
1711 # Reverse a file character by character.
1717 @section @command{nl}: Number lines and write files
1720 @cindex numbering lines
1721 @cindex line numbering
1723 @command{nl} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1724 standard input if none are given, to standard output, with line numbers
1725 added to some or all of the lines. Synopsis:
1728 nl [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1731 @cindex logical pages, numbering on
1732 @command{nl} decomposes its input into (logical) pages; by default, the
1733 line number is reset to 1 at the top of each logical page. @command{nl}
1734 treats all of the input files as a single document; it does not reset
1735 line numbers or logical pages between files.
1737 @cindex headers, numbering
1738 @cindex body, numbering
1739 @cindex footers, numbering
1740 A logical page consists of three sections: header, body, and footer.
1741 Any of the sections can be empty. Each can be numbered in a different
1742 style from the others.
1744 The beginnings of the sections of logical pages are indicated in the
1745 input file by a line containing exactly one of these delimiter strings:
1756 The two characters from which these strings are made can be changed from
1757 @samp{\} and @samp{:} via options (see below), but the pattern and
1758 length of each string cannot be changed.
1760 A section delimiter is replaced by an empty line on output. Any text
1761 that comes before the first section delimiter string in the input file
1762 is considered to be part of a body section, so @command{nl} treats a
1763 file that contains no section delimiters as a single body section.
1765 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1769 @item -b @var{style}
1770 @itemx --body-numbering=@var{style}
1772 @opindex --body-numbering
1773 Select the numbering style for lines in the body section of each
1774 logical page. When a line is not numbered, the current line number
1775 is not incremented, but the line number separator character is still
1776 prepended to the line. The styles are:
1782 number only nonempty lines (default for body),
1784 do not number lines (default for header and footer),
1786 number only lines that contain a match for the basic regular
1787 expression @var{bre}.
1788 @xref{Regular Expressions, , Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}.
1792 @itemx --section-delimiter=@var{cd}
1794 @opindex --section-delimiter
1795 @cindex section delimiters of pages
1796 Set the section delimiter characters to @var{cd}; default is
1797 @samp{\:}. If only @var{c} is given, the second remains @samp{:}.
1798 (Remember to protect @samp{\} or other metacharacters from shell
1799 expansion with quotes or extra backslashes.)
1801 @item -f @var{style}
1802 @itemx --footer-numbering=@var{style}
1804 @opindex --footer-numbering
1805 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1807 @item -h @var{style}
1808 @itemx --header-numbering=@var{style}
1810 @opindex --header-numbering
1811 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1813 @item -i @var{number}
1814 @itemx --line-increment=@var{number}
1816 @opindex --line-increment
1817 Increment line numbers by @var{number} (default 1).
1819 @item -l @var{number}
1820 @itemx --join-blank-lines=@var{number}
1822 @opindex --join-blank-lines
1823 @cindex empty lines, numbering
1824 @cindex blank lines, numbering
1825 Consider @var{number} (default 1) consecutive empty lines to be one
1826 logical line for numbering, and only number the last one. Where fewer
1827 than @var{number} consecutive empty lines occur, do not number them.
1828 An empty line is one that contains no characters, not even spaces
1831 @item -n @var{format}
1832 @itemx --number-format=@var{format}
1834 @opindex --number-format
1835 Select the line numbering format (default is @code{rn}):
1839 @opindex ln @r{format for @command{nl}}
1840 left justified, no leading zeros;
1842 @opindex rn @r{format for @command{nl}}
1843 right justified, no leading zeros;
1845 @opindex rz @r{format for @command{nl}}
1846 right justified, leading zeros.
1850 @itemx --no-renumber
1852 @opindex --no-renumber
1853 Do not reset the line number at the start of a logical page.
1855 @item -s @var{string}
1856 @itemx --number-separator=@var{string}
1858 @opindex --number-separator
1859 Separate the line number from the text line in the output with
1860 @var{string} (default is the TAB character).
1862 @item -v @var{number}
1863 @itemx --starting-line-number=@var{number}
1865 @opindex --starting-line-number
1866 Set the initial line number on each logical page to @var{number} (default 1).
1868 @item -w @var{number}
1869 @itemx --number-width=@var{number}
1871 @opindex --number-width
1872 Use @var{number} characters for line numbers (default 6).
1880 @section @command{od}: Write files in octal or other formats
1883 @cindex octal dump of files
1884 @cindex hex dump of files
1885 @cindex ASCII dump of files
1886 @cindex file contents, dumping unambiguously
1888 @command{od} writes an unambiguous representation of each @var{file}
1889 (@samp{-} means standard input), or standard input if none are given.
1893 od [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1894 od [-abcdfilosx]@dots{} [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b]]
1895 od [@var{option}]@dots{} --traditional [@var{file}]@c
1896 [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1899 Each line of output consists of the offset in the input, followed by
1900 groups of data from the file. By default, @command{od} prints the offset in
1901 octal, and each group of file data is a C @code{short int}'s worth of input
1902 printed as a single octal number.
1904 If @var{offset} is given, it specifies how many input bytes to skip
1905 before formatting and writing. By default, it is interpreted as an
1906 octal number, but the optional trailing decimal point causes it to be
1907 interpreted as decimal. If no decimal is specified and the offset
1908 begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} it is interpreted as a hexadecimal
1909 number. If there is a trailing @samp{b}, the number of bytes skipped
1910 will be @var{offset} multiplied by 512.
1912 If a command is of both the first and second forms, the second form is
1913 assumed if the last operand begins with @samp{+} or (if there are two
1914 operands) a digit. For example, in @samp{od foo 10} and @samp{od +10}
1915 the @samp{10} is an offset, whereas in @samp{od 10} the @samp{10} is a
1918 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1922 @item -A @var{radix}
1923 @itemx --address-radix=@var{radix}
1925 @opindex --address-radix
1926 @cindex radix for file offsets
1927 @cindex file offset radix
1928 Select the base in which file offsets are printed. @var{radix} can
1929 be one of the following:
1939 none (do not print offsets).
1942 The default is octal.
1944 @item --endian=@var{order}
1946 @cindex byte-swapping
1948 Reorder input bytes, to handle inputs with differing byte orders,
1949 or to provide consistent output independent of the endian convention
1950 of the current system. Swapping is performed according to the
1951 specified @option{--type} size and endian @var{order}, which can be
1952 @samp{little} or @samp{big}.
1954 @item -j @var{bytes}
1955 @itemx --skip-bytes=@var{bytes}
1957 @opindex --skip-bytes
1958 Skip @var{bytes} input bytes before formatting and writing. If
1959 @var{bytes} begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, it is interpreted in
1960 hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0}, in octal; otherwise,
1962 @multiplierSuffixes{bytes}
1964 @item -N @var{bytes}
1965 @itemx --read-bytes=@var{bytes}
1967 @opindex --read-bytes
1968 Output at most @var{bytes} bytes of the input. Prefixes and suffixes on
1969 @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the @option{-j} option.
1971 @item -S @var{bytes}
1972 @itemx --strings[=@var{bytes}]
1975 @cindex string constants, outputting
1976 Instead of the normal output, output only @dfn{string constants}: at
1977 least @var{bytes} consecutive ASCII graphic characters,
1978 followed by a zero byte (ASCII NUL).
1979 Prefixes and suffixes on @var{bytes} are interpreted as for the
1982 If @var{bytes} is omitted with @option{--strings}, the default is 3.
1985 @itemx --format=@var{type}
1988 Select the format in which to output the file data. @var{type} is a
1989 string of one or more of the below type indicator characters. If you
1990 include more than one type indicator character in a single @var{type}
1991 string, or use this option more than once, @command{od} writes one copy
1992 of each output line using each of the data types that you specified,
1993 in the order that you specified.
1995 Adding a trailing ``z'' to any type specification appends a display
1996 of the single byte character representation of the printable characters
1997 to the output line generated by the type specification.
2001 named character, ignoring high-order bit
2003 printable single byte character, C backslash escape
2004 or a 3 digit octal sequence
2008 floating point (@pxref{Floating point})
2017 The type @code{a} outputs things like @samp{sp} for space, @samp{nl} for
2018 newline, and @samp{nul} for a zero byte. Only the least significant
2019 seven bits of each byte is used; the high-order bit is ignored.
2020 Type @code{c} outputs
2021 @samp{ }, @samp{\n}, and @code{\0}, respectively.
2024 Except for types @samp{a} and @samp{c}, you can specify the number
2025 of bytes to use in interpreting each number in the given data type
2026 by following the type indicator character with a decimal integer.
2027 Alternately, you can specify the size of one of the C compiler's
2028 built-in data types by following the type indicator character with
2029 one of the following characters. For integers (@samp{d}, @samp{o},
2030 @samp{u}, @samp{x}):
2043 For floating point (@code{f}):
2055 @itemx --output-duplicates
2057 @opindex --output-duplicates
2058 Output consecutive lines that are identical. By default, when two or
2059 more consecutive output lines would be identical, @command{od} outputs only
2060 the first line, and puts just an asterisk on the following line to
2061 indicate the elision.
2064 @itemx --width[=@var{n}]
2067 Dump @code{n} input bytes per output line. This must be a multiple of
2068 the least common multiple of the sizes associated with the specified
2071 If this option is not given at all, the default is 16. If @var{n} is
2072 omitted, the default is 32.
2076 The next several options are shorthands for format specifications.
2077 GNU @command{od} accepts any combination of shorthands and format
2078 specification options. These options accumulate.
2084 Output as named characters. Equivalent to @samp{-t a}.
2088 Output as octal bytes. Equivalent to @samp{-t o1}.
2092 Output as printable single byte characters, C backslash escapes
2093 or 3 digit octal sequences. Equivalent to @samp{-t c}.
2097 Output as unsigned decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t u2}.
2101 Output as floats. Equivalent to @samp{-t fF}.
2105 Output as decimal ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dI}.
2109 Output as decimal long ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dL}.
2113 Output as octal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t o2}.
2117 Output as decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t d2}.
2121 Output as hexadecimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t x2}.
2124 @opindex --traditional
2125 Recognize the non-option label argument that traditional @command{od}
2126 accepted. The following syntax:
2129 od --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
2133 can be used to specify at most one file and optional arguments
2134 specifying an offset and a pseudo-start address, @var{label}.
2135 The @var{label} argument is interpreted
2136 just like @var{offset}, but it specifies an initial pseudo-address. The
2137 pseudo-addresses are displayed in parentheses following any normal
2145 @node base32 invocation
2146 @section @command{base32}: Transform data into printable data
2149 @cindex base32 encoding
2151 @command{base32} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2152 into (or from) base32 encoded form. The base32 encoded form uses
2153 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2154 The usage and options of this command are precisely the
2155 same as for @command{base64}. @xref{base64 invocation}.
2158 @node base64 invocation
2159 @section @command{base64}: Transform data into printable data
2162 @cindex base64 encoding
2164 @command{base64} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2165 into (or from) base64 encoded form. The base64 encoded form uses
2166 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2170 base64 [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2171 base64 --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2174 The base64 encoding expands data to roughly 133% of the original.
2175 The base32 encoding expands data to roughly 160% of the original.
2176 The format conforms to
2177 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc4648.txt, RFC 4648}.
2179 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2184 @itemx --wrap=@var{cols}
2188 @cindex column to wrap data after
2189 During encoding, wrap lines after @var{cols} characters. This must be
2192 The default is to wrap after 76 characters. Use the value 0 to
2193 disable line wrapping altogether.
2199 @cindex Decode base64 data
2200 @cindex Base64 decoding
2201 Change the mode of operation, from the default of encoding data, to
2202 decoding data. Input is expected to be base64 encoded data, and the
2203 output will be the original data.
2206 @itemx --ignore-garbage
2208 @opindex --ignore-garbage
2209 @cindex Ignore garbage in base64 stream
2210 When decoding, newlines are always accepted.
2211 During decoding, ignore unrecognized bytes,
2212 to permit distorted data to be decoded.
2219 @node Formatting file contents
2220 @chapter Formatting file contents
2222 @cindex formatting file contents
2224 These commands reformat the contents of files.
2227 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
2228 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
2229 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
2233 @node fmt invocation
2234 @section @command{fmt}: Reformat paragraph text
2237 @cindex reformatting paragraph text
2238 @cindex paragraphs, reformatting
2239 @cindex text, reformatting
2241 @command{fmt} fills and joins lines to produce output lines of (at most)
2242 a given number of characters (75 by default). Synopsis:
2245 fmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2248 @command{fmt} reads from the specified @var{file} arguments (or standard
2249 input if none are given), and writes to standard output.
2251 By default, blank lines, spaces between words, and indentation are
2252 preserved in the output; successive input lines with different
2253 indentation are not joined; tabs are expanded on input and introduced on
2256 @cindex line-breaking
2257 @cindex sentences and line-breaking
2258 @cindex Knuth, Donald E.
2259 @cindex Plass, Michael F.
2260 @command{fmt} prefers breaking lines at the end of a sentence, and tries to
2261 avoid line breaks after the first word of a sentence or before the last
2262 word of a sentence. A @dfn{sentence break} is defined as either the end
2263 of a paragraph or a word ending in any of @samp{.?!}, followed by two
2264 spaces or end of line, ignoring any intervening parentheses or quotes.
2265 Like @TeX{}, @command{fmt} reads entire ``paragraphs'' before choosing line
2266 breaks; the algorithm is a variant of that given by Donald E. Knuth
2267 and Michael F. Plass in ``Breaking Paragraphs Into Lines'',
2268 @cite{Software---Practice & Experience} @b{11}, 11 (November 1981),
2271 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2276 @itemx --crown-margin
2278 @opindex --crown-margin
2279 @cindex crown margin
2280 @dfn{Crown margin} mode: preserve the indentation of the first two
2281 lines within a paragraph, and align the left margin of each subsequent
2282 line with that of the second line.
2285 @itemx --tagged-paragraph
2287 @opindex --tagged-paragraph
2288 @cindex tagged paragraphs
2289 @dfn{Tagged paragraph} mode: like crown margin mode, except that if
2290 indentation of the first line of a paragraph is the same as the
2291 indentation of the second, the first line is treated as a one-line
2297 @opindex --split-only
2298 Split lines only. Do not join short lines to form longer ones. This
2299 prevents sample lines of code, and other such ``formatted'' text from
2300 being unduly combined.
2303 @itemx --uniform-spacing
2305 @opindex --uniform-spacing
2306 Uniform spacing. Reduce spacing between words to one space, and spacing
2307 between sentences to two spaces.
2310 @itemx -w @var{width}
2311 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2312 @opindex -@var{width}
2315 Fill output lines up to @var{width} characters (default 75 or @var{goal}
2316 plus 10, if @var{goal} is provided).
2319 @itemx --goal=@var{goal}
2322 @command{fmt} initially tries to make lines @var{goal} characters wide.
2323 By default, this is 7% shorter than @var{width}.
2325 @item -p @var{prefix}
2326 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2327 Only lines beginning with @var{prefix} (possibly preceded by whitespace)
2328 are subject to formatting. The prefix and any preceding whitespace are
2329 stripped for the formatting and then re-attached to each formatted output
2330 line. One use is to format certain kinds of program comments, while
2331 leaving the code unchanged.
2338 @section @command{pr}: Paginate or columnate files for printing
2341 @cindex printing, preparing files for
2342 @cindex multicolumn output, generating
2343 @cindex merging files in parallel
2345 @command{pr} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
2346 standard input if none are given, to standard output, paginating and
2347 optionally outputting in multicolumn format; optionally merges all
2348 @var{file}s, printing all in parallel, one per column. Synopsis:
2351 pr [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2355 By default, a 5-line header is printed at each page: two blank lines;
2356 a line with the date, the file name, and the page count; and two more
2357 blank lines. A footer of five blank lines is also printed.
2358 The default @var{page_length} is 66
2359 lines. The default number of text lines is therefore 56.
2360 The text line of the header takes the form
2361 @samp{@var{date} @var{string} @var{page}}, with spaces inserted around
2362 @var{string} so that the line takes up the full @var{page_width}. Here,
2363 @var{date} is the date (see the @option{-D} or @option{--date-format}
2364 option for details), @var{string} is the centered header string, and
2365 @var{page} identifies the page number. The @env{LC_MESSAGES} locale
2366 category affects the spelling of @var{page}; in the default C locale, it
2367 is @samp{Page @var{number}} where @var{number} is the decimal page
2370 Form feeds in the input cause page breaks in the output. Multiple form
2371 feeds produce empty pages.
2373 Columns are of equal width, separated by an optional string (default
2374 is @samp{space}). For multicolumn output, lines will always be truncated to
2375 @var{page_width} (default 72), unless you use the @option{-J} option.
2377 column output no line truncation occurs by default. Use @option{-W} option to
2378 truncate lines in that case.
2380 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2384 @item +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2385 @itemx --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2386 @c The two following @opindex lines evoke warnings because they contain ':'
2387 @c The 'info' spec does not permit that. If we use those lines, we end
2388 @c up with truncated index entries that don't work.
2389 @c @opindex +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2390 @c @opindex --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2391 @opindex +@var{page_range}
2392 @opindex --pages=@var{page_range}
2393 Begin printing with page @var{first_page} and stop with @var{last_page}.
2394 Missing @samp{:@var{last_page}} implies end of file. While estimating
2395 the number of skipped pages each form feed in the input file results
2396 in a new page. Page counting with and without @samp{+@var{first_page}}
2397 is identical. By default, counting starts with the first page of input
2398 file (not first page printed). Line numbering may be altered by @option{-N}
2402 @itemx --columns=@var{column}
2403 @opindex -@var{column}
2405 @cindex down columns
2406 With each single @var{file}, produce @var{column} columns of output
2407 (default is 1) and print columns down, unless @option{-a} is used. The
2408 column width is automatically decreased as @var{column} increases; unless
2409 you use the @option{-W/-w} option to increase @var{page_width} as well.
2410 This option might well cause some lines to be truncated. The number of
2411 lines in the columns on each page are balanced. The options @option{-e}
2412 and @option{-i} are on for multiple text-column output. Together with
2413 @option{-J} option column alignment and line truncation is turned off.
2414 Lines of full length are joined in a free field format and @option{-S}
2415 option may set field separators. @option{-@var{column}} may not be used
2416 with @option{-m} option.
2422 @cindex across columns
2423 With each single @var{file}, print columns across rather than down. The
2424 @option{-@var{column}} option must be given with @var{column} greater than one.
2425 If a line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated.
2428 @itemx --show-control-chars
2430 @opindex --show-control-chars
2431 Print control characters using hat notation (e.g., @samp{^G}); print
2432 other nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation. By default,
2433 nonprinting characters are not changed.
2436 @itemx --double-space
2438 @opindex --double-space
2439 @cindex double spacing
2440 Double space the output.
2442 @item -D @var{format}
2443 @itemx --date-format=@var{format}
2444 @cindex time formats
2445 @cindex formatting times
2446 Format header dates using @var{format}, using the same conventions as
2447 for the command @samp{date +@var{format}}. @xref{date invocation}.
2448 Except for directives, which start with
2449 @samp{%}, characters in @var{format} are printed unchanged. You can use
2450 this option to specify an arbitrary string in place of the header date,
2451 e.g., @option{--date-format="Monday morning"}.
2453 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2455 The default date format is @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M} (for example,
2456 @samp{2001-12-04 23:59});
2457 but if the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set
2458 and the @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the POSIX
2459 locale, the default is @samp{%b %e %H:%M %Y} (for example,
2460 @samp{Dec@ @ 4 23:59 2001}.
2463 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
2464 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
2465 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
2466 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
2468 @item -e[@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2469 @itemx --expand-tabs[=@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2471 @opindex --expand-tabs
2473 Expand @var{tab}s to spaces on input. Optional argument @var{in-tabchar} is
2474 the input tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2475 argument @var{in-tabwidth} is the input tab character's width (default
2483 @opindex --form-feed
2484 Use a form feed instead of newlines to separate output pages. This does
2485 not alter the default page length of 66 lines.
2487 @item -h @var{header}
2488 @itemx --header=@var{header}
2491 Replace the file name in the header with the centered string @var{header}.
2492 When using the shell, @var{header} should be quoted and should be
2493 separated from @option{-h} by a space.
2495 @item -i[@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2496 @itemx --output-tabs[=@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2498 @opindex --output-tabs
2500 Replace spaces with @var{tab}s on output. Optional argument @var{out-tabchar}
2501 is the output tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2502 argument @var{out-tabwidth} is the output tab character's width (default
2508 @opindex --join-lines
2509 Merge lines of full length. Used together with the column options
2510 @option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}. Turns off
2511 @option{-W/-w} line truncation;
2512 no column alignment used; may be used with
2513 @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]}. @option{-J} has been introduced
2514 (together with @option{-W} and @option{--sep-string})
2515 to disentangle the old (POSIX-compliant) options @option{-w} and
2516 @option{-s} along with the three column options.
2519 @item -l @var{page_length}
2520 @itemx --length=@var{page_length}
2523 Set the page length to @var{page_length} (default 66) lines, including
2524 the lines of the header [and the footer]. If @var{page_length} is less
2525 than or equal to 10, the header and footer are omitted, as if the
2526 @option{-t} option had been given.
2532 Merge and print all @var{file}s in parallel, one in each column. If a
2533 line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated, unless the @option{-J}
2534 option is used. @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]} may be used.
2536 some @var{file}s (form feeds set) produce empty columns, still marked
2537 by @var{string}. The result is a continuous line numbering and column
2538 marking throughout the whole merged file. Completely empty merged pages
2539 show no separators or line numbers. The default header becomes
2540 @samp{@var{date} @var{page}} with spaces inserted in the middle; this
2541 may be used with the @option{-h} or @option{--header} option to fill up
2542 the middle blank part.
2544 @item -n[@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2545 @itemx --number-lines[=@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2547 @opindex --number-lines
2548 Provide @var{digits} digit line numbering (default for @var{digits} is
2549 5). With multicolumn output the number occupies the first @var{digits}
2550 column positions of each text column or only each line of @option{-m}
2551 output. With single column output the number precedes each line just as
2552 @option{-m} does. Default counting of the line numbers starts with the
2553 first line of the input file (not the first line printed, compare the
2554 @option{--page} option and @option{-N} option).
2555 Optional argument @var{number-separator} is the character appended to
2556 the line number to separate it from the text followed. The default
2557 separator is the TAB character. In a strict sense a TAB is always
2558 printed with single column output only. The TAB width varies
2559 with the TAB position, e.g., with the left @var{margin} specified
2560 by @option{-o} option. With multicolumn output priority is given to
2561 @samp{equal width of output columns} (a POSIX specification).
2562 The TAB width is fixed to the value of the first column and does
2563 not change with different values of left @var{margin}. That means a
2564 fixed number of spaces is always printed in the place of the
2565 @var{number-separator} TAB@. The tabification depends upon the output
2568 @item -N @var{line_number}
2569 @itemx --first-line-number=@var{line_number}
2571 @opindex --first-line-number
2572 Start line counting with the number @var{line_number} at first line of
2573 first page printed (in most cases not the first line of the input file).
2575 @item -o @var{margin}
2576 @itemx --indent=@var{margin}
2579 @cindex indenting lines
2581 Indent each line with a margin @var{margin} spaces wide (default is zero).
2582 The total page width is the size of the margin plus the @var{page_width}
2583 set with the @option{-W/-w} option. A limited overflow may occur with
2584 numbered single column output (compare @option{-n} option).
2587 @itemx --no-file-warnings
2589 @opindex --no-file-warnings
2590 Do not print a warning message when an argument @var{file} cannot be
2591 opened. (The exit status will still be nonzero, however.)
2593 @item -s[@var{char}]
2594 @itemx --separator[=@var{char}]
2596 @opindex --separator
2597 Separate columns by a single character @var{char}. The default for
2598 @var{char} is the TAB character without @option{-w} and @samp{no
2599 character} with @option{-w}. Without @option{-s} the default separator
2600 @samp{space} is set. @option{-s[char]} turns off line truncation of all
2601 three column options (@option{-COLUMN}|@option{-a -COLUMN}|@option{-m}) unless
2602 @option{-w} is set. This is a POSIX-compliant formulation.
2605 @item -S[@var{string}]
2606 @itemx --sep-string[=@var{string}]
2608 @opindex --sep-string
2609 Use @var{string} to separate output columns. The @option{-S} option doesn't
2610 affect the @option{-W/-w} option, unlike the @option{-s} option which does. It
2611 does not affect line truncation or column alignment.
2612 Without @option{-S}, and with @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses the default output
2614 Without @option{-S} or @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses a @samp{space}
2615 (same as @option{-S"@w{ }"}).
2616 If no @samp{@var{string}} argument is specified, @samp{""} is assumed.
2619 @itemx --omit-header
2621 @opindex --omit-header
2622 Do not print the usual header [and footer] on each page, and do not fill
2623 out the bottom of pages (with blank lines or a form feed). No page
2624 structure is produced, but form feeds set in the input files are retained.
2625 The predefined pagination is not changed. @option{-t} or @option{-T} may be
2626 useful together with other options; e.g.: @option{-t -e4}, expand TAB characters
2627 in the input file to 4 spaces but don't make any other changes. Use of
2628 @option{-t} overrides @option{-h}.
2631 @itemx --omit-pagination
2633 @opindex --omit-pagination
2634 Do not print header [and footer]. In addition eliminate all form feeds
2635 set in the input files.
2638 @itemx --show-nonprinting
2640 @opindex --show-nonprinting
2641 Print nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation.
2643 @item -w @var{page_width}
2644 @itemx --width=@var{page_width}
2647 Set page width to @var{page_width} characters for multiple text-column
2648 output only (default for @var{page_width} is 72). The specified
2649 @var{page_width} is rounded down so that columns have equal width.
2650 @option{-s[CHAR]} turns off the default page width and any line truncation
2651 and column alignment.
2652 Lines of full length are merged, regardless of the column options
2653 set. No @var{page_width} setting is possible with single column output.
2654 A POSIX-compliant formulation.
2656 @item -W @var{page_width}
2657 @itemx --page_width=@var{page_width}
2659 @opindex --page_width
2660 Set the page width to @var{page_width} characters, honored with and
2661 without a column option. With a column option, the specified @var{page_width}
2662 is rounded down so that columns have equal width. Text lines are truncated,
2663 unless @option{-J} is used. Together with one of the three column options
2664 (@option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}) column
2665 alignment is always used. The separator options @option{-S} or @option{-s}
2666 don't disable the @option{-W} option. Default is 72 characters. Without
2667 @option{-W @var{page_width}} and without any of the column options NO line
2668 truncation is used (defined to keep downward compatibility and to meet
2669 most frequent tasks). That's equivalent to @option{-W 72 -J}@. The header
2670 line is never truncated.
2677 @node fold invocation
2678 @section @command{fold}: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
2681 @cindex wrapping long input lines
2682 @cindex folding long input lines
2684 @command{fold} writes each @var{file} (@option{-} means standard input), or
2685 standard input if none are given, to standard output, breaking long
2689 fold [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2692 By default, @command{fold} breaks lines wider than 80 columns. The output
2693 is split into as many lines as necessary.
2695 @cindex screen columns
2696 @command{fold} counts screen columns by default; thus, a tab may count more
2697 than one column, backspace decreases the column count, and carriage
2698 return sets the column to zero.
2700 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2708 Count bytes rather than columns, so that tabs, backspaces, and carriage
2709 returns are each counted as taking up one column, just like other
2716 Break at word boundaries: the line is broken after the last blank before
2717 the maximum line length. If the line contains no such blanks, the line
2718 is broken at the maximum line length as usual.
2720 @item -w @var{width}
2721 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2724 Use a maximum line length of @var{width} columns instead of 80.
2726 For compatibility @command{fold} supports an obsolete option syntax
2727 @option{-@var{width}}. New scripts should use @option{-w @var{width}}
2735 @node Output of parts of files
2736 @chapter Output of parts of files
2738 @cindex output of parts of files
2739 @cindex parts of files, output of
2741 These commands output pieces of the input.
2744 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
2745 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
2746 * split invocation:: Split a file into pieces.
2747 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
2750 @node head invocation
2751 @section @command{head}: Output the first part of files
2754 @cindex initial part of files, outputting
2755 @cindex first part of files, outputting
2757 @command{head} prints the first part (10 lines by default) of each
2758 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2759 when given a @var{file} of @option{-}. Synopsis:
2762 head [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2765 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{head} prints a
2766 one-line header consisting of:
2769 ==> @var{file name} <==
2773 before the output for each @var{file}.
2775 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2780 @itemx --bytes=@var{k}
2783 Print the first @var{k} bytes, instead of initial lines.
2784 However, if @var{k} starts with a @samp{-},
2785 print all but the last @var{k} bytes of each file.
2786 @multiplierSuffixes{k}
2789 @itemx --lines=@var{k}
2792 Output the first @var{k} lines.
2793 However, if @var{k} starts with a @samp{-},
2794 print all but the last @var{k} lines of each file.
2795 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2803 Never print file name headers.
2809 Always print file name headers.
2813 For compatibility @command{head} also supports an obsolete option syntax
2814 @option{-@var{count}@var{options}}, which is recognized only if it is
2815 specified first. @var{count} is a decimal number optionally followed
2816 by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{k}, @samp{m}) as in @option{-c}, or
2817 @samp{l} to mean count by lines, or other option letters (@samp{cqv}).
2818 Scripts intended for standard hosts should use @option{-c @var{count}}
2819 or @option{-n @var{count}} instead. If your script must also run on
2820 hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, it is usually simpler to
2821 avoid @command{head}, e.g., by using @samp{sed 5q} instead of
2827 @node tail invocation
2828 @section @command{tail}: Output the last part of files
2831 @cindex last part of files, outputting
2833 @command{tail} prints the last part (10 lines by default) of each
2834 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2835 when given a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
2838 tail [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2841 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{tail} prints a
2842 one-line header consisting of:
2845 ==> @var{file name} <==
2849 before the output for each @var{file}.
2851 @cindex BSD @command{tail}
2852 GNU @command{tail} can output any amount of data (some other versions of
2853 @command{tail} cannot). It also has no @option{-r} option (print in
2854 reverse), since reversing a file is really a different job from printing
2855 the end of a file; BSD @command{tail} (which is the one with @option{-r}) can
2856 only reverse files that are at most as large as its buffer, which is
2857 typically 32 KiB@. A more reliable and versatile way to reverse files is
2858 the GNU @command{tac} command.
2860 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2865 @itemx --bytes=@var{k}
2868 Output the last @var{k} bytes, instead of final lines.
2869 However, if @var{k} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2870 @var{k}th byte from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2871 @multiplierSuffixes{k}
2874 @itemx --follow[=@var{how}]
2877 @cindex growing files
2878 @vindex name @r{follow option}
2879 @vindex descriptor @r{follow option}
2880 Loop forever trying to read more characters at the end of the file,
2881 presumably because the file is growing.
2882 If more than one file is given, @command{tail} prints a header whenever it
2883 gets output from a different file, to indicate which file that output is
2886 There are two ways to specify how you'd like to track files with this option,
2887 but that difference is noticeable only when a followed file is removed or
2889 If you'd like to continue to track the end of a growing file even after
2890 it has been unlinked, use @option{--follow=descriptor}. This is the default
2891 behavior, but it is not useful if you're tracking a log file that may be
2892 rotated (removed or renamed, then reopened). In that case, use
2893 @option{--follow=name} to track the named file, perhaps by reopening it
2894 periodically to see if it has been removed and recreated by some other program.
2895 Note that the inotify-based implementation handles this case without
2896 the need for any periodic reopening.
2898 No matter which method you use, if the tracked file is determined to have
2899 shrunk, @command{tail} prints a message saying the file has been truncated
2900 and resumes tracking the end of the file from the newly-determined endpoint.
2902 When a file is removed, @command{tail}'s behavior depends on whether it is
2903 following the name or the descriptor. When following by name, tail can
2904 detect that a file has been removed and gives a message to that effect,
2905 and if @option{--retry} has been specified it will continue checking
2906 periodically to see if the file reappears.
2907 When following a descriptor, tail does not detect that the file has
2908 been unlinked or renamed and issues no message; even though the file
2909 may no longer be accessible via its original name, it may still be
2912 The option values @samp{descriptor} and @samp{name} may be specified only
2913 with the long form of the option, not with @option{-f}.
2915 The @option{-f} option is ignored if
2916 no @var{file} operand is specified and standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
2917 Likewise, the @option{-f} option has no effect for any
2918 operand specified as @samp{-}, when standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
2920 With kernel inotify support, output is triggered by file changes
2921 and is generally very prompt.
2922 Otherwise, @command{tail} sleeps for one second between checks---
2923 use @option{--sleep-interval=@var{n}} to change that default---which can
2924 make the output appear slightly less responsive or bursty.
2925 When using tail without inotify support, you can make it more responsive
2926 by using a sub-second sleep interval, e.g., via an alias like this:
2929 alias tail='tail -s.1'
2934 This option is the same as @option{--follow=name --retry}. That is, tail
2935 will attempt to reopen a file when it is removed. Should this fail, tail
2936 will keep trying until it becomes accessible again.
2940 Indefinitely try to open the specified file.
2941 This option is useful mainly when following (and otherwise issues a warning).
2943 When following by file descriptor (i.e., with @option{--follow=descriptor}),
2944 this option only affects the initial open of the file, as after a successful
2945 open, @command{tail} will start following the file descriptor.
2947 When following by name (i.e., with @option{--follow=name}), @command{tail}
2948 infinitely retries to re-open the given files until killed.
2950 Without this option, when @command{tail} encounters a file that doesn't
2951 exist or is otherwise inaccessible, it reports that fact and
2952 never checks it again.
2954 @item --sleep-interval=@var{number}
2955 @opindex --sleep-interval
2956 Change the number of seconds to wait between iterations (the default is 1.0).
2957 During one iteration, every specified file is checked to see if it has
2959 Historical implementations of @command{tail} have required that
2960 @var{number} be an integer. However, GNU @command{tail} accepts
2961 an arbitrary floating point number. @xref{Floating point}.
2962 When @command{tail} uses inotify, this polling-related option
2963 is usually ignored. However, if you also specify @option{--pid=@var{p}},
2964 @command{tail} checks whether process @var{p} is alive at least
2965 every @var{number} seconds.
2967 @item --pid=@var{pid}
2969 When following by name or by descriptor, you may specify the process ID,
2970 @var{pid}, of the sole writer of all @var{file} arguments. Then, shortly
2971 after that process terminates, tail will also terminate. This will
2972 work properly only if the writer and the tailing process are running on
2973 the same machine. For example, to save the output of a build in a file
2974 and to watch the file grow, if you invoke @command{make} and @command{tail}
2975 like this then the tail process will stop when your build completes.
2976 Without this option, you would have had to kill the @code{tail -f}
2980 $ make >& makerr & tail --pid=$! -f makerr
2983 If you specify a @var{pid} that is not in use or that does not correspond
2984 to the process that is writing to the tailed files, then @command{tail}
2985 may terminate long before any @var{file}s stop growing or it may not
2986 terminate until long after the real writer has terminated.
2987 Note that @option{--pid} cannot be supported on some systems; @command{tail}
2988 will print a warning if this is the case.
2990 @item --max-unchanged-stats=@var{n}
2991 @opindex --max-unchanged-stats
2992 When tailing a file by name, if there have been @var{n} (default
2993 n=@value{DEFAULT_MAX_N_UNCHANGED_STATS_BETWEEN_OPENS}) consecutive
2994 iterations for which the file has not changed, then
2995 @code{open}/@code{fstat} the file to determine if that file name is
2996 still associated with the same device/inode-number pair as before.
2997 When following a log file that is rotated, this is approximately the
2998 number of seconds between when tail prints the last pre-rotation lines
2999 and when it prints the lines that have accumulated in the new log file.
3000 This option is meaningful only when polling (i.e., without inotify)
3001 and when following by name.
3004 @itemx --lines=@var{k}
3007 Output the last @var{k} lines.
3008 However, if @var{k} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
3009 @var{k}th line from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
3010 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
3018 Never print file name headers.
3024 Always print file name headers.
3028 For compatibility @command{tail} also supports an obsolete usage
3029 @samp{tail -[@var{count}][bcl][f] [@var{file}]}, which is recognized
3030 only if it does not conflict with the usage described
3031 above. This obsolete form uses exactly one option and at most one
3032 file. In the option, @var{count} is an optional decimal number optionally
3033 followed by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{c}, @samp{l}) to mean count
3034 by 512-byte blocks, bytes, or lines, optionally followed by @samp{f}
3035 which has the same meaning as @option{-f}.
3037 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
3038 On older systems, the leading @samp{-} can be replaced by @samp{+} in
3039 the obsolete option syntax with the same meaning as in counts, and
3040 obsolete usage overrides normal usage when the two conflict.
3041 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
3042 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
3045 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
3046 syntax and should use @option{-c @var{count}[b]}, @option{-n
3047 @var{count}}, and/or @option{-f} instead. If your script must also
3048 run on hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, you can often
3049 rewrite it to avoid problematic usages, e.g., by using @samp{sed -n
3050 '$p'} rather than @samp{tail -1}. If that's not possible, the script
3051 can use a test like @samp{if tail -c +1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1;
3052 then @dots{}} to decide which syntax to use.
3054 Even if your script assumes the standard behavior, you should still
3055 beware usages whose behaviors differ depending on the POSIX
3056 version. For example, avoid @samp{tail - main.c}, since it might be
3057 interpreted as either @samp{tail main.c} or as @samp{tail -- -
3058 main.c}; avoid @samp{tail -c 4}, since it might mean either @samp{tail
3059 -c4} or @samp{tail -c 10 4}; and avoid @samp{tail +4}, since it might
3060 mean either @samp{tail ./+4} or @samp{tail -n +4}.
3065 @node split invocation
3066 @section @command{split}: Split a file into pieces.
3069 @cindex splitting a file into pieces
3070 @cindex pieces, splitting a file into
3072 @command{split} creates output files containing consecutive or interleaved
3073 sections of @var{input} (standard input if none is given or @var{input}
3074 is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
3077 split [@var{option}] [@var{input} [@var{prefix}]]
3080 By default, @command{split} puts 1000 lines of @var{input} (or whatever is
3081 left over for the last section), into each output file.
3083 @cindex output file name prefix
3084 The output files' names consist of @var{prefix} (@samp{x} by default)
3085 followed by a group of characters (@samp{aa}, @samp{ab}, @dots{} by
3086 default), such that concatenating the output files in traditional
3087 sorted order by file name produces the original input file (except
3088 @option{-nr/@var{n}}). By default split will initially create files
3089 with two generated suffix characters, and will increase this width by two
3090 when the next most significant position reaches the last character.
3091 (@samp{yz}, @samp{zaaa}, @samp{zaab}, @dots{}). In this way an arbitrary
3092 number of output files are supported, which sort as described above,
3093 even in the presence of an @option{--additional-suffix} option.
3094 If the @option{-a} option is specified and the output file names are
3095 exhausted, @command{split} reports an error without deleting the
3096 output files that it did create.
3098 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3102 @item -l @var{lines}
3103 @itemx --lines=@var{lines}
3106 Put @var{lines} lines of @var{input} into each output file.
3107 If @option{--separator} is specified, then @var{lines} determines
3108 the number of records.
3110 For compatibility @command{split} also supports an obsolete
3111 option syntax @option{-@var{lines}}. New scripts should use
3112 @option{-l @var{lines}} instead.
3115 @itemx --bytes=@var{size}
3118 Put @var{size} bytes of @var{input} into each output file.
3119 @multiplierSuffixes{size}
3122 @itemx --line-bytes=@var{size}
3124 @opindex --line-bytes
3125 Put into each output file as many complete lines of @var{input} as
3126 possible without exceeding @var{size} bytes. Individual lines or records
3127 longer than @var{size} bytes are broken into multiple files.
3128 @var{size} has the same format as for the @option{--bytes} option.
3129 If @option{--separator} is specified, then @var{lines} determines
3130 the number of records.
3132 @item --filter=@var{command}
3134 With this option, rather than simply writing to each output file,
3135 write through a pipe to the specified shell @var{command} for each output file.
3136 @var{command} should use the $FILE environment variable, which is set
3137 to a different output file name for each invocation of the command.
3138 For example, imagine that you have a 1TiB compressed file
3139 that, if uncompressed, would be too large to reside on disk,
3140 yet you must split it into individually-compressed pieces
3141 of a more manageable size.
3142 To do that, you might run this command:
3145 xz -dc BIG.xz | split -b200G --filter='xz > $FILE.xz' - big-
3148 Assuming a 10:1 compression ratio, that would create about fifty 20GiB files
3149 with names @file{big-aa.xz}, @file{big-ab.xz}, @file{big-ac.xz}, etc.
3151 @item -n @var{chunks}
3152 @itemx --number=@var{chunks}
3156 Split @var{input} to @var{chunks} output files where @var{chunks} may be:
3159 @var{n} generate @var{n} files based on current size of @var{input}
3160 @var{k}/@var{n} only output @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3161 l/@var{n} generate @var{n} files without splitting lines or records
3162 l/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but only output @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3163 r/@var{n} like @samp{l} but use round robin distribution
3164 r/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but only output @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3167 Any excess bytes remaining after dividing the @var{input}
3168 into @var{n} chunks, are assigned to the last chunk.
3169 Any excess bytes appearing after the initial calculation are discarded
3170 (except when using @samp{r} mode).
3172 All @var{n} files are created even if there are fewer than @var{n} lines,
3173 or the @var{input} is truncated.
3175 For @samp{l} mode, chunks are approximately @var{input} size / @var{n}.
3176 The @var{input} is partitioned into @var{n} equal sized portions, with
3177 the last assigned any excess. If a line @emph{starts} within a partition
3178 it is written completely to the corresponding file. Since lines or records
3179 are not split even if they overlap a partition, the files written
3180 can be larger or smaller than the partition size, and even empty
3181 if a line/record is so long as to completely overlap the partition.
3183 For @samp{r} mode, the size of @var{input} is irrelevant,
3184 and so can be a pipe for example.
3186 @item -a @var{length}
3187 @itemx --suffix-length=@var{length}
3189 @opindex --suffix-length
3190 Use suffixes of length @var{length}. If a @var{length} of 0 is specified,
3191 this is the same as if (any previous) @option{-a} was not specified, and
3192 thus enables the default behavior, which starts the suffix length at 2,
3193 and unless @option{-n} or @option{--numeric-suffixes=@var{from}} is
3194 specified, will auto increase the length by 2 as required.
3197 @itemx --numeric-suffixes[=@var{from}]
3199 @opindex --numeric-suffixes
3200 Use digits in suffixes rather than lower-case letters. The numerical
3201 suffix counts from @var{from} if specified, 0 otherwise.
3203 @var{from} is supported with the long form option, and is used to either set the
3204 initial suffix for a single run, or to set the suffix offset for independently
3205 split inputs, and consequently the auto suffix length expansion described above
3206 is disabled. Therefore you may also want to use option @option{-a} to allow
3207 suffixes beyond @samp{99}. Note if option @option{--number} is specified and
3208 the number of files is less than @var{from}, a single run is assumed and the
3209 minimum suffix length required is automatically determined.
3211 @item --additional-suffix=@var{suffix}
3212 @opindex --additional-suffix
3213 Append an additional @var{suffix} to output file names. @var{suffix}
3214 must not contain slash.
3217 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3219 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3220 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. This can happen
3221 with the @option{--number} option if a file is (truncated to be) shorter
3222 than the number requested, or if a line is so long as to completely
3223 span a chunk. The output file sequence numbers, always run consecutively
3224 even when this option is specified.
3226 @item -t @var{separator}
3227 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
3229 @opindex --separator
3230 @cindex line separator character
3231 @cindex record separator character
3232 Use character @var{separator} as the record separator instead of the default
3233 newline character (ASCII LF).
3234 To specify ASCII NUL as the separator, use the two-character string @samp{\0},
3235 e.g., @samp{split -t '\0'}.
3240 @opindex --unbuffered
3241 Immediately copy input to output in @option{--number r/@dots{}} mode,
3242 which is a much slower mode of operation.
3246 Write a diagnostic just before each output file is opened.
3252 Here are a few examples to illustrate how the
3253 @option{--number} (@option{-n}) option works:
3255 Notice how, by default, one line may be split onto two or more:
3258 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -n3 k; head xa?
3271 Use the "l/" modifier to suppress that:
3274 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nl/3 k; head xa?
3287 Use the "r/" modifier to distribute lines in a round-robin fashion:
3290 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nr/3 k; head xa?
3303 You can also extract just the Kth chunk.
3304 This extracts and prints just the 7th "chunk" of 33:
3307 $ seq 100 > k; split -nl/7/33 k
3314 @node csplit invocation
3315 @section @command{csplit}: Split a file into context-determined pieces
3318 @cindex context splitting
3319 @cindex splitting a file into pieces by context
3321 @command{csplit} creates zero or more output files containing sections of
3322 @var{input} (standard input if @var{input} is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
3325 csplit [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{input} @var{pattern}@dots{}
3328 The contents of the output files are determined by the @var{pattern}
3329 arguments, as detailed below. An error occurs if a @var{pattern}
3330 argument refers to a nonexistent line of the input file (e.g., if no
3331 remaining line matches a given regular expression). After every
3332 @var{pattern} has been matched, any remaining input is copied into one
3335 By default, @command{csplit} prints the number of bytes written to each
3336 output file after it has been created.
3338 The types of pattern arguments are:
3343 Create an output file containing the input up to but not including line
3344 @var{n} (a positive integer). If followed by a repeat count, also
3345 create an output file containing the next @var{n} lines of the input
3346 file once for each repeat.
3348 @item /@var{regexp}/[@var{offset}]
3349 Create an output file containing the current line up to (but not
3350 including) the next line of the input file that contains a match for
3351 @var{regexp}. The optional @var{offset} is an integer.
3352 If it is given, the input up to (but not including) the
3353 matching line plus or minus @var{offset} is put into the output file,
3354 and the line after that begins the next section of input.
3356 @item %@var{regexp}%[@var{offset}]
3357 Like the previous type, except that it does not create an output
3358 file, so that section of the input file is effectively ignored.
3360 @item @{@var{repeat-count}@}
3361 Repeat the previous pattern @var{repeat-count} additional
3362 times. The @var{repeat-count} can either be a positive integer or an
3363 asterisk, meaning repeat as many times as necessary until the input is
3368 The output files' names consist of a prefix (@samp{xx} by default)
3369 followed by a suffix. By default, the suffix is an ascending sequence
3370 of two-digit decimal numbers from @samp{00} to @samp{99}. In any case,
3371 concatenating the output files in sorted order by file name produces the
3372 original input file.
3374 By default, if @command{csplit} encounters an error or receives a hangup,
3375 interrupt, quit, or terminate signal, it removes any output files
3376 that it has created so far before it exits.
3378 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3382 @item -f @var{prefix}
3383 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
3386 @cindex output file name prefix
3387 Use @var{prefix} as the output file name prefix.
3389 @item -b @var{suffix}
3390 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
3393 @cindex output file name suffix
3394 Use @var{suffix} as the output file name suffix. When this option is
3395 specified, the suffix string must include exactly one
3396 @code{printf(3)}-style conversion specification, possibly including
3397 format specification flags, a field width, a precision specifications,
3398 or all of these kinds of modifiers. The format letter must convert a
3399 binary unsigned integer argument to readable form. The format letters
3400 @samp{d} and @samp{i} are aliases for @samp{u}, and the
3401 @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{x}, and @samp{X} conversions are allowed. The
3402 entire @var{suffix} is given (with the current output file number) to
3403 @code{sprintf(3)} to form the file name suffixes for each of the
3404 individual output files in turn. If this option is used, the
3405 @option{--digits} option is ignored.
3407 @item -n @var{digits}
3408 @itemx --digits=@var{digits}
3411 Use output file names containing numbers that are @var{digits} digits
3412 long instead of the default 2.
3417 @opindex --keep-files
3418 Do not remove output files when errors are encountered.
3420 @item --suppress-matched
3421 @opindex --suppress-matched
3422 Do not output lines matching the specified @var{pattern}.
3423 I.e., suppress the boundary line from the start of the second
3424 and subsequent splits.
3427 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3429 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3430 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. (In cases where
3431 the section delimiters of the input file are supposed to mark the first
3432 lines of each of the sections, the first output file will generally be a
3433 zero-length file unless you use this option.) The output file sequence
3434 numbers always run consecutively starting from 0, even when this option
3445 Do not print counts of output file sizes.
3451 Here is an example of its usage.
3452 First, create an empty directory for the exercise,
3459 Now, split the sequence of 1..14 on lines that end with 0 or 5:
3462 $ seq 14 | csplit - '/[05]$/' '@{*@}'
3468 Each number printed above is the size of an output
3469 file that csplit has just created.
3470 List the names of those output files:
3477 Use @command{head} to show their contents:
3502 Example of splitting input by empty lines:
3505 $ csplit --suppress-matched @var{input.txt} '/^$/' '@{*@}'
3509 @c TODO: "uniq" already supports "--group".
3510 @c when it gets the "--key" option, uncomment this example.
3512 @c Example of splitting input file, based on the value of column 2:
3515 @c $ cat @var{input.txt} |
3517 @c uniq --group -k2,2 |
3518 @c csplit -m '/^$/' '@{*@}'
3521 @node Summarizing files
3522 @chapter Summarizing files
3524 @cindex summarizing files
3526 These commands generate just a few numbers representing entire
3530 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
3531 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
3532 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
3533 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
3534 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
3535 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
3540 @section @command{wc}: Print newline, word, and byte counts
3544 @cindex character count
3548 @command{wc} counts the number of bytes, characters, whitespace-separated
3549 words, and newlines in each given @var{file}, or standard input if none
3550 are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3553 wc [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3556 @cindex total counts
3557 @command{wc} prints one line of counts for each file, and if the file was
3558 given as an argument, it prints the file name following the counts. If
3559 more than one @var{file} is given, @command{wc} prints a final line
3560 containing the cumulative counts, with the file name @file{total}. The
3561 counts are printed in this order: newlines, words, characters, bytes,
3562 maximum line length.
3563 Each count is printed right-justified in a field with at least one
3564 space between fields so that the numbers and file names normally line
3565 up nicely in columns. The width of the count fields varies depending
3566 on the inputs, so you should not depend on a particular field width.
3567 However, as a GNU extension, if only one count is printed,
3568 it is guaranteed to be printed without leading spaces.
3570 By default, @command{wc} prints three counts: the newline, words, and byte
3571 counts. Options can specify that only certain counts be printed.
3572 Options do not undo others previously given, so
3579 prints both the byte counts and the word counts.
3581 With the @option{--max-line-length} option, @command{wc} prints the length
3582 of the longest line per file, and if there is more than one file it
3583 prints the maximum (not the sum) of those lengths. The line lengths here
3584 are measured in screen columns, according to the current locale and
3585 assuming tab positions in every 8th column.
3587 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3595 Print only the byte counts.
3601 Print only the character counts.
3607 Print only the word counts.
3613 Print only the newline counts.
3616 @itemx --max-line-length
3618 @opindex --max-line-length
3619 Print only the maximum display widths.
3620 Tabs are set at every 8th column.
3621 Display widths of wide characters are considered.
3622 Non-printable characters are given 0 width.
3624 @macro filesZeroFromOption{cmd,withTotalOption,subListOutput}
3625 @item --files0-from=@var{file}
3626 @opindex --files0-from=@var{file}
3627 @c This is commented out to avoid a texi2dvi failure.
3628 @c texi2dvi (GNU Texinfo 4.11) 1.104
3629 @c @cindex including files from @command{\cmd\}
3630 Disallow processing files named on the command line, and instead process
3631 those named in file @var{file}; each name being terminated by a zero byte
3633 This is useful \withTotalOption\
3634 when the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
3636 In such cases, running @command{\cmd\} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
3637 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{\cmd\} print
3638 \subListOutput\ for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
3639 One way to produce a list of ASCII NUL terminated file
3641 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate.
3642 If @var{file} is @samp{-} then the ASCII NUL terminated
3643 file names are read from standard input.
3645 @filesZeroFromOption{wc,,a total}
3647 For example, to find the length of the longest line in any @file{.c} or
3648 @file{.h} file in the current hierarchy, do this:
3651 find . -name '*.[ch]' -print0 |
3652 wc -L --files0-from=- | tail -n1
3660 @node sum invocation
3661 @section @command{sum}: Print checksum and block counts
3664 @cindex 16-bit checksum
3665 @cindex checksum, 16-bit
3667 @command{sum} computes a 16-bit checksum for each given @var{file}, or
3668 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3671 sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3674 @command{sum} prints the checksum for each @var{file} followed by the
3675 number of blocks in the file (rounded up). If more than one @var{file}
3676 is given, file names are also printed (by default). (With the
3677 @option{--sysv} option, corresponding file names are printed when there is
3678 at least one file argument.)
3680 By default, GNU @command{sum} computes checksums using an algorithm
3681 compatible with BSD @command{sum} and prints file sizes in units of
3684 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3690 @cindex BSD @command{sum}
3691 Use the default (BSD compatible) algorithm. This option is included for
3692 compatibility with the System V @command{sum}. Unless @option{-s} was also
3693 given, it has no effect.
3699 @cindex System V @command{sum}
3700 Compute checksums using an algorithm compatible with System V
3701 @command{sum}'s default, and print file sizes in units of 512-byte blocks.
3705 @command{sum} is provided for compatibility; the @command{cksum} program (see
3706 next section) is preferable in new applications.
3711 @node cksum invocation
3712 @section @command{cksum}: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
3715 @cindex cyclic redundancy check
3716 @cindex CRC checksum
3718 @command{cksum} computes a cyclic redundancy check (CRC) checksum for each
3719 given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given or for a
3720 @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3723 cksum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3726 @command{cksum} prints the CRC checksum for each file along with the number
3727 of bytes in the file, and the file name unless no arguments were given.
3729 @command{cksum} is typically used to ensure that files
3730 transferred by unreliable means (e.g., netnews) have not been corrupted,
3731 by comparing the @command{cksum} output for the received files with the
3732 @command{cksum} output for the original files (typically given in the
3735 The CRC algorithm is specified by the POSIX standard. It is not
3736 compatible with the BSD or System V @command{sum} algorithms (see the
3737 previous section); it is more robust.
3739 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
3745 @node md5sum invocation
3746 @section @command{md5sum}: Print or check MD5 digests
3750 @cindex 128-bit checksum
3751 @cindex checksum, 128-bit
3752 @cindex fingerprint, 128-bit
3753 @cindex message-digest, 128-bit
3755 @command{md5sum} computes a 128-bit checksum (or @dfn{fingerprint} or
3756 @dfn{message-digest}) for each specified @var{file}.
3758 Note: The MD5 digest is more reliable than a simple CRC (provided by
3759 the @command{cksum} command) for detecting accidental file corruption,
3760 as the chances of accidentally having two files with identical MD5
3761 are vanishingly small. However, it should not be considered secure
3762 against malicious tampering: although finding a file with a given MD5
3763 fingerprint is considered infeasible at the moment, it is known how
3764 to modify certain files, including digital certificates, so that they
3765 appear valid when signed with an MD5 digest.
3766 For more secure hashes, consider using SHA-2. @xref{sha2 utilities}.
3768 If a @var{file} is specified as @samp{-} or if no files are given
3769 @command{md5sum} computes the checksum for the standard input.
3770 @command{md5sum} can also determine whether a file and checksum are
3771 consistent. Synopsis:
3774 md5sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3777 For each @var{file}, @samp{md5sum} outputs by default, the MD5 checksum,
3778 a space, a flag indicating binary or text input mode, and the file name.
3779 Binary mode is indicated with @samp{*}, text mode with @samp{ } (space).
3780 Binary mode is the default on systems where it's significant,
3781 otherwise text mode is the default.
3782 If @var{file} contains a backslash or newline, the
3783 line is started with a backslash, and each problematic character in
3784 the file name is escaped with a backslash, making the output
3785 unambiguous even in the presence of arbitrary file names.
3786 If @var{file} is omitted or specified as @samp{-}, standard input is read.
3788 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3796 @cindex binary input files
3797 Treat each input file as binary, by reading it in binary mode and
3798 outputting a @samp{*} flag. This is the inverse of @option{--text}.
3799 On systems like GNU that do not distinguish between binary
3800 and text files, this option merely flags each input mode as binary:
3801 the MD5 checksum is unaffected. This option is the default on systems
3802 like MS-DOS that distinguish between binary and text files, except
3803 for reading standard input when standard input is a terminal.
3807 Read file names and checksum information (not data) from each
3808 @var{file} (or from stdin if no @var{file} was specified) and report
3809 whether the checksums match the contents of the named files.
3810 The input to this mode of @command{md5sum} is usually the output of
3811 a prior, checksum-generating run of @samp{md5sum}.
3812 Three input formats are supported. Either the default output
3813 format described above, the @option{--tag} output format,
3814 or the BSD reversed mode format which is similar to the default mode,
3815 but doesn't use a character to distinguish binary and text modes.
3817 For each such line, @command{md5sum} reads the named file and computes its
3818 MD5 checksum. Then, if the computed message digest does not match the
3819 one on the line with the file name, the file is noted as having
3820 failed the test. Otherwise, the file passes the test.
3821 By default, for each valid line, one line is written to standard
3822 output indicating whether the named file passed the test.
3823 After all checks have been performed, if there were any failures,
3824 a warning is issued to standard error.
3825 Use the @option{--status} option to inhibit that output.
3826 If any listed file cannot be opened or read, if any valid line has
3827 an MD5 checksum inconsistent with the associated file, or if no valid
3828 line is found, @command{md5sum} exits with nonzero status. Otherwise,
3829 it exits successfully.
3833 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3834 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3835 When verifying checksums, don't generate an 'OK' message per successfully
3836 checked file. Files that fail the verification are reported in the
3837 default one-line-per-file format. If there is any checksum mismatch,
3838 print a warning summarizing the failures to standard error.
3842 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3843 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3844 When verifying checksums, don't generate the default one-line-per-file
3845 diagnostic and don't output the warning summarizing any failures.
3846 Failures to open or read a file still evoke individual diagnostics to
3848 If all listed files are readable and are consistent with the associated
3849 MD5 checksums, exit successfully. Otherwise exit with a status code
3850 indicating there was a failure.
3855 Output BSD style checksums, which indicate the checksum algorithm used.
3856 As a GNU extension, file names with problematic characters
3857 are escaped as described above, with the same escaping indicator of @samp{\}
3858 at the start of the line, being used.
3859 The @option{--tag} option implies binary mode, and is disallowed with
3860 @option{--text} mode as supporting that would unnecessarily complicate
3861 the output format, while providing little benefit.
3867 @cindex text input files
3868 Treat each input file as text, by reading it in text mode and
3869 outputting a @samp{ } flag. This is the inverse of @option{--binary}.
3870 This option is the default on systems like GNU that do not
3871 distinguish between binary and text files. On other systems, it is
3872 the default for reading standard input when standard input is a
3873 terminal. This mode is never defaulted to if @option{--tag} is used.
3879 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3880 When verifying checksums, warn about improperly formatted MD5 checksum lines.
3881 This option is useful only if all but a few lines in the checked input
3886 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3887 When verifying checksums,
3888 if one or more input line is invalid,
3889 exit nonzero after all warnings have been issued.
3896 @node sha1sum invocation
3897 @section @command{sha1sum}: Print or check SHA-1 digests
3901 @cindex 160-bit checksum
3902 @cindex checksum, 160-bit
3903 @cindex fingerprint, 160-bit
3904 @cindex message-digest, 160-bit
3906 @command{sha1sum} computes a 160-bit checksum for each specified
3907 @var{file}. The usage and options of this command are precisely the
3908 same as for @command{md5sum}. @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3910 Note: The SHA-1 digest is more secure than MD5, and no collisions of
3911 it are known (different files having the same fingerprint). However,
3912 it is known that they can be produced with considerable, but not
3913 unreasonable, resources. For this reason, it is generally considered
3914 that SHA-1 should be gradually phased out in favor of the more secure
3915 SHA-2 hash algorithms. @xref{sha2 utilities}.
3918 @node sha2 utilities
3919 @section sha2 utilities: Print or check SHA-2 digests
3926 @cindex 224-bit checksum
3927 @cindex 256-bit checksum
3928 @cindex 384-bit checksum
3929 @cindex 512-bit checksum
3930 @cindex checksum, 224-bit
3931 @cindex checksum, 256-bit
3932 @cindex checksum, 384-bit
3933 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
3934 @cindex fingerprint, 224-bit
3935 @cindex fingerprint, 256-bit
3936 @cindex fingerprint, 384-bit
3937 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
3938 @cindex message-digest, 224-bit
3939 @cindex message-digest, 256-bit
3940 @cindex message-digest, 384-bit
3941 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
3943 The commands @command{sha224sum}, @command{sha256sum},
3944 @command{sha384sum} and @command{sha512sum} compute checksums of
3945 various lengths (respectively 224, 256, 384 and 512 bits),
3946 collectively known as the SHA-2 hashes. The usage and options of
3947 these commands are precisely the same as for @command{md5sum}
3948 and @command{sha1sum}.
3949 @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3951 Note: The SHA384 and SHA512 digests are considerably slower to
3952 compute, especially on 32-bit computers, than SHA224 or SHA256.
3955 @node Operating on sorted files
3956 @chapter Operating on sorted files
3958 @cindex operating on sorted files
3959 @cindex sorted files, operations on
3961 These commands work with (or produce) sorted files.
3964 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
3965 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
3966 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
3967 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
3968 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
3969 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
3973 @node sort invocation
3974 @section @command{sort}: Sort text files
3977 @cindex sorting files
3979 @command{sort} sorts, merges, or compares all the lines from the given
3980 files, or standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of
3981 @samp{-}. By default, @command{sort} writes the results to standard
3985 sort [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3988 @command{sort} has three modes of operation: sort (the default), merge,
3989 and check for sortedness. The following options change the operation
3996 @itemx --check=diagnose-first
3999 @cindex checking for sortedness
4000 Check whether the given file is already sorted: if it is not all
4001 sorted, print a diagnostic containing the first out-of-order line and
4002 exit with a status of 1.
4003 Otherwise, exit successfully.
4004 At most one input file can be given.
4007 @itemx --check=quiet
4008 @itemx --check=silent
4011 @cindex checking for sortedness
4012 Exit successfully if the given file is already sorted, and
4013 exit with status 1 otherwise.
4014 At most one input file can be given.
4015 This is like @option{-c}, except it does not print a diagnostic.
4021 @cindex merging sorted files
4022 Merge the given files by sorting them as a group. Each input file must
4023 always be individually sorted. It always works to sort instead of
4024 merge; merging is provided because it is faster, in the case where it
4029 @cindex sort stability
4030 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
4031 A pair of lines is compared as follows:
4032 @command{sort} compares each pair of fields, in the
4033 order specified on the command line, according to the associated
4034 ordering options, until a difference is found or no fields are left.
4035 If no key fields are specified, @command{sort} uses a default key of
4036 the entire line. Finally, as a last resort when all keys compare
4037 equal, @command{sort} compares entire lines as if no ordering options
4038 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) were specified. The
4039 @option{--stable} (@option{-s}) option disables this @dfn{last-resort
4040 comparison} so that lines in which all fields compare equal are left
4041 in their original relative order. The @option{--unique}
4042 (@option{-u}) option also disables the last-resort comparison.
4046 Unless otherwise specified, all comparisons use the character collating
4047 sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.@footnote{If you
4048 use a non-POSIX locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL}
4049 to @samp{en_US}), then @command{sort} may produce output that is sorted
4050 differently than you're accustomed to. In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL}
4051 environment variable to @samp{C}@. Note that setting only @env{LC_COLLATE}
4052 has two problems. First, it is ineffective if @env{LC_ALL} is also set.
4053 Second, it has undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} (or @env{LANG}, if
4054 @env{LC_CTYPE} is unset) is set to an incompatible value. For example,
4055 you get undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} is @code{ja_JP.PCK} but
4056 @env{LC_COLLATE} is @code{en_US.UTF-8}.}
4058 GNU @command{sort} (as specified for all GNU utilities) has no
4059 limit on input line length or restrictions on bytes allowed within lines.
4060 In addition, if the final byte of an input file is not a newline, GNU
4061 @command{sort} silently supplies one. A line's trailing newline is not
4062 part of the line for comparison purposes.
4064 @cindex exit status of @command{sort}
4068 0 if no error occurred
4069 1 if invoked with @option{-c} or @option{-C} and the input is not sorted
4070 2 if an error occurred
4074 If the environment variable @env{TMPDIR} is set, @command{sort} uses its
4075 value as the directory for temporary files instead of @file{/tmp}. The
4076 @option{--temporary-directory} (@option{-T}) option in turn overrides
4077 the environment variable.
4079 The following options affect the ordering of output lines. They may be
4080 specified globally or as part of a specific key field. If no key
4081 fields are specified, global options apply to comparison of entire
4082 lines; otherwise the global options are inherited by key fields that do
4083 not specify any special options of their own. In pre-POSIX
4084 versions of @command{sort}, global options affect only later key fields,
4085 so portable shell scripts should specify global options first.
4090 @itemx --ignore-leading-blanks
4092 @opindex --ignore-leading-blanks
4093 @cindex blanks, ignoring leading
4095 Ignore leading blanks when finding sort keys in each line.
4096 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4097 can change this. Note blanks may be ignored by your locale's collating
4098 rules, but without this option they will be significant for character
4099 positions specified in keys with the @option{-k} option.
4102 @itemx --dictionary-order
4104 @opindex --dictionary-order
4105 @cindex dictionary order
4106 @cindex phone directory order
4107 @cindex telephone directory order
4109 Sort in @dfn{phone directory} order: ignore all characters except
4110 letters, digits and blanks when sorting.
4111 By default letters and digits are those of ASCII and a blank
4112 is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale can change this.
4115 @itemx --ignore-case
4117 @opindex --ignore-case
4118 @cindex ignoring case
4119 @cindex case folding
4121 Fold lowercase characters into the equivalent uppercase characters when
4122 comparing so that, for example, @samp{b} and @samp{B} sort as equal.
4123 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
4124 When used with @option{--unique} those lower case equivalent lines are
4125 thrown away. (There is currently no way to throw away the upper case
4126 equivalent instead. (Any @option{--reverse} given would only affect
4127 the final result, after the throwing away.))
4130 @itemx --general-numeric-sort
4131 @itemx --sort=general-numeric
4133 @opindex --general-numeric-sort
4135 @cindex general numeric sort
4137 Sort numerically, converting a prefix of each line to a long
4138 double-precision floating point number. @xref{Floating point}.
4139 Do not report overflow, underflow, or conversion errors.
4140 Use the following collating sequence:
4144 Lines that do not start with numbers (all considered to be equal).
4146 NaNs (``Not a Number'' values, in IEEE floating point arithmetic)
4147 in a consistent but machine-dependent order.
4151 Finite numbers in ascending numeric order (with @math{-0} and @math{+0} equal).
4156 Use this option only if there is no alternative; it is much slower than
4157 @option{--numeric-sort} (@option{-n}) and it can lose information when
4158 converting to floating point.
4161 @itemx --human-numeric-sort
4162 @itemx --sort=human-numeric
4164 @opindex --human-numeric-sort
4166 @cindex human numeric sort
4168 Sort numerically, first by numeric sign (negative, zero, or positive);
4169 then by SI suffix (either empty, or @samp{k} or @samp{K}, or
4170 one of @samp{MGTPEZY}, in that order; @pxref{Block size}); and finally
4171 by numeric value. For example, @samp{1023M} sorts before @samp{1G}
4172 because @samp{M} (mega) precedes @samp{G} (giga) as an SI
4173 suffix. This option sorts values that are consistently scaled to the
4174 nearest suffix, regardless of whether suffixes denote powers of 1000
4175 or 1024, and it therefore sorts the output of any single invocation of
4176 the @command{df}, @command{du}, or @command{ls} commands that are
4177 invoked with their @option{--human-readable} or @option{--si} options.
4178 The syntax for numbers is the same as for the @option{--numeric-sort}
4179 option; the SI suffix must immediately follow the number.
4180 Note also the @command{numfmt} command, which can be used to reformat
4181 numbers to human format @emph{after} the sort, thus often allowing
4182 sort to operate on more accurate numbers.
4185 @itemx --ignore-nonprinting
4187 @opindex --ignore-nonprinting
4188 @cindex nonprinting characters, ignoring
4189 @cindex unprintable characters, ignoring
4191 Ignore nonprinting characters.
4192 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
4193 This option has no effect if the stronger @option{--dictionary-order}
4194 (@option{-d}) option is also given.
4200 @opindex --month-sort
4202 @cindex months, sorting by
4204 An initial string, consisting of any amount of blanks, followed
4205 by a month name abbreviation, is folded to UPPER case and
4206 compared in the order @samp{JAN} < @samp{FEB} < @dots{} < @samp{DEC}@.
4207 Invalid names compare low to valid names. The @env{LC_TIME} locale
4208 category determines the month spellings.
4209 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4213 @itemx --numeric-sort
4214 @itemx --sort=numeric
4216 @opindex --numeric-sort
4218 @cindex numeric sort
4220 Sort numerically. The number begins each line and consists
4221 of optional blanks, an optional @samp{-} sign, and zero or more
4222 digits possibly separated by thousands separators, optionally followed
4223 by a decimal-point character and zero or more digits. An empty
4224 number is treated as @samp{0}. The @env{LC_NUMERIC}
4225 locale specifies the decimal-point character and thousands separator.
4226 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4229 Comparison is exact; there is no rounding error.
4231 Neither a leading @samp{+} nor exponential notation is recognized.
4232 To compare such strings numerically, use the
4233 @option{--general-numeric-sort} (@option{-g}) option.
4236 @itemx --version-sort
4238 @opindex --version-sort
4239 @cindex version number sort
4240 Sort by version name and number. It behaves like a standard sort,
4241 except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
4242 as an index/version number. (@xref{Details about version sort}.)
4248 @cindex reverse sorting
4249 Reverse the result of comparison, so that lines with greater key values
4250 appear earlier in the output instead of later.
4253 @itemx --random-sort
4254 @itemx --sort=random
4256 @opindex --random-sort
4259 Sort by hashing the input keys and then sorting the hash values.
4260 Choose the hash function at random, ensuring that it is free of
4261 collisions so that differing keys have differing hash values. This is
4262 like a random permutation of the inputs (@pxref{shuf invocation}),
4263 except that keys with the same value sort together.
4265 If multiple random sort fields are specified, the same random hash
4266 function is used for all fields. To use different random hash
4267 functions for different fields, you can invoke @command{sort} more
4270 The choice of hash function is affected by the
4271 @option{--random-source} option.
4279 @item --compress-program=@var{prog}
4280 Compress any temporary files with the program @var{prog}.
4282 With no arguments, @var{prog} must compress standard input to standard
4283 output, and when given the @option{-d} option it must decompress
4284 standard input to standard output.
4286 Terminate with an error if @var{prog} exits with nonzero status.
4288 White space and the backslash character should not appear in
4289 @var{prog}; they are reserved for future use.
4291 @filesZeroFromOption{sort,,sorted output}
4293 @item -k @var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4294 @itemx --key=@var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4298 Specify a sort field that consists of the part of the line between
4299 @var{pos1} and @var{pos2} (or the end of the line, if @var{pos2} is
4300 omitted), @emph{inclusive}.
4302 Each @var{pos} has the form @samp{@var{f}[.@var{c}][@var{opts}]},
4303 where @var{f} is the number of the field to use, and @var{c} is the number
4304 of the first character from the beginning of the field. Fields and character
4305 positions are numbered starting with 1; a character position of zero in
4306 @var{pos2} indicates the field's last character. If @samp{.@var{c}} is
4307 omitted from @var{pos1}, it defaults to 1 (the beginning of the field);
4308 if omitted from @var{pos2}, it defaults to 0 (the end of the field).
4309 @var{opts} are ordering options, allowing individual keys to be sorted
4310 according to different rules; see below for details. Keys can span
4313 Example: To sort on the second field, use @option{--key=2,2}
4314 (@option{-k 2,2}). See below for more notes on keys and more examples.
4315 See also the @option{--debug} option to help determine the part
4316 of the line being used in the sort.
4319 Highlight the portion of each line used for sorting.
4320 Also issue warnings about questionable usage to stderr.
4322 @item --batch-size=@var{nmerge}
4323 @opindex --batch-size
4324 @cindex number of inputs to merge, nmerge
4325 Merge at most @var{nmerge} inputs at once.
4327 When @command{sort} has to merge more than @var{nmerge} inputs,
4328 it merges them in groups of @var{nmerge}, saving the result in
4329 a temporary file, which is then used as an input in a subsequent merge.
4331 A large value of @var{nmerge} may improve merge performance and decrease
4332 temporary storage utilization at the expense of increased memory usage
4333 and I/O@. Conversely a small value of @var{nmerge} may reduce memory
4334 requirements and I/O at the expense of temporary storage consumption and
4337 The value of @var{nmerge} must be at least 2. The default value is
4338 currently 16, but this is implementation-dependent and may change in
4341 The value of @var{nmerge} may be bounded by a resource limit for open
4342 file descriptors. The commands @samp{ulimit -n} or @samp{getconf
4343 OPEN_MAX} may display limits for your systems; these limits may be
4344 modified further if your program already has some files open, or if
4345 the operating system has other limits on the number of open files. If
4346 the value of @var{nmerge} exceeds the resource limit, @command{sort}
4347 silently uses a smaller value.
4349 @item -o @var{output-file}
4350 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4353 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4354 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4355 Normally, @command{sort} reads all input before opening
4356 @var{output-file}, so you can safely sort a file in place by using
4357 commands like @code{sort -o F F} and @code{cat F | sort -o F}@.
4358 However, @command{sort} with @option{--merge} (@option{-m}) can open
4359 the output file before reading all input, so a command like @code{cat
4360 F | sort -m -o F - G} is not safe as @command{sort} might start
4361 writing @file{F} before @command{cat} is done reading it.
4363 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4364 On newer systems, @option{-o} cannot appear after an input file if
4365 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, e.g., @samp{sort F -o F}@. Portable
4366 scripts should specify @option{-o @var{output-file}} before any input
4369 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4370 @opindex --random-source
4371 @cindex random source for sorting
4372 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4373 random hash function to use with the @option{-R} option. @xref{Random
4380 @cindex sort stability
4381 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
4383 Make @command{sort} stable by disabling its last-resort comparison.
4384 This option has no effect if no fields or global ordering options
4385 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) are specified.
4388 @itemx --buffer-size=@var{size}
4390 @opindex --buffer-size
4391 @cindex size for main memory sorting
4392 Use a main-memory sort buffer of the given @var{size}. By default,
4393 @var{size} is in units of 1024 bytes. Appending @samp{%} causes
4394 @var{size} to be interpreted as a percentage of physical memory.
4395 Appending @samp{K} multiplies @var{size} by 1024 (the default),
4396 @samp{M} by 1,048,576, @samp{G} by 1,073,741,824, and so on for
4397 @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}@. Appending
4398 @samp{b} causes @var{size} to be interpreted as a byte count, with no
4401 This option can improve the performance of @command{sort} by causing it
4402 to start with a larger or smaller sort buffer than the default.
4403 However, this option affects only the initial buffer size. The buffer
4404 grows beyond @var{size} if @command{sort} encounters input lines larger
4407 @item -t @var{separator}
4408 @itemx --field-separator=@var{separator}
4410 @opindex --field-separator
4411 @cindex field separator character
4412 Use character @var{separator} as the field separator when finding the
4413 sort keys in each line. By default, fields are separated by the empty
4414 string between a non-blank character and a blank character.
4415 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4418 That is, given the input line @w{@samp{ foo bar}}, @command{sort} breaks it
4419 into fields @w{@samp{ foo}} and @w{@samp{ bar}}. The field separator is
4420 not considered to be part of either the field preceding or the field
4421 following, so with @samp{sort @w{-t " "}} the same input line has
4422 three fields: an empty field, @samp{foo}, and @samp{bar}.
4423 However, fields that extend to the end of the line,
4424 as @option{-k 2}, or fields consisting of a range, as @option{-k 2,3},
4425 retain the field separators present between the endpoints of the range.
4427 To specify ASCII NUL as the field separator,
4428 use the two-character string @samp{\0}, e.g., @samp{sort -t '\0'}.
4430 @item -T @var{tempdir}
4431 @itemx --temporary-directory=@var{tempdir}
4433 @opindex --temporary-directory
4434 @cindex temporary directory
4436 Use directory @var{tempdir} to store temporary files, overriding the
4437 @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. If this option is given more than
4438 once, temporary files are stored in all the directories given. If you
4439 have a large sort or merge that is I/O-bound, you can often improve
4440 performance by using this option to specify directories on different
4441 disks and controllers.
4443 @item --parallel=@var{n}
4445 @cindex multithreaded sort
4446 Set the number of sorts run in parallel to @var{n}. By default,
4447 @var{n} is set to the number of available processors, but limited
4448 to 8, as there are diminishing performance gains after that.
4449 Note also that using @var{n} threads increases the memory usage by
4450 a factor of log @var{n}. Also see @ref{nproc invocation}.
4456 @cindex uniquifying output
4458 Normally, output only the first of a sequence of lines that compare
4459 equal. For the @option{--check} (@option{-c} or @option{-C}) option,
4460 check that no pair of consecutive lines compares equal.
4462 This option also disables the default last-resort comparison.
4464 The commands @code{sort -u} and @code{sort | uniq} are equivalent, but
4465 this equivalence does not extend to arbitrary @command{sort} options.
4466 For example, @code{sort -n -u} inspects only the value of the initial
4467 numeric string when checking for uniqueness, whereas @code{sort -n |
4468 uniq} inspects the entire line. @xref{uniq invocation}.
4474 Historical (BSD and System V) implementations of @command{sort} have
4475 differed in their interpretation of some options, particularly
4476 @option{-b}, @option{-f}, and @option{-n}.
4477 GNU sort follows the POSIX
4478 behavior, which is usually (but not always!) like the System V behavior.
4479 According to POSIX, @option{-n} no longer implies @option{-b}. For
4480 consistency, @option{-M} has been changed in the same way. This may
4481 affect the meaning of character positions in field specifications in
4482 obscure cases. The only fix is to add an explicit @option{-b}.
4484 A position in a sort field specified with @option{-k} may have any
4485 of the option letters @samp{MbdfghinRrV} appended to it, in which case no
4486 global ordering options are inherited by that particular field. The
4487 @option{-b} option may be independently attached to either or both of
4488 the start and end positions of a field specification, and if it is
4489 inherited from the global options it will be attached to both.
4490 If input lines can contain leading or adjacent blanks and @option{-t}
4491 is not used, then @option{-k} is typically combined with @option{-b} or
4492 an option that implicitly ignores leading blanks (@samp{Mghn}) as otherwise
4493 the varying numbers of leading blanks in fields can cause confusing results.
4495 If the start position in a sort field specifier falls after the end of
4496 the line or after the end field, the field is empty. If the @option{-b}
4497 option was specified, the @samp{.@var{c}} part of a field specification
4498 is counted from the first nonblank character of the field.
4500 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4501 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4502 On older systems, @command{sort} supports an obsolete origin-zero
4503 syntax @samp{+@var{pos1} [-@var{pos2}]} for specifying sort keys.
4504 The obsolete sequence @samp{sort +@var{a}.@var{x} -@var{b}.@var{y}}
4505 is equivalent to @samp{sort -k @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b}} if @var{y}
4506 is @samp{0} or absent, otherwise it is equivalent to @samp{sort -k
4507 @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b+1}.@var{y}}.
4509 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
4510 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4511 conformance}); it can also be enabled when @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is
4512 not set by using the obsolete syntax with @samp{-@var{pos2}} present.
4514 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
4515 syntax and should use @option{-k} instead. For example, avoid
4516 @samp{sort +2}, since it might be interpreted as either @samp{sort
4517 ./+2} or @samp{sort -k 3}. If your script must also run on hosts that
4518 support only the obsolete syntax, it can use a test like @samp{if sort
4519 -k 1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then @dots{}} to decide which syntax
4522 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options.
4527 Sort in descending (reverse) numeric order.
4534 Run no more than 4 sorts concurrently, using a buffer size of 10M.
4537 sort --parallel=4 -S 10M
4541 Sort alphabetically, omitting the first and second fields
4542 and the blanks at the start of the third field.
4543 This uses a single key composed of the characters beginning
4544 at the start of the first nonblank character in field three
4545 and extending to the end of each line.
4552 Sort numerically on the second field and resolve ties by sorting
4553 alphabetically on the third and fourth characters of field five.
4554 Use @samp{:} as the field delimiter.
4557 sort -t : -k 2,2n -k 5.3,5.4
4560 Note that if you had written @option{-k 2n} instead of @option{-k 2,2n}
4561 @command{sort} would have used all characters beginning in the second field
4562 and extending to the end of the line as the primary @emph{numeric}
4563 key. For the large majority of applications, treating keys spanning
4564 more than one field as numeric will not do what you expect.
4566 Also note that the @samp{n} modifier was applied to the field-end
4567 specifier for the first key. It would have been equivalent to
4568 specify @option{-k 2n,2} or @option{-k 2n,2n}. All modifiers except
4569 @samp{b} apply to the associated @emph{field}, regardless of whether
4570 the modifier character is attached to the field-start and/or the
4571 field-end part of the key specifier.
4574 Sort the password file on the fifth field and ignore any
4575 leading blanks. Sort lines with equal values in field five
4576 on the numeric user ID in field three. Fields are separated
4580 sort -t : -k 5b,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
4581 sort -t : -n -k 5b,5 -k 3,3 /etc/passwd
4582 sort -t : -b -k 5,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
4585 These three commands have equivalent effect. The first specifies that
4586 the first key's start position ignores leading blanks and the second
4587 key is sorted numerically. The other two commands rely on global
4588 options being inherited by sort keys that lack modifiers. The inheritance
4589 works in this case because @option{-k 5b,5b} and @option{-k 5b,5} are
4590 equivalent, as the location of a field-end lacking a @samp{.@var{c}}
4591 character position is not affected by whether initial blanks are
4595 Sort a set of log files, primarily by IPv4 address and secondarily by
4596 time stamp. If two lines' primary and secondary keys are identical,
4597 output the lines in the same order that they were input. The log
4598 files contain lines that look like this:
4601 4.150.156.3 - - [01/Apr/2004:06:31:51 +0000] message 1
4602 211.24.3.231 - - [24/Apr/2004:20:17:39 +0000] message 2
4605 Fields are separated by exactly one space. Sort IPv4 addresses
4606 lexicographically, e.g., 212.61.52.2 sorts before 212.129.233.201
4607 because 61 is less than 129.
4610 sort -s -t ' ' -k 4.9n -k 4.5M -k 4.2n -k 4.14,4.21 file*.log |
4611 sort -s -t '.' -k 1,1n -k 2,2n -k 3,3n -k 4,4n
4614 This example cannot be done with a single @command{sort} invocation,
4615 since IPv4 address components are separated by @samp{.} while dates
4616 come just after a space. So it is broken down into two invocations of
4617 @command{sort}: the first sorts by time stamp and the second by IPv4
4618 address. The time stamp is sorted by year, then month, then day, and
4619 finally by hour-minute-second field, using @option{-k} to isolate each
4620 field. Except for hour-minute-second there's no need to specify the
4621 end of each key field, since the @samp{n} and @samp{M} modifiers sort
4622 based on leading prefixes that cannot cross field boundaries. The
4623 IPv4 addresses are sorted lexicographically. The second sort uses
4624 @samp{-s} so that ties in the primary key are broken by the secondary
4625 key; the first sort uses @samp{-s} so that the combination of the two
4629 Generate a tags file in case-insensitive sorted order.
4632 find src -type f -print0 | sort -z -f | xargs -0 etags --append
4635 The use of @option{-print0}, @option{-z}, and @option{-0} in this case means
4636 that file names that contain blanks or other special characters are
4638 by the sort operation.
4640 @c This example is a bit contrived and needs more explanation.
4642 @c Sort records separated by an arbitrary string by using a pipe to convert
4643 @c each record delimiter string to @samp{\0}, then using sort's -z option,
4644 @c and converting each @samp{\0} back to the original record delimiter.
4647 @c printf 'c\n\nb\n\na\n' |
4648 @c perl -0pe 's/\n\n/\n\0/g' |
4650 @c perl -0pe 's/\0/\n/g'
4654 Use the common DSU, Decorate Sort Undecorate idiom to
4655 sort lines according to their length.
4658 awk '@{print length, $0@}' /etc/passwd | sort -n | cut -f2- -d' '
4661 In general this technique can be used to sort data that the @command{sort}
4662 command does not support, or is inefficient at, sorting directly.
4665 Shuffle a list of directories, but preserve the order of files within
4666 each directory. For instance, one could use this to generate a music
4667 playlist in which albums are shuffled but the songs of each album are
4671 ls */* | sort -t / -k 1,1R -k 2,2
4677 @node shuf invocation
4678 @section @command{shuf}: Shuffling text
4681 @cindex shuffling files
4683 @command{shuf} shuffles its input by outputting a random permutation
4684 of its input lines. Each output permutation is equally likely.
4688 shuf [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
4689 shuf -e [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
4690 shuf -i @var{lo}-@var{hi} [@var{option}]@dots{}
4693 @command{shuf} has three modes of operation that affect where it
4694 obtains its input lines. By default, it reads lines from standard
4695 input. The following options change the operation mode:
4703 @cindex command-line operands to shuffle
4704 Treat each command-line operand as an input line.
4706 @item -i @var{lo}-@var{hi}
4707 @itemx --input-range=@var{lo}-@var{hi}
4709 @opindex --input-range
4710 @cindex input range to shuffle
4711 Act as if input came from a file containing the range of unsigned
4712 decimal integers @var{lo}@dots{}@var{hi}, one per line.
4716 @command{shuf}'s other options can affect its behavior in all
4721 @item -n @var{lines}
4722 @itemx --head-count=@var{count}
4724 @opindex --head-count
4725 @cindex head of output
4726 Output at most @var{count} lines. By default, all input lines are
4729 @item -o @var{output-file}
4730 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4733 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4734 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4735 @command{shuf} reads all input before opening
4736 @var{output-file}, so you can safely shuffle a file in place by using
4737 commands like @code{shuf -o F <F} and @code{cat F | shuf -o F}.
4739 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4740 @opindex --random-source
4741 @cindex random source for shuffling
4742 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4743 permutation to generate. @xref{Random sources}.
4749 @cindex repeat output values
4750 Repeat output values, that is, select with replacement. With this
4751 option the output is not a permutation of the input; instead, each
4752 output line is randomly chosen from all the inputs. This option is
4753 typically combined with @option{--head-count}; if
4754 @option{--head-count} is not given, @command{shuf} repeats
4773 might produce the output
4783 Similarly, the command:
4786 shuf -e clubs hearts diamonds spades
4800 and the command @samp{shuf -i 1-4} might output:
4810 The above examples all have four input lines, so @command{shuf} might
4811 produce any of the twenty-four possible permutations of the input. In
4812 general, if there are @var{n} input lines, there are @var{n}! (i.e.,
4813 @var{n} factorial, or @var{n} * (@var{n} - 1) * @dots{} * 1) possible
4814 output permutations.
4817 To output 50 random numbers each in the range 0 through 9, use:
4820 shuf -r -n 50 -i 0-9
4824 To simulate 100 coin flips, use:
4827 shuf -r -n 100 -e Head Tail
4833 @node uniq invocation
4834 @section @command{uniq}: Uniquify files
4837 @cindex uniquify files
4839 @command{uniq} writes the unique lines in the given @file{input}, or
4840 standard input if nothing is given or for an @var{input} name of
4844 uniq [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4847 By default, @command{uniq} prints its input lines, except that
4848 it discards all but the first of adjacent repeated lines, so that
4849 no output lines are repeated. Optionally, it can instead discard
4850 lines that are not repeated, or all repeated lines.
4852 The input need not be sorted, but repeated input lines are detected
4853 only if they are adjacent. If you want to discard non-adjacent
4854 duplicate lines, perhaps you want to use @code{sort -u}.
4855 @xref{sort invocation}.
4858 Comparisons honor the rules specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE}
4861 If no @var{output} file is specified, @command{uniq} writes to standard
4864 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4869 @itemx --skip-fields=@var{n}
4871 @opindex --skip-fields
4872 Skip @var{n} fields on each line before checking for uniqueness. Use
4873 a null string for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} fields. Fields
4874 are sequences of non-space non-tab characters that are separated from
4875 each other by at least one space or tab.
4877 For compatibility @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4878 @option{-@var{n}}. New scripts should use @option{-f @var{n}} instead.
4881 @itemx --skip-chars=@var{n}
4883 @opindex --skip-chars
4884 Skip @var{n} characters before checking for uniqueness. Use a null string
4885 for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} characters. If you use both
4886 the field and character skipping options, fields are skipped over first.
4888 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4889 On older systems, @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4891 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
4892 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4893 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
4894 behavior depends on this variable.
4895 For example, use @samp{uniq ./+10} or @samp{uniq -s 10} rather than
4896 the ambiguous @samp{uniq +10}.
4902 Print the number of times each line occurred along with the line.
4905 @itemx --ignore-case
4907 @opindex --ignore-case
4908 Ignore differences in case when comparing lines.
4914 @cindex repeated lines, outputting
4915 Discard lines that are not repeated. When used by itself, this option
4916 causes @command{uniq} to print the first copy of each repeated line,
4920 @itemx --all-repeated[=@var{delimit-method}]
4922 @opindex --all-repeated
4923 @cindex all repeated lines, outputting
4924 Do not discard the second and subsequent repeated input lines,
4925 but discard lines that are not repeated.
4926 This option is useful mainly in conjunction with other options e.g.,
4927 to ignore case or to compare only selected fields.
4928 The optional @var{delimit-method}, supported with the long form option,
4929 specifies how to delimit groups of repeated lines, and must be one of the
4935 Do not delimit groups of repeated lines.
4936 This is equivalent to @option{--all-repeated} (@option{-D}).
4939 Output a newline before each group of repeated lines.
4940 @macro nulOutputNote
4941 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use a zero
4942 byte (ASCII NUL) instead of a newline as the delimiter.
4947 Separate groups of repeated lines with a single newline.
4948 This is the same as using @samp{prepend}, except that
4949 no delimiter is inserted before the first group, and hence
4950 may be better suited for output direct to users.
4954 @macro ambiguousGroupNote
4955 Note that when groups are delimited and the input stream contains
4956 two or more consecutive blank lines, then the output is ambiguous.
4957 To avoid that, filter the input through @samp{tr -s '\\n'} to replace
4958 each sequence of consecutive newlines with a single newline.
4962 This is a GNU extension.
4963 @c FIXME: give an example showing *how* it's useful
4965 @item --group[=@var{delimit-method}]
4967 @cindex all lines, grouping
4968 Output all lines, and delimit each unique group.
4970 The optional @var{delimit-method} specifies how to delimit
4971 groups, and must be one of the following:
4976 Separate unique groups with a single delimiter.
4977 This is the default delimiting method if none is specified,
4978 and better suited for output direct to users.
4981 Output a delimiter before each group of unique items.
4984 Output a delimiter after each group of unique items.
4987 Output a delimiter around each group of unique items.
4992 This is a GNU extension.
4998 @cindex unique lines, outputting
4999 Discard the last line that would be output for a repeated input group.
5000 When used by itself, this option causes @command{uniq} to print unique
5001 lines, and nothing else.
5004 @itemx --check-chars=@var{n}
5006 @opindex --check-chars
5007 Compare at most @var{n} characters on each line (after skipping any specified
5008 fields and characters). By default the entire rest of the lines are
5018 @node comm invocation
5019 @section @command{comm}: Compare two sorted files line by line
5022 @cindex line-by-line comparison
5023 @cindex comparing sorted files
5025 @command{comm} writes to standard output lines that are common, and lines
5026 that are unique, to two input files; a file name of @samp{-} means
5027 standard input. Synopsis:
5030 comm [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5034 Before @command{comm} can be used, the input files must be sorted using the
5035 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
5036 If an input file ends in a non-newline
5037 character, a newline is silently appended. The @command{sort} command with
5038 no options always outputs a file that is suitable input to @command{comm}.
5040 @cindex differing lines
5041 @cindex common lines
5042 With no options, @command{comm} produces three-column output. Column one
5043 contains lines unique to @var{file1}, column two contains lines unique
5044 to @var{file2}, and column three contains lines common to both files.
5045 Columns are separated by a single TAB character.
5046 @c FIXME: when there's an option to supply an alternative separator
5047 @c string, append "by default" to the above sentence.
5052 The options @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and @option{-3} suppress printing of
5053 the corresponding columns (and separators). Also see @ref{Common options}.
5055 Unlike some other comparison utilities, @command{comm} has an exit
5056 status that does not depend on the result of the comparison.
5057 Upon normal completion @command{comm} produces an exit code of zero.
5058 If there is an error it exits with nonzero status.
5060 @macro checkOrderOption{cmd}
5061 If the @option{--check-order} option is given, unsorted inputs will
5062 cause a fatal error message. If the option @option{--nocheck-order}
5063 is given, unsorted inputs will never cause an error message. If neither
5064 of these options is given, wrongly sorted inputs are diagnosed
5065 only if an input file is found to contain unpairable
5067 lines, and when both input files are non empty.
5069 @ifclear JOIN_COMMAND
5072 If an input file is diagnosed as being unsorted, the @command{\cmd\}
5073 command will exit with a nonzero status (and the output should not be used).
5075 Forcing @command{\cmd\} to process wrongly sorted input files
5076 containing unpairable lines by specifying @option{--nocheck-order} is
5077 not guaranteed to produce any particular output. The output will
5078 probably not correspond with whatever you hoped it would be.
5080 @checkOrderOption{comm}
5085 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
5087 @item --nocheck-order
5088 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order.
5092 @item --output-delimiter=@var{str}
5093 Print @var{str} between adjacent output columns,
5094 rather than the default of a single TAB character.
5096 The delimiter @var{str} may not be empty.
5100 @node ptx invocation
5101 @section @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
5105 @command{ptx} reads a text file and essentially produces a permuted index, with
5106 each keyword in its context. The calling sketch is either one of:
5109 ptx [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{file} @dots{}]
5110 ptx -G [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
5113 The @option{-G} (or its equivalent: @option{--traditional}) option disables
5114 all GNU extensions and reverts to traditional mode, thus introducing some
5115 limitations and changing several of the program's default option values.
5116 When @option{-G} is not specified, GNU extensions are always enabled.
5117 GNU extensions to @command{ptx} are documented wherever appropriate in this
5118 document. @xref{Compatibility in ptx}, for the full list.
5120 Individual options are explained in the following sections.
5122 When GNU extensions are enabled, there may be zero, one or several
5123 @var{file}s after the options. If there is no @var{file}, the program
5124 reads the standard input. If there is one or several @var{file}s, they
5125 give the name of input files which are all read in turn, as if all the
5126 input files were concatenated. However, there is a full contextual
5127 break between each file and, when automatic referencing is requested,
5128 file names and line numbers refer to individual text input files. In
5129 all cases, the program outputs the permuted index to the standard
5132 When GNU extensions are @emph{not} enabled, that is, when the program
5133 operates in traditional mode, there may be zero, one or two parameters
5134 besides the options. If there are no parameters, the program reads the
5135 standard input and outputs the permuted index to the standard output.
5136 If there is only one parameter, it names the text @var{input} to be read
5137 instead of the standard input. If two parameters are given, they give
5138 respectively the name of the @var{input} file to read and the name of
5139 the @var{output} file to produce. @emph{Be very careful} to note that,
5140 in this case, the contents of file given by the second parameter is
5141 destroyed. This behavior is dictated by System V @command{ptx}
5142 compatibility; GNU Standards normally discourage output parameters not
5143 introduced by an option.
5145 Note that for @emph{any} file named as the value of an option or as an
5146 input text file, a single dash @samp{-} may be used, in which case
5147 standard input is assumed. However, it would not make sense to use this
5148 convention more than once per program invocation.
5151 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
5152 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
5153 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
5154 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
5155 * Compatibility in ptx::
5159 @node General options in ptx
5160 @subsection General options
5165 @itemx --traditional
5166 As already explained, this option disables all GNU extensions to
5167 @command{ptx} and switches to traditional mode.
5170 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
5174 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
5182 @node Charset selection in ptx
5183 @subsection Charset selection
5185 @c FIXME: People don't necessarily know what an IBM-PC was these days.
5186 As it is set up now, the program assumes that the input file is coded
5187 using 8-bit ISO 8859-1 code, also known as Latin-1 character set,
5188 @emph{unless} it is compiled for MS-DOS, in which case it uses the
5189 character set of the IBM-PC@. (GNU @command{ptx} is not known to work on
5190 smaller MS-DOS machines anymore.) Compared to 7-bit ASCII, the set
5191 of characters which are letters is different; this alters the behavior
5192 of regular expression matching. Thus, the default regular expression
5193 for a keyword allows foreign or diacriticized letters. Keyword sorting,
5194 however, is still crude; it obeys the underlying character set ordering
5200 @itemx --ignore-case
5201 Fold lower case letters to upper case for sorting.
5206 @node Input processing in ptx
5207 @subsection Word selection and input processing
5212 @itemx --break-file=@var{file}
5214 This option provides an alternative (to @option{-W}) method of describing
5215 which characters make up words. It introduces the name of a
5216 file which contains a list of characters which can@emph{not} be part of
5217 one word; this file is called the @dfn{Break file}. Any character which
5218 is not part of the Break file is a word constituent. If both options
5219 @option{-b} and @option{-W} are specified, then @option{-W} has precedence and
5220 @option{-b} is ignored.
5222 When GNU extensions are enabled, the only way to avoid newline as a
5223 break character is to write all the break characters in the file with no
5224 newline at all, not even at the end of the file. When GNU extensions
5225 are disabled, spaces, tabs and newlines are always considered as break
5226 characters even if not included in the Break file.
5229 @itemx --ignore-file=@var{file}
5231 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5232 never be taken as keywords in concordance output. It is called the
5233 @dfn{Ignore file}. The file contains exactly one word in each line; the
5234 end of line separation of words is not subject to the value of the
5238 @itemx --only-file=@var{file}
5240 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5241 be retained in concordance output; any word not mentioned in this file
5242 is ignored. The file is called the @dfn{Only file}. The file contains
5243 exactly one word in each line; the end of line separation of words is
5244 not subject to the value of the @option{-S} option.
5246 There is no default for the Only file. When both an Only file and an
5247 Ignore file are specified, a word is considered a keyword only
5248 if it is listed in the Only file and not in the Ignore file.
5253 On each input line, the leading sequence of non-white space characters will be
5254 taken to be a reference that has the purpose of identifying this input
5255 line in the resulting permuted index.
5256 @xref{Output formatting in ptx},
5257 for more information about reference production.
5258 Using this option changes the default value for option @option{-S}.
5260 Using this option, the program does not try very hard to remove
5261 references from contexts in output, but it succeeds in doing so
5262 @emph{when} the context ends exactly at the newline. If option
5263 @option{-r} is used with @option{-S} default value, or when GNU extensions
5264 are disabled, this condition is always met and references are completely
5265 excluded from the output contexts.
5267 @item -S @var{regexp}
5268 @itemx --sentence-regexp=@var{regexp}
5270 This option selects which regular expression will describe the end of a
5271 line or the end of a sentence. In fact, this regular expression is not
5272 the only distinction between end of lines or end of sentences, and input
5273 line boundaries have no special significance outside this option. By
5274 default, when GNU extensions are enabled and if @option{-r} option is not
5275 used, end of sentences are used. In this case, this @var{regex} is
5276 imported from GNU Emacs:
5279 [.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\|\t\\| \\)[ \t\n]*
5282 Whenever GNU extensions are disabled or if @option{-r} option is used, end
5283 of lines are used; in this case, the default @var{regexp} is just:
5289 Using an empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to completely disabling end of
5290 line or end of sentence recognition. In this case, the whole file is
5291 considered to be a single big line or sentence. The user might want to
5292 disallow all truncation flag generation as well, through option @option{-F
5293 ""}. @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5296 When the keywords happen to be near the beginning of the input line or
5297 sentence, this often creates an unused area at the beginning of the
5298 output context line; when the keywords happen to be near the end of the
5299 input line or sentence, this often creates an unused area at the end of
5300 the output context line. The program tries to fill those unused areas
5301 by wrapping around context in them; the tail of the input line or
5302 sentence is used to fill the unused area on the left of the output line;
5303 the head of the input line or sentence is used to fill the unused area
5304 on the right of the output line.
5306 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5307 sequences from the C language are recognized and converted to the
5308 corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5310 @item -W @var{regexp}
5311 @itemx --word-regexp=@var{regexp}
5313 This option selects which regular expression will describe each keyword.
5314 By default, if GNU extensions are enabled, a word is a sequence of
5315 letters; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{\w+}. When GNU extensions are
5316 disabled, a word is by default anything which ends with a space, a tab
5317 or a newline; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{[^ \t\n]+}.
5319 An empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to not using this option.
5320 @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5323 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5324 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5325 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5330 @node Output formatting in ptx
5331 @subsection Output formatting
5333 Output format is mainly controlled by the @option{-O} and @option{-T} options
5334 described in the table below. When neither @option{-O} nor @option{-T} are
5335 selected, and if GNU extensions are enabled, the program chooses an
5336 output format suitable for a dumb terminal. Each keyword occurrence is
5337 output to the center of one line, surrounded by its left and right
5338 contexts. Each field is properly justified, so the concordance output
5339 can be readily observed. As a special feature, if automatic
5340 references are selected by option @option{-A} and are output before the
5341 left context, that is, if option @option{-R} is @emph{not} selected, then
5342 a colon is added after the reference; this nicely interfaces with GNU
5343 Emacs @code{next-error} processing. In this default output format, each
5344 white space character, like newline and tab, is merely changed to
5345 exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress consecutive
5346 spaces. This might change in the future. Except for those white space
5347 characters, every other character of the underlying set of 256
5348 characters is transmitted verbatim.
5350 Output format is further controlled by the following options.
5354 @item -g @var{number}
5355 @itemx --gap-size=@var{number}
5357 Select the size of the minimum white space gap between the fields on the
5360 @item -w @var{number}
5361 @itemx --width=@var{number}
5363 Select the maximum output width of each final line. If references are
5364 used, they are included or excluded from the maximum output width
5365 depending on the value of option @option{-R}@. If this option is not
5366 selected, that is, when references are output before the left context,
5367 the maximum output width takes into account the maximum length of all
5368 references. If this option is selected, that is, when references are
5369 output after the right context, the maximum output width does not take
5370 into account the space taken by references, nor the gap that precedes
5374 @itemx --auto-reference
5376 Select automatic references. Each input line will have an automatic
5377 reference made up of the file name and the line ordinal, with a single
5378 colon between them. However, the file name will be empty when standard
5379 input is being read. If both @option{-A} and @option{-r} are selected, then
5380 the input reference is still read and skipped, but the automatic
5381 reference is used at output time, overriding the input reference.
5384 @itemx --right-side-refs
5386 In the default output format, when option @option{-R} is not used, any
5387 references produced by the effect of options @option{-r} or @option{-A} are
5388 placed to the far right of output lines, after the right context. With
5389 default output format, when the @option{-R} option is specified, references
5390 are rather placed at the beginning of each output line, before the left
5391 context. For any other output format, option @option{-R} is
5392 ignored, with one exception: with @option{-R} the width of references
5393 is @emph{not} taken into account in total output width given by @option{-w}.
5395 This option is automatically selected whenever GNU extensions are
5398 @item -F @var{string}
5399 @itemx --flac-truncation=@var{string}
5401 This option will request that any truncation in the output be reported
5402 using the string @var{string}. Most output fields theoretically extend
5403 towards the beginning or the end of the current line, or current
5404 sentence, as selected with option @option{-S}@. But there is a maximum
5405 allowed output line width, changeable through option @option{-w}, which is
5406 further divided into space for various output fields. When a field has
5407 to be truncated because it cannot extend beyond the beginning or the end of
5408 the current line to fit in, then a truncation occurs. By default,
5409 the string used is a single slash, as in @option{-F /}.
5411 @var{string} may have more than one character, as in @option{-F @dots{}}.
5412 Also, in the particular case when @var{string} is empty (@option{-F ""}),
5413 truncation flagging is disabled, and no truncation marks are appended in
5416 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5417 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5418 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5420 @item -M @var{string}
5421 @itemx --macro-name=@var{string}
5423 Select another @var{string} to be used instead of @samp{xx}, while
5424 generating output suitable for @command{nroff}, @command{troff} or @TeX{}.
5427 @itemx --format=roff
5429 Choose an output format suitable for @command{nroff} or @command{troff}
5430 processing. Each output line will look like:
5433 .xx "@var{tail}" "@var{before}" "@var{keyword_and_after}"@c
5434 "@var{head}" "@var{ref}"
5437 so it will be possible to write a @samp{.xx} roff macro to take care of
5438 the output typesetting. This is the default output format when GNU
5439 extensions are disabled. Option @option{-M} can be used to change
5440 @samp{xx} to another macro name.
5442 In this output format, each non-graphical character, like newline and
5443 tab, is merely changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to
5444 compress consecutive spaces. Each quote character @samp{"} is doubled
5445 so it will be correctly processed by @command{nroff} or @command{troff}.
5450 Choose an output format suitable for @TeX{} processing. Each output
5451 line will look like:
5454 \xx @{@var{tail}@}@{@var{before}@}@{@var{keyword}@}@c
5455 @{@var{after}@}@{@var{head}@}@{@var{ref}@}
5459 so it will be possible to write a @code{\xx} definition to take care of
5460 the output typesetting. Note that when references are not being
5461 produced, that is, neither option @option{-A} nor option @option{-r} is
5462 selected, the last parameter of each @code{\xx} call is inhibited.
5463 Option @option{-M} can be used to change @samp{xx} to another macro
5466 In this output format, some special characters, like @samp{$}, @samp{%},
5467 @samp{&}, @samp{#} and @samp{_} are automatically protected with a
5468 backslash. Curly brackets @samp{@{}, @samp{@}} are protected with a
5469 backslash and a pair of dollar signs (to force mathematical mode). The
5470 backslash itself produces the sequence @code{\backslash@{@}}.
5471 Circumflex and tilde diacritical marks produce the sequence @code{^\@{ @}} and
5472 @code{~\@{ @}} respectively. Other diacriticized characters of the
5473 underlying character set produce an appropriate @TeX{} sequence as far
5474 as possible. The other non-graphical characters, like newline and tab,
5475 and all other characters which are not part of ASCII, are merely
5476 changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress
5477 consecutive spaces. Let me know how to improve this special character
5478 processing for @TeX{}.
5483 @node Compatibility in ptx
5484 @subsection The GNU extensions to @command{ptx}
5486 This version of @command{ptx} contains a few features which do not exist in
5487 System V @command{ptx}. These extra features are suppressed by using the
5488 @option{-G} command line option, unless overridden by other command line
5489 options. Some GNU extensions cannot be recovered by overriding, so the
5490 simple rule is to avoid @option{-G} if you care about GNU extensions.
5491 Here are the differences between this program and System V @command{ptx}.
5496 This program can read many input files at once, it always writes the
5497 resulting concordance on standard output. On the other hand, System V
5498 @command{ptx} reads only one file and sends the result to standard output
5499 or, if a second @var{file} parameter is given on the command, to that
5502 Having output parameters not introduced by options is a dangerous
5503 practice which GNU avoids as far as possible. So, for using @command{ptx}
5504 portably between GNU and System V, you should always use it with a
5505 single input file, and always expect the result on standard output. You
5506 might also want to automatically configure in a @option{-G} option to
5507 @command{ptx} calls in products using @command{ptx}, if the configurator finds
5508 that the installed @command{ptx} accepts @option{-G}.
5511 The only options available in System V @command{ptx} are options @option{-b},
5512 @option{-f}, @option{-g}, @option{-i}, @option{-o}, @option{-r}, @option{-t} and
5513 @option{-w}. All other options are GNU extensions and are not repeated in
5514 this enumeration. Moreover, some options have a slightly different
5515 meaning when GNU extensions are enabled, as explained below.
5518 By default, concordance output is not formatted for @command{troff} or
5519 @command{nroff}. It is rather formatted for a dumb terminal. @command{troff}
5520 or @command{nroff} output may still be selected through option @option{-O}.
5523 Unless @option{-R} option is used, the maximum reference width is
5524 subtracted from the total output line width. With GNU extensions
5525 disabled, width of references is not taken into account in the output
5526 line width computations.
5529 All 256 bytes, even ASCII NUL bytes, are always read and
5530 processed from input file with no adverse effect, even if GNU extensions
5531 are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} does not accept 8-bit
5532 characters, a few control characters are rejected, and the tilde
5533 @samp{~} is also rejected.
5536 Input line length is only limited by available memory, even if GNU
5537 extensions are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} processes only
5538 the first 200 characters in each line.
5541 The break (non-word) characters default to be every character except all
5542 letters of the underlying character set, diacriticized or not. When GNU
5543 extensions are disabled, the break characters default to space, tab and
5547 The program makes better use of output line width. If GNU extensions
5548 are disabled, the program rather tries to imitate System V @command{ptx},
5549 but still, there are some slight disposition glitches this program does
5550 not completely reproduce.
5553 The user can specify both an Ignore file and an Only file. This is not
5554 allowed with System V @command{ptx}.
5559 @node tsort invocation
5560 @section @command{tsort}: Topological sort
5563 @cindex topological sort
5565 @command{tsort} performs a topological sort on the given @var{file}, or
5566 standard input if no input file is given or for a @var{file} of
5567 @samp{-}. For more details and some history, see @ref{tsort background}.
5571 tsort [@var{option}] [@var{file}]
5574 @command{tsort} reads its input as pairs of strings, separated by blanks,
5575 indicating a partial ordering. The output is a total ordering that
5576 corresponds to the given partial ordering.
5590 will produce the output
5601 Consider a more realistic example.
5602 You have a large set of functions all in one file, and they may all be
5603 declared static except one. Currently that one (say @code{main}) is the
5604 first function defined in the file, and the ones it calls directly follow
5605 it, followed by those they call, etc. Let's say that you are determined
5606 to take advantage of prototypes, so you have to choose between declaring
5607 all of those functions (which means duplicating a lot of information from
5608 the definitions) and rearranging the functions so that as many as possible
5609 are defined before they are used. One way to automate the latter process
5610 is to get a list for each function of the functions it calls directly.
5611 Many programs can generate such lists. They describe a call graph.
5612 Consider the following list, in which a given line indicates that the
5613 function on the left calls the one on the right directly.
5619 tail_file pretty_name
5620 tail_file write_header
5622 tail_forever recheck
5623 tail_forever pretty_name
5624 tail_forever write_header
5625 tail_forever dump_remainder
5628 tail_lines start_lines
5629 tail_lines dump_remainder
5630 tail_lines file_lines
5631 tail_lines pipe_lines
5633 tail_bytes start_bytes
5634 tail_bytes dump_remainder
5635 tail_bytes pipe_bytes
5636 file_lines dump_remainder
5640 then you can use @command{tsort} to produce an ordering of those
5641 functions that satisfies your requirement.
5644 example$ tsort call-graph | tac
5664 @command{tsort} detects any cycles in the input and writes the first cycle
5665 encountered to standard error.
5667 Note that for a given partial ordering, generally there is no unique
5668 total ordering. In the context of the call graph above, the function
5669 @code{parse_options} may be placed anywhere in the list as long as it
5670 precedes @code{main}.
5672 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
5678 * tsort background:: Where tsort came from.
5681 @node tsort background
5682 @subsection @command{tsort}: Background
5684 @command{tsort} exists because very early versions of the Unix linker processed
5685 an archive file exactly once, and in order. As @command{ld} read each object
5686 in the archive, it decided whether it was needed in the program based on
5687 whether it defined any symbols which were undefined at that point in
5690 This meant that dependencies within the archive had to be handled
5691 specially. For example, @code{scanf} probably calls @code{read}. That means
5692 that in a single pass through an archive, it was important for @code{scanf.o}
5693 to appear before read.o, because otherwise a program which calls
5694 @code{scanf} but not @code{read} might end up with an unexpected unresolved
5695 reference to @code{read}.
5697 The way to address this problem was to first generate a set of
5698 dependencies of one object file on another. This was done by a shell
5699 script called @command{lorder}. The GNU tools don't provide a version of
5700 lorder, as far as I know, but you can still find it in BSD
5703 Then you ran @command{tsort} over the @command{lorder} output, and you used the
5704 resulting sort to define the order in which you added objects to the archive.
5706 This whole procedure has been obsolete since about 1980, because
5707 Unix archives now contain a symbol table (traditionally built by
5708 @command{ranlib}, now generally built by @command{ar} itself), and the Unix
5709 linker uses the symbol table to effectively make multiple passes over
5712 Anyhow, that's where tsort came from. To solve an old problem with
5713 the way the linker handled archive files, which has since been solved
5717 @node Operating on fields
5718 @chapter Operating on fields
5721 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
5722 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
5723 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
5727 @node cut invocation
5728 @section @command{cut}: Print selected parts of lines
5731 @command{cut} writes to standard output selected parts of each line of each
5732 input file, or standard input if no files are given or for a file name of
5736 cut @var{option}@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5739 In the table which follows, the @var{byte-list}, @var{character-list},
5740 and @var{field-list} are one or more numbers or ranges (two numbers
5741 separated by a dash) separated by commas. Bytes, characters, and
5742 fields are numbered starting at 1. Incomplete ranges may be
5743 given: @option{-@var{m}} means @samp{1-@var{m}}; @samp{@var{n}-} means
5744 @samp{@var{n}} through end of line or last field. The list elements
5745 can be repeated, can overlap, and can be specified in any order; but
5746 the selected input is written in the same order that it is read, and
5747 is written exactly once.
5749 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common
5754 @item -b @var{byte-list}
5755 @itemx --bytes=@var{byte-list}
5758 Select for printing only the bytes in positions listed in
5759 @var{byte-list}. Tabs and backspaces are treated like any other
5760 character; they take up 1 byte. If an output delimiter is specified,
5761 (see the description of @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that
5762 string between ranges of selected bytes.
5764 @item -c @var{character-list}
5765 @itemx --characters=@var{character-list}
5767 @opindex --characters
5768 Select for printing only the characters in positions listed in
5769 @var{character-list}. The same as @option{-b} for now, but
5770 internationalization will change that. Tabs and backspaces are
5771 treated like any other character; they take up 1 character. If an
5772 output delimiter is specified, (see the description of
5773 @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that string between ranges
5776 @item -f @var{field-list}
5777 @itemx --fields=@var{field-list}
5780 Select for printing only the fields listed in @var{field-list}.
5781 Fields are separated by a TAB character by default. Also print any
5782 line that contains no delimiter character, unless the
5783 @option{--only-delimited} (@option{-s}) option is specified.
5785 Note @command{awk} supports more sophisticated field processing,
5786 and by default will use (and discard) runs of blank characters to
5787 separate fields, and ignore leading and trailing blanks.
5790 awk '{print $2}' # print the second field
5791 awk '{print $NF-1}' # print the penultimate field
5792 awk '{print $2,$1}' # reorder the first two fields
5796 In the unlikely event that @command{awk} is unavailable,
5797 one can use the @command{join} command, to process blank
5798 characters as @command{awk} does above.
5801 join -a1 -o 1.2 - /dev/null # print the second field
5802 join -a1 -o 1.2,1.1 - /dev/null # reorder the first two fields
5806 @item -d @var{input_delim_byte}
5807 @itemx --delimiter=@var{input_delim_byte}
5809 @opindex --delimiter
5810 With @option{-f}, use the first byte of @var{input_delim_byte} as
5811 the input fields separator (default is TAB).
5815 Do not split multi-byte characters (no-op for now).
5818 @itemx --only-delimited
5820 @opindex --only-delimited
5821 For @option{-f}, do not print lines that do not contain the field separator
5822 character. Normally, any line without a field separator is printed verbatim.
5824 @item --output-delimiter=@var{output_delim_string}
5825 @opindex --output-delimiter
5826 With @option{-f}, output fields are separated by @var{output_delim_string}.
5827 The default with @option{-f} is to use the input delimiter.
5828 When using @option{-b} or @option{-c} to select ranges of byte or
5829 character offsets (as opposed to ranges of fields),
5830 output @var{output_delim_string} between non-overlapping
5831 ranges of selected bytes.
5834 @opindex --complement
5835 This option is a GNU extension.
5836 Select for printing the complement of the bytes, characters or fields
5837 selected with the @option{-b}, @option{-c} or @option{-f} options.
5838 In other words, do @emph{not} print the bytes, characters or fields
5839 specified via those options. This option is useful when you have
5840 many fields and want to print all but a few of them.
5847 @node paste invocation
5848 @section @command{paste}: Merge lines of files
5851 @cindex merging files
5853 @command{paste} writes to standard output lines consisting of sequentially
5854 corresponding lines of each given file, separated by a TAB character.
5855 Standard input is used for a file name of @samp{-} or if no input files
5861 paste [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5875 Take lines sequentially from each file:
5883 Duplicate lines from a file:
5885 $ paste num2 let3 num2
5891 Intermix lines from stdin:
5893 $ paste - let3 - < num2
5899 Join consecutive lines with a space:
5901 $ seq 4 | paste -d ' ' - -
5906 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5914 Paste the lines of one file at a time rather than one line from each
5915 file. Using the above example data:
5918 $ paste -s num2 let3
5923 @item -d @var{delim-list}
5924 @itemx --delimiters=@var{delim-list}
5926 @opindex --delimiters
5927 Consecutively use the characters in @var{delim-list} instead of
5928 TAB to separate merged lines. When @var{delim-list} is
5929 exhausted, start again at its beginning. Using the above example data:
5932 $ paste -d '%_' num2 let3 num2
5943 @node join invocation
5944 @section @command{join}: Join lines on a common field
5947 @cindex common field, joining on
5949 @command{join} writes to standard output a line for each pair of input
5950 lines that have identical join fields. Synopsis:
5953 join [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5956 Either @var{file1} or @var{file2} (but not both) can be @samp{-},
5957 meaning standard input. @var{file1} and @var{file2} should be
5958 sorted on the join fields.
5961 Normally, the sort order is that of the
5962 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale. Unless
5963 the @option{-t} option is given, the sort comparison ignores blanks at
5964 the start of the join field, as in @code{sort -b}. If the
5965 @option{--ignore-case} option is given, the sort comparison ignores
5966 the case of characters in the join field, as in @code{sort -f}.
5968 The @command{sort} and @command{join} commands should use consistent
5969 locales and options if the output of @command{sort} is fed to
5970 @command{join}. You can use a command like @samp{sort -k 1b,1} to
5971 sort a file on its default join field, but if you select a non-default
5972 locale, join field, separator, or comparison options, then you should
5973 do so consistently between @command{join} and @command{sort}.
5974 If @samp{join -t ''} is specified then the whole line is considered which
5975 matches the default operation of sort.
5977 If the input has no unpairable lines, a GNU extension is
5978 available; the sort order can be any order that considers two fields
5979 to be equal if and only if the sort comparison described above
5980 considers them to be equal. For example:
5998 @checkOrderOption{join}
6003 @item the join field is the first field in each line;
6004 @item fields in the input are separated by one or more blanks, with leading
6005 blanks on the line ignored;
6006 @item fields in the output are separated by a space;
6007 @item each output line consists of the join field, the remaining
6008 fields from @var{file1}, then the remaining fields from @var{file2}.
6011 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6015 @item -a @var{file-number}
6017 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number} (either
6018 @samp{1} or @samp{2}), in addition to the normal output.
6021 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
6023 @item --nocheck-order
6024 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order. This is the default.
6026 @item -e @var{string}
6028 Replace those output fields that are missing in the input with @var{string}.
6029 I.e., missing fields specified with the @option{-12jo} options.
6033 Treat the first line of each input file as a header line. The header lines
6034 will be joined and printed as the first output line. If @option{-o} is used to
6035 specify output format, the header line will be printed according to the
6036 specified format. The header lines will not be checked for ordering even if
6037 @option{--check-order} is specified. Also if the header lines from each file
6038 do not match, the heading fields from the first file will be used.
6041 @itemx --ignore-case
6043 @opindex --ignore-case
6044 Ignore differences in case when comparing keys.
6045 With this option, the lines of the input files must be ordered in the same way.
6046 Use @samp{sort -f} to produce this ordering.
6048 @item -1 @var{field}
6050 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 1.
6052 @item -2 @var{field}
6054 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 2.
6056 @item -j @var{field}
6057 Equivalent to @option{-1 @var{field} -2 @var{field}}.
6059 @item -o @var{field-list}
6061 If the keyword @samp{auto} is specified, infer the output format from
6062 the first line in each file. This is the same as the default output format
6063 but also ensures the same number of fields are output for each line.
6064 Missing fields are replaced with the @option{-e} option and extra fields
6067 Otherwise, construct each output line according to the format in
6068 @var{field-list}. Each element in @var{field-list} is either the single
6069 character @samp{0} or has the form @var{m.n} where the file number, @var{m},
6070 is @samp{1} or @samp{2} and @var{n} is a positive field number.
6072 A field specification of @samp{0} denotes the join field.
6073 In most cases, the functionality of the @samp{0} field spec
6074 may be reproduced using the explicit @var{m.n} that corresponds
6075 to the join field. However, when printing unpairable lines
6076 (using either of the @option{-a} or @option{-v} options), there is no way
6077 to specify the join field using @var{m.n} in @var{field-list}
6078 if there are unpairable lines in both files.
6079 To give @command{join} that functionality, POSIX invented the @samp{0}
6080 field specification notation.
6082 The elements in @var{field-list}
6083 are separated by commas or blanks.
6084 Blank separators typically need to be quoted for the shell. For
6085 example, the commands @samp{join -o 1.2,2.2} and @samp{join -o '1.2
6086 2.2'} are equivalent.
6088 All output lines---including those printed because of any -a or -v
6089 option---are subject to the specified @var{field-list}.
6092 Use character @var{char} as the input and output field separator.
6093 Treat as significant each occurrence of @var{char} in the input file.
6094 Use @samp{sort -t @var{char}}, without the @option{-b} option of
6095 @samp{sort}, to produce this ordering. If @samp{join -t ''} is specified,
6096 the whole line is considered, matching the default operation of sort.
6097 If @samp{-t '\0'} is specified then the ASCII NUL
6098 character is used to delimit the fields.
6100 @item -v @var{file-number}
6101 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number}
6102 (either @samp{1} or @samp{2}), instead of the normal output.
6111 @node Operating on characters
6112 @chapter Operating on characters
6114 @cindex operating on characters
6116 These commands operate on individual characters.
6119 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
6120 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
6121 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
6126 @section @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
6133 tr [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{set1} [@var{set2}]
6136 @command{tr} copies standard input to standard output, performing
6137 one of the following operations:
6141 translate, and optionally squeeze repeated characters in the result,
6143 squeeze repeated characters,
6147 delete characters, then squeeze repeated characters from the result.
6150 The @var{set1} and (if given) @var{set2} arguments define ordered
6151 sets of characters, referred to below as @var{set1} and @var{set2}. These
6152 sets are the characters of the input that @command{tr} operates on.
6153 The @option{--complement} (@option{-c}, @option{-C}) option replaces
6155 complement (all of the characters that are not in @var{set1}).
6157 Currently @command{tr} fully supports only single-byte characters.
6158 Eventually it will support multibyte characters; when it does, the
6159 @option{-C} option will cause it to complement the set of characters,
6160 whereas @option{-c} will cause it to complement the set of values.
6161 This distinction will matter only when some values are not characters,
6162 and this is possible only in locales using multibyte encodings when
6163 the input contains encoding errors.
6165 The program accepts the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
6166 options. @xref{Common options}. Options must precede operands.
6171 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
6172 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
6173 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting.
6177 @node Character sets
6178 @subsection Specifying sets of characters
6180 @cindex specifying sets of characters
6182 The format of the @var{set1} and @var{set2} arguments resembles
6183 the format of regular expressions; however, they are not regular
6184 expressions, only lists of characters. Most characters simply
6185 represent themselves in these strings, but the strings can contain
6186 the shorthands listed below, for convenience. Some of them can be
6187 used only in @var{set1} or @var{set2}, as noted below.
6191 @item Backslash escapes
6192 @cindex backslash escapes
6194 The following backslash escape sequences are recognized:
6212 The 8-bit character with the value given by @var{ooo}, which is 1 to 3
6213 octal digits. Note that @samp{\400} is interpreted as the two-byte
6214 sequence, @samp{\040} @samp{0}.
6219 While a backslash followed by a character not listed above is
6220 interpreted as that character, the backslash also effectively
6221 removes any special significance, so it is useful to escape
6222 @samp{[}, @samp{]}, @samp{*}, and @samp{-}.
6227 The notation @samp{@var{m}-@var{n}} expands to all of the characters
6228 from @var{m} through @var{n}, in ascending order. @var{m} should
6229 collate before @var{n}; if it doesn't, an error results. As an example,
6230 @samp{0-9} is the same as @samp{0123456789}.
6232 GNU @command{tr} does not support the System V syntax that uses square
6233 brackets to enclose ranges. Translations specified in that format
6234 sometimes work as expected, since the brackets are often transliterated
6235 to themselves. However, they should be avoided because they sometimes
6236 behave unexpectedly. For example, @samp{tr -d '[0-9]'} deletes brackets
6239 Many historically common and even accepted uses of ranges are not
6240 portable. For example, on EBCDIC hosts using the @samp{A-Z}
6241 range will not do what most would expect because @samp{A} through @samp{Z}
6242 are not contiguous as they are in ASCII@.
6243 If you can rely on a POSIX compliant version of @command{tr}, then
6244 the best way to work around this is to use character classes (see below).
6245 Otherwise, it is most portable (and most ugly) to enumerate the members
6248 @item Repeated characters
6249 @cindex repeated characters
6251 The notation @samp{[@var{c}*@var{n}]} in @var{set2} expands to @var{n}
6252 copies of character @var{c}. Thus, @samp{[y*6]} is the same as
6253 @samp{yyyyyy}. The notation @samp{[@var{c}*]} in @var{string2} expands
6254 to as many copies of @var{c} as are needed to make @var{set2} as long as
6255 @var{set1}. If @var{n} begins with @samp{0}, it is interpreted in
6256 octal, otherwise in decimal.
6258 @item Character classes
6259 @cindex character classes
6261 The notation @samp{[:@var{class}:]} expands to all of the characters in
6262 the (predefined) class @var{class}. The characters expand in no
6263 particular order, except for the @code{upper} and @code{lower} classes,
6264 which expand in ascending order. When the @option{--delete} (@option{-d})
6265 and @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) options are both given, any
6266 character class can be used in @var{set2}. Otherwise, only the
6267 character classes @code{lower} and @code{upper} are accepted in
6268 @var{set2}, and then only if the corresponding character class
6269 (@code{upper} and @code{lower}, respectively) is specified in the same
6270 relative position in @var{set1}. Doing this specifies case conversion.
6271 The class names are given below; an error results when an invalid class
6283 Horizontal whitespace.
6292 Printable characters, not including space.
6298 Printable characters, including space.
6301 Punctuation characters.
6304 Horizontal or vertical whitespace.
6313 @item Equivalence classes
6314 @cindex equivalence classes
6316 The syntax @samp{[=@var{c}=]} expands to all of the characters that are
6317 equivalent to @var{c}, in no particular order. Equivalence classes are
6318 a relatively recent invention intended to support non-English alphabets.
6319 But there seems to be no standard way to define them or determine their
6320 contents. Therefore, they are not fully implemented in GNU @command{tr};
6321 each character's equivalence class consists only of that character,
6322 which is of no particular use.
6328 @subsection Translating
6330 @cindex translating characters
6332 @command{tr} performs translation when @var{set1} and @var{set2} are
6333 both given and the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option is not given.
6334 @command{tr} translates each character of its input that is in @var{set1}
6335 to the corresponding character in @var{set2}. Characters not in
6336 @var{set1} are passed through unchanged. When a character appears more
6337 than once in @var{set1} and the corresponding characters in @var{set2}
6338 are not all the same, only the final one is used. For example, these
6339 two commands are equivalent:
6346 A common use of @command{tr} is to convert lowercase characters to
6347 uppercase. This can be done in many ways. Here are three of them:
6350 tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
6352 tr '[:lower:]' '[:upper:]'
6356 But note that using ranges like @code{a-z} above is not portable.
6358 When @command{tr} is performing translation, @var{set1} and @var{set2}
6359 typically have the same length. If @var{set1} is shorter than
6360 @var{set2}, the extra characters at the end of @var{set2} are ignored.
6362 On the other hand, making @var{set1} longer than @var{set2} is not
6363 portable; POSIX says that the result is undefined. In this situation,
6364 BSD @command{tr} pads @var{set2} to the length of @var{set1} by repeating
6365 the last character of @var{set2} as many times as necessary. System V
6366 @command{tr} truncates @var{set1} to the length of @var{set2}.
6368 By default, GNU @command{tr} handles this case like BSD @command{tr}.
6369 When the @option{--truncate-set1} (@option{-t}) option is given,
6370 GNU @command{tr} handles this case like the System V @command{tr}
6371 instead. This option is ignored for operations other than translation.
6373 Acting like System V @command{tr} in this case breaks the relatively common
6377 tr -cs A-Za-z0-9 '\012'
6381 because it converts only zero bytes (the first element in the
6382 complement of @var{set1}), rather than all non-alphanumerics, to
6386 By the way, the above idiom is not portable because it uses ranges, and
6387 it assumes that the octal code for newline is 012.
6388 Assuming a POSIX compliant @command{tr}, here is a better
6392 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
6397 @subsection Squeezing repeats and deleting
6399 @cindex squeezing repeat characters
6400 @cindex deleting characters
6402 When given just the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option, @command{tr}
6403 removes any input characters that are in @var{set1}.
6405 When given just the @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) option,
6406 @command{tr} replaces each input sequence of a repeated character that
6407 is in @var{set1} with a single occurrence of that character.
6409 When given both @option{--delete} and @option{--squeeze-repeats}, @command{tr}
6410 first performs any deletions using @var{set1}, then squeezes repeats
6411 from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
6413 The @option{--squeeze-repeats} option may also be used when translating,
6414 in which case @command{tr} first performs translation, then squeezes
6415 repeats from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
6417 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options:
6422 Remove all zero bytes:
6429 Put all words on lines by themselves. This converts all
6430 non-alphanumeric characters to newlines, then squeezes each string
6431 of repeated newlines into a single newline:
6434 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
6438 Convert each sequence of repeated newlines to a single newline:
6445 Find doubled occurrences of words in a document.
6446 @c Separate the following two "the"s, so typo checkers don't complain.
6447 For example, people often write ``the @w{}the'' with the repeated words
6448 separated by a newline. The Bourne shell script below works first
6449 by converting each sequence of punctuation and blank characters to a
6450 single newline. That puts each ``word'' on a line by itself.
6451 Next it maps all uppercase characters to lower case, and finally it
6452 runs @command{uniq} with the @option{-d} option to print out only the words
6458 | tr -s '[:punct:][:blank:]' '[\n*]' \
6459 | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' \
6464 Deleting a small set of characters is usually straightforward. For example,
6465 to remove all @samp{a}s, @samp{x}s, and @samp{M}s you would do this:
6471 However, when @samp{-} is one of those characters, it can be tricky because
6472 @samp{-} has special meanings. Performing the same task as above but also
6473 removing all @samp{-} characters, we might try @code{tr -d -axM}, but
6474 that would fail because @command{tr} would try to interpret @option{-a} as
6475 a command-line option. Alternatively, we could try putting the hyphen
6476 inside the string, @code{tr -d a-xM}, but that wouldn't work either because
6477 it would make @command{tr} interpret @code{a-x} as the range of characters
6478 @samp{a}@dots{}@samp{x} rather than the three.
6479 One way to solve the problem is to put the hyphen at the end of the list
6486 Or you can use @samp{--} to terminate option processing:
6492 More generally, use the character class notation @code{[=c=]}
6493 with @samp{-} (or any other character) in place of the @samp{c}:
6499 Note how single quotes are used in the above example to protect the
6500 square brackets from interpretation by a shell.
6505 @node expand invocation
6506 @section @command{expand}: Convert tabs to spaces
6509 @cindex tabs to spaces, converting
6510 @cindex converting tabs to spaces
6512 @command{expand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or standard
6513 input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to standard
6514 output, with tab characters converted to the appropriate number of
6518 expand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6521 By default, @command{expand} converts all tabs to spaces. It preserves
6522 backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column count for
6523 tab calculations. The default action is equivalent to @option{-t 8} (set
6524 tabs every 8 columns).
6526 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6530 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6531 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6534 @cindex tab stops, setting
6535 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} spaces apart
6536 (default is 8). Otherwise, set the tabs at columns @var{tab1},
6537 @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and replace any tabs beyond the
6538 last tab stop given with single spaces. Tab stops can be separated by
6539 blanks as well as by commas.
6541 For compatibility, GNU @command{expand} also accepts the obsolete
6542 option syntax, @option{-@var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}}. New scripts
6543 should use @option{-t @var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}} instead.
6549 @cindex initial tabs, converting
6550 Only convert initial tabs (those that precede all non-space or non-tab
6551 characters) on each line to spaces.
6558 @node unexpand invocation
6559 @section @command{unexpand}: Convert spaces to tabs
6563 @command{unexpand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or
6564 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to
6565 standard output, converting blanks at the beginning of each line into
6566 as many tab characters as needed. In the default POSIX
6567 locale, a @dfn{blank} is a space or a tab; other locales may specify
6568 additional blank characters. Synopsis:
6571 unexpand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6574 By default, @command{unexpand} converts only initial blanks (those
6575 that precede all non-blank characters) on each line. It
6576 preserves backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column
6577 count for tab calculations. By default, tabs are set at every 8th
6580 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6584 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6585 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6588 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} columns apart
6589 instead of the default 8. Otherwise, set the tabs at columns
6590 @var{tab1}, @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and leave blanks
6591 beyond the tab stops given unchanged. Tab stops can be separated by
6592 blanks as well as by commas. This option implies the @option{-a} option.
6594 For compatibility, GNU @command{unexpand} supports the obsolete option syntax,
6595 @option{-@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}}, where tab stops must be
6596 separated by commas. (Unlike @option{-t}, this obsolete option does
6597 not imply @option{-a}.) New scripts should use @option{--first-only -t
6598 @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}} instead.
6604 Also convert all sequences of two or more blanks just before a tab stop,
6605 even if they occur after non-blank characters in a line.
6612 @node Directory listing
6613 @chapter Directory listing
6615 This chapter describes the @command{ls} command and its variants @command{dir}
6616 and @command{vdir}, which list information about files.
6619 * ls invocation:: List directory contents.
6620 * dir invocation:: Briefly ls.
6621 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely ls.
6622 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for ls, etc.
6627 @section @command{ls}: List directory contents
6630 @cindex directory listing
6632 The @command{ls} program lists information about files (of any type,
6633 including directories). Options and file arguments can be intermixed
6634 arbitrarily, as usual.
6636 For non-option command-line arguments that are directories, by default
6637 @command{ls} lists the contents of directories, not recursively, and
6638 omitting files with names beginning with @samp{.}. For other non-option
6639 arguments, by default @command{ls} lists just the file name. If no
6640 non-option argument is specified, @command{ls} operates on the current
6641 directory, acting as if it had been invoked with a single argument of @samp{.}.
6644 By default, the output is sorted alphabetically, according to the locale
6645 settings in effect.@footnote{If you use a non-POSIX
6646 locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL} to @samp{en_US}), then @command{ls} may
6647 produce output that is sorted differently than you're accustomed to.
6648 In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable to @samp{C}.}
6649 If standard output is
6650 a terminal, the output is in columns (sorted vertically) and control
6651 characters are output as question marks; otherwise, the output is listed
6652 one per line and control characters are output as-is.
6654 Because @command{ls} is such a fundamental program, it has accumulated many
6655 options over the years. They are described in the subsections below;
6656 within each section, options are listed alphabetically (ignoring case).
6657 The division of options into the subsections is not absolute, since some
6658 options affect more than one aspect of @command{ls}'s operation.
6660 @cindex exit status of @command{ls}
6665 1 minor problems (e.g., failure to access a file or directory not
6666 specified as a command line argument. This happens when listing a
6667 directory in which entries are actively being removed or renamed.)
6668 2 serious trouble (e.g., memory exhausted, invalid option, failure
6669 to access a file or directory specified as a command line argument
6670 or a directory loop)
6673 Also see @ref{Common options}.
6676 * Which files are listed::
6677 * What information is listed::
6678 * Sorting the output::
6679 * Details about version sort::
6680 * General output formatting::
6681 * Formatting file timestamps::
6682 * Formatting the file names::
6686 @node Which files are listed
6687 @subsection Which files are listed
6689 These options determine which files @command{ls} lists information for.
6690 By default, @command{ls} lists files and the contents of any
6691 directories on the command line, except that in directories it ignores
6692 files whose names start with @samp{.}.
6700 In directories, do not ignore file names that start with @samp{.}.
6705 @opindex --almost-all
6706 In directories, do not ignore all file names that start with @samp{.};
6707 ignore only @file{.} and @file{..}. The @option{--all} (@option{-a})
6708 option overrides this option.
6711 @itemx --ignore-backups
6713 @opindex --ignore-backups
6714 @cindex backup files, ignoring
6715 In directories, ignore files that end with @samp{~}. This option is
6716 equivalent to @samp{--ignore='*~' --ignore='.*~'}.
6721 @opindex --directory
6722 List just the names of directories, as with other types of files, rather
6723 than listing their contents.
6724 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -F.
6725 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
6726 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
6727 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6728 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
6731 @itemx --dereference-command-line
6733 @opindex --dereference-command-line
6734 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6735 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, show information
6736 for the file the link references rather than for the link itself.
6738 @item --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
6739 @opindex --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
6740 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6741 Do not dereference symbolic links, with one exception:
6742 if a command line argument specifies a symbolic link that refers to
6743 a directory, show information for that directory rather than for the
6745 This is the default behavior when no other dereferencing-related
6746 option has been specified (@option{--classify} (@option{-F}),
6747 @option{--directory} (@option{-d}),
6749 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6750 @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H})).
6752 @item --group-directories-first
6753 @opindex --group-directories-first
6754 Group all the directories before the files and then sort the
6755 directories and the files separately using the selected sort key
6756 (see --sort option).
6757 That is, this option specifies a primary sort key,
6758 and the --sort option specifies a secondary key.
6759 However, any use of @option{--sort=none}
6760 (@option{-U}) disables this option altogether.
6762 @item --hide=PATTERN
6763 @opindex --hide=@var{pattern}
6764 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
6765 @var{pattern}, unless the @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or
6766 @option{--almost-all} (@option{-A}) is also given. This
6767 option acts like @option{--ignore=@var{pattern}} except that it has no
6768 effect if @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or @option{--almost-all}
6769 (@option{-A}) is also given.
6771 This option can be useful in shell aliases. For example, if
6772 @command{lx} is an alias for @samp{ls --hide='*~'} and @command{ly} is
6773 an alias for @samp{ls --ignore='*~'}, then the command @samp{lx -A}
6774 lists the file @file{README~} even though @samp{ly -A} would not.
6776 @item -I @var{pattern}
6777 @itemx --ignore=@var{pattern}
6779 @opindex --ignore=@var{pattern}
6780 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
6781 (not regular expression) @var{pattern}. As
6782 in the shell, an initial @samp{.} in a file name does not match a
6783 wildcard at the start of @var{pattern}. Sometimes it is useful
6784 to give this option several times. For example,
6787 $ ls --ignore='.??*' --ignore='.[^.]' --ignore='#*'
6790 The first option ignores names of length 3 or more that start with @samp{.},
6791 the second ignores all two-character names that start with @samp{.}
6792 except @samp{..}, and the third ignores names that start with @samp{#}.
6795 @itemx --dereference
6797 @opindex --dereference
6798 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6799 When showing file information for a symbolic link, show information
6800 for the file the link references rather than the link itself.
6801 However, even with this option, @command{ls} still prints the name
6802 of the link itself, not the name of the file that the link points to.
6807 @opindex --recursive
6808 @cindex recursive directory listing
6809 @cindex directory listing, recursive
6810 List the contents of all directories recursively.
6815 @node What information is listed
6816 @subsection What information is listed
6818 These options affect the information that @command{ls} displays. By
6819 default, only file names are shown.
6825 @cindex hurd, author, printing
6826 List each file's author when producing long format directory listings.
6827 In GNU/Hurd, file authors can differ from their owners, but in other
6828 operating systems the two are the same.
6834 @cindex dired Emacs mode support
6835 With the long listing (@option{-l}) format, print an additional line after
6839 //DIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @var{beg2} @var{end2} @dots{}
6843 The @var{begn} and @var{endn} are unsigned integers that record the
6844 byte position of the beginning and end of each file name in the output.
6845 This makes it easy for Emacs to find the names, even when they contain
6846 unusual characters such as space or newline, without fancy searching.
6848 If directories are being listed recursively (@option{-R}), output a similar
6849 line with offsets for each subdirectory name:
6852 //SUBDIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @dots{}
6855 Finally, output a line of the form:
6858 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=@var{word}
6862 where @var{word} is the quoting style (@pxref{Formatting the file names}).
6864 Here is an actual example:
6867 $ mkdir -p a/sub/deeper a/sub2
6869 $ touch a/sub/deeper/file
6870 $ ls -gloRF --dired a
6873 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f1
6874 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f2
6875 drwxr-xr-x 3 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub/
6876 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub2/
6880 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 deeper/
6884 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 file
6888 //DIRED// 48 50 84 86 120 123 158 162 217 223 282 286
6889 //SUBDIRED// 2 3 167 172 228 240 290 296
6890 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=literal
6893 Note that the pairs of offsets on the @samp{//DIRED//} line above delimit
6894 these names: @file{f1}, @file{f2}, @file{sub}, @file{sub2}, @file{deeper},
6896 The offsets on the @samp{//SUBDIRED//} line delimit the following
6897 directory names: @file{a}, @file{a/sub}, @file{a/sub/deeper}, @file{a/sub2}.
6899 Here is an example of how to extract the fifth entry name, @samp{deeper},
6900 corresponding to the pair of offsets, 222 and 228:
6903 $ ls -gloRF --dired a > out
6904 $ dd bs=1 skip=222 count=6 < out 2>/dev/null; echo
6908 Note that although the listing above includes a trailing slash
6909 for the @samp{deeper} entry, the offsets select the name without
6910 the trailing slash. However, if you invoke @command{ls} with @option{--dired}
6911 along with an option like @option{--escape} (aka @option{-b}) and operate
6912 on a file whose name contains special characters, notice that the backslash
6917 $ ls -blog --dired 'a b'
6918 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:28 a\ b
6920 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=escape
6923 If you use a quoting style that adds quote marks
6924 (e.g., @option{--quoting-style=c}), then the offsets include the quote marks.
6925 So beware that the user may select the quoting style via the environment
6926 variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. Hence, applications using @option{--dired}
6927 should either specify an explicit @option{--quoting-style=literal} option
6928 (aka @option{-N} or @option{--literal}) on the command line, or else be
6929 prepared to parse the escaped names.
6932 @opindex --full-time
6933 Produce long format directory listings, and list times in full. It is
6934 equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with
6935 @option{--time-style=full-iso} (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}).
6939 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display owner information.
6945 Inhibit display of group information in a long format directory listing.
6946 (This is the default in some non-GNU versions of @command{ls}, so we
6947 provide this option for compatibility.)
6955 @cindex inode number, printing
6956 Print the inode number (also called the file serial number and index
6957 number) of each file to the left of the file name. (This number
6958 uniquely identifies each file within a particular file system.)
6961 @itemx --format=long
6962 @itemx --format=verbose
6965 @opindex long ls @r{format}
6966 @opindex verbose ls @r{format}
6967 In addition to the name of each file, print the file type, file mode bits,
6968 number of hard links, owner name, group name, size, and
6969 timestamp (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}), normally
6970 the modification time. Print question marks for information that
6971 cannot be determined.
6973 Normally the size is printed as a byte count without punctuation, but
6974 this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}). For example, @option{-h}
6975 prints an abbreviated, human-readable count, and
6976 @samp{--block-size="'1"} prints a byte count with the thousands
6977 separator of the current locale.
6979 For each directory that is listed, preface the files with a line
6980 @samp{total @var{blocks}}, where @var{blocks} is the total disk allocation
6981 for all files in that directory. The block size currently defaults to 1024
6982 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6983 The @var{blocks} computed counts each hard link separately;
6984 this is arguably a deficiency.
6986 The file type is one of the following characters:
6988 @c The commented-out entries are ones we're not sure about.
6996 character special file
6998 high performance (``contiguous data'') file
7002 door (Solaris 2.5 and up)
7004 @c semaphore, if this is a distinct file type
7008 @c multiplexed file (7th edition Unix; obsolete)
7010 off-line (``migrated'') file (Cray DMF)
7012 network special file (HP-UX)
7016 port (Solaris 10 and up)
7018 @c message queue, if this is a distinct file type
7022 @c shared memory object, if this is a distinct file type
7024 @c typed memory object, if this is a distinct file type
7026 @c whiteout (4.4BSD; not implemented)
7028 some other file type
7031 @cindex permissions, output by @command{ls}
7032 The file mode bits listed are similar to symbolic mode specifications
7033 (@pxref{Symbolic Modes}). But @command{ls} combines multiple bits into the
7034 third character of each set of permissions as follows:
7038 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit and the corresponding executable bit
7042 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit is set but the corresponding
7043 executable bit is not set.
7046 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit, and the
7047 other-executable bit, are both set. The restricted deletion flag is
7048 another name for the sticky bit. @xref{Mode Structure}.
7051 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit is set but the
7052 other-executable bit is not set.
7055 If the executable bit is set and none of the above apply.
7061 Following the file mode bits is a single character that specifies
7062 whether an alternate access method such as an access control list
7063 applies to the file. When the character following the file mode bits is a
7064 space, there is no alternate access method. When it is a printing
7065 character, then there is such a method.
7067 GNU @command{ls} uses a @samp{.} character to indicate a file
7068 with a security context, but no other alternate access method.
7070 A file with any other combination of alternate access methods
7071 is marked with a @samp{+} character.
7074 @itemx --numeric-uid-gid
7076 @opindex --numeric-uid-gid
7077 @cindex numeric uid and gid
7078 @cindex numeric user and group IDs
7079 Produce long format directory listings, but
7080 display numeric user and group IDs instead of the owner and group names.
7084 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display group information.
7085 It is equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with @option{--no-group} .
7091 @cindex disk allocation
7092 @cindex size of files, reporting
7093 Print the disk allocation of each file to the left of the file name.
7094 This is the amount of disk space used by the file, which is usually a
7095 bit more than the file's size, but it can be less if the file has holes.
7097 Normally the disk allocation is printed in units of
7098 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
7100 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
7101 For files that are NFS-mounted from an HP-UX system to a BSD system,
7102 this option reports sizes that are half the correct values. On HP-UX
7103 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for files
7104 that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw in HP-UX;
7105 it also affects the HP-UX @command{ls} program.
7114 @cindex security context
7115 Display the SELinux security context or @samp{?} if none is found.
7116 When used with the @option{-l} option, print the security context
7117 to the left of the size column.
7122 @node Sorting the output
7123 @subsection Sorting the output
7125 @cindex sorting @command{ls} output
7126 These options change the order in which @command{ls} sorts the information
7127 it outputs. By default, sorting is done by character code
7128 (e.g., ASCII order).
7134 @itemx --time=status
7137 @opindex ctime@r{, printing or sorting by}
7138 @opindex status time@r{, printing or sorting by}
7139 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
7140 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{-l}, @option{-o}) is being used,
7141 print the status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) instead of
7142 the modification time.
7143 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
7144 or when not using a long listing format,
7145 sort according to the status change time.
7149 @cindex unsorted directory listing
7150 @cindex directory order, listing by
7151 Primarily, like @option{-U}---do not sort; list the files in whatever
7152 order they are stored in the directory. But also enable @option{-a} (list
7153 all files) and disable @option{-l}, @option{--color}, and @option{-s} (if they
7154 were specified before the @option{-f}).
7160 @cindex reverse sorting
7161 Reverse whatever the sorting method is---e.g., list files in reverse
7162 alphabetical order, youngest first, smallest first, or whatever.
7168 @opindex size of files@r{, sorting files by}
7169 Sort by file size, largest first.
7175 @opindex modification time@r{, sorting files by}
7176 Sort by modification time (the @samp{mtime} in the inode), newest first.
7180 @itemx --time=access
7184 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
7185 @opindex atime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
7186 @opindex access time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
7187 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{--format=long}) is being used,
7188 print the last access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode).
7189 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
7190 or when not using a long listing format, sort according to the access time.
7196 @opindex none@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
7197 Do not sort; list the files in whatever order they are
7198 stored in the directory. (Do not do any of the other unrelated things
7199 that @option{-f} does.) This is especially useful when listing very large
7200 directories, since not doing any sorting can be noticeably faster.
7203 @itemx --sort=version
7206 @opindex version@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
7207 Sort by version name and number, lowest first. It behaves like a default
7208 sort, except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
7209 as an index/version number. (@xref{Details about version sort}.)
7212 @itemx --sort=extension
7215 @opindex extension@r{, sorting files by}
7216 Sort directory contents alphabetically by file extension (characters
7217 after the last @samp{.}); files with no extension are sorted first.
7222 @node Details about version sort
7223 @subsection Details about version sort
7225 Version sorting handles the fact that file names frequently include indices or
7226 version numbers. Standard sorting usually does not produce the order that one
7227 expects because comparisons are made on a character-by-character basis.
7228 Version sorting is especially useful when browsing directories that contain
7229 many files with indices/version numbers in their names:
7233 abc.zml-1.gz abc.zml-1.gz
7234 abc.zml-12.gz abc.zml-2.gz
7235 abc.zml-2.gz abc.zml-12.gz
7238 Version-sorted strings are compared such that if @var{ver1} and @var{ver2}
7239 are version numbers and @var{prefix} and @var{suffix} (@var{suffix} matching
7240 the regular expression @samp{(\.[A-Za-z~][A-Za-z0-9~]*)*}) are strings then
7241 @var{ver1} < @var{ver2} implies that the name composed of
7242 ``@var{prefix} @var{ver1} @var{suffix}'' sorts before
7243 ``@var{prefix} @var{ver2} @var{suffix}''.
7245 Note also that leading zeros of numeric parts are ignored:
7249 abc-1.007.tgz abc-1.01a.tgz
7250 abc-1.012b.tgz abc-1.007.tgz
7251 abc-1.01a.tgz abc-1.012b.tgz
7254 This functionality is implemented using gnulib's @code{filevercmp} function,
7255 which has some caveats worth noting.
7258 @item @env{LC_COLLATE} is ignored, which means @samp{ls -v} and @samp{sort -V}
7259 will sort non-numeric prefixes as if the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale category
7260 was set to @samp{C}@.
7261 @item Some suffixes will not be matched by the regular
7262 expression mentioned above. Consequently these examples may
7263 not sort as you expect:
7271 abc-1.2.3.4.x86_64.rpm
7272 abc-1.2.3.x86_64.rpm
7276 @node General output formatting
7277 @subsection General output formatting
7279 These options affect the appearance of the overall output.
7284 @itemx --format=single-column
7287 @opindex single-column @r{output of files}
7288 List one file per line. This is the default for @command{ls} when standard
7289 output is not a terminal. See also the @option{-b} and @option{-q} options
7290 to suppress direct output of newline characters within a file name.
7293 @itemx --format=vertical
7296 @opindex vertical @r{sorted files in columns}
7297 List files in columns, sorted vertically. This is the default for
7298 @command{ls} if standard output is a terminal. It is always the default
7299 for the @command{dir} program.
7300 GNU @command{ls} uses variable width columns to display as many files as
7301 possible in the fewest lines.
7303 @item --color [=@var{when}]
7305 @cindex color, distinguishing file types with
7306 Specify whether to use color for distinguishing file types. @var{when}
7307 may be omitted, or one of:
7310 @vindex none @r{color option}
7311 - Do not use color at all. This is the default.
7313 @vindex auto @r{color option}
7314 @cindex terminal, using color iff
7315 - Only use color if standard output is a terminal.
7317 @vindex always @r{color option}
7320 Specifying @option{--color} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
7321 @option{--color=always}.
7322 Piping a colorized listing through a pager like @command{more} or
7323 @command{less} usually produces unreadable results. However, using
7324 @code{more -f} does seem to work.
7327 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
7328 Note that using the @option{--color} option may incur a noticeable
7329 performance penalty when run in a directory with very many entries,
7330 because the default settings require that @command{ls} @code{stat} every
7331 single file it lists.
7332 However, if you would like most of the file-type coloring
7333 but can live without the other coloring options (e.g.,
7334 executable, orphan, sticky, other-writable, capability), use
7335 @command{dircolors} to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment variable like this,
7337 eval $(dircolors -p | perl -pe \
7338 's/^((CAP|S[ET]|O[TR]|M|E)\w+).*/$1 00/' | dircolors -)
7340 and on a @code{dirent.d_type}-capable file system, @command{ls}
7341 will perform only one @code{stat} call per command line argument.
7345 @itemx --indicator-style=classify
7348 @opindex --indicator-style
7349 @cindex file type and executables, marking
7350 @cindex executables and file type, marking
7351 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. Also,
7352 for regular files that are executable, append @samp{*}. The file type
7353 indicators are @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links,
7354 @samp{|} for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, @samp{>} for doors,
7355 and nothing for regular files.
7356 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -d.
7357 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
7358 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
7359 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
7360 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
7363 @itemx --indicator-style=file-type
7364 @opindex --file-type
7365 @opindex --indicator-style
7366 @cindex file type, marking
7367 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. This is
7368 like @option{-F}, except that executables are not marked.
7370 @item --indicator-style=@var{word}
7371 @opindex --indicator-style
7372 Append a character indicator with style @var{word} to entry names,
7377 Do not append any character indicator; this is the default.
7379 Append @samp{/} for directories. This is the same as the @option{-p}
7382 Append @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links, @samp{|}
7383 for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, and nothing for regular files. This is
7384 the same as the @option{--file-type} option.
7386 Append @samp{*} for executable regular files, otherwise behave as for
7387 @samp{file-type}. This is the same as the @option{-F} or
7388 @option{--classify} option.
7394 @opindex --kibibytes
7395 Set the default block size to its normal value of 1024 bytes,
7396 overriding any contrary specification in environment variables
7397 (@pxref{Block size}). This option is in turn overridden by the
7398 @option{--block-size}, @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable}, and
7399 @option{--si} options.
7401 The @option{-k} or @option{--kibibytes} option affects the
7402 per-directory block count written by the @option{-l} and similar
7403 options, and the size written by the @option{-s} or @option{--size}
7404 option. It does not affect the file size written by @option{-l}.
7407 @itemx --format=commas
7410 @opindex commas@r{, outputting between files}
7411 List files horizontally, with as many as will fit on each line,
7412 separated by @samp{, } (a comma and a space).
7415 @itemx --indicator-style=slash
7417 @opindex --indicator-style
7418 @cindex file type, marking
7419 Append a @samp{/} to directory names.
7422 @itemx --format=across
7423 @itemx --format=horizontal
7426 @opindex across@r{, listing files}
7427 @opindex horizontal@r{, listing files}
7428 List the files in columns, sorted horizontally.
7431 @itemx --tabsize=@var{cols}
7434 Assume that each tab stop is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is 8.
7435 @command{ls} uses tabs where possible in the output, for efficiency. If
7436 @var{cols} is zero, do not use tabs at all.
7438 Some terminal emulators might not properly align columns to the right of a
7439 TAB following a non-ASCII byte. You can avoid that issue by using the
7440 @option{-T0} option or put @code{TABSIZE=0} in your environment, to tell
7441 @command{ls} to align using spaces, not tabs.
7444 @itemx --width=@var{cols}
7448 Assume the screen is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is taken
7449 from the terminal settings if possible; otherwise the environment
7450 variable @env{COLUMNS} is used if it is set; otherwise the default
7456 @node Formatting file timestamps
7457 @subsection Formatting file timestamps
7459 By default, file timestamps are listed in abbreviated form, using
7460 a date like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002} for non-recent timestamps, and a
7461 date-without-year and time like @samp{Mar 30 23:45} for recent timestamps.
7462 This format can change depending on the current locale as detailed below.
7465 A timestamp is considered to be @dfn{recent} if it is less than six
7466 months old, and is not dated in the future. If a timestamp dated
7467 today is not listed in recent form, the timestamp is in the future,
7468 which means you probably have clock skew problems which may break
7469 programs like @command{make} that rely on file timestamps.
7472 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
7473 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
7474 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
7475 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
7477 The following option changes how file timestamps are printed.
7480 @item --time-style=@var{style}
7481 @opindex --time-style
7483 List timestamps in style @var{style}. The @var{style} should
7484 be one of the following:
7489 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
7490 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
7491 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
7492 @command{ls} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
7493 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
7494 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
7496 If @var{format} contains two format strings separated by a newline,
7497 the former is used for non-recent files and the latter for recent
7498 files; if you want output columns to line up, you may need to insert
7499 spaces in one of the two formats.
7502 List timestamps in full using ISO 8601 date, time, and time zone
7503 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
7504 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
7505 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
7507 This is useful because the time output includes all the information that
7508 is available from the operating system. For example, this can help
7509 explain @command{make}'s behavior, since GNU @command{make}
7510 uses the full timestamp to determine whether a file is out of date.
7513 List ISO 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
7514 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
7515 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
7516 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
7519 List ISO 8601 dates for non-recent timestamps (e.g.,
7520 @samp{2002-03-30@ }), and ISO 8601 month, day, hour, and
7521 minute for recent timestamps (e.g., @samp{03-30 23:45}). These
7522 timestamps are uglier than @samp{long-iso} timestamps, but they carry
7523 nearly the same information in a smaller space and their brevity helps
7524 @command{ls} output fit within traditional 80-column output lines.
7525 The following two @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
7530 ls -l --time-style="+%Y-%m-%d $newline%m-%d %H:%M"
7531 ls -l --time-style="iso"
7536 List timestamps in a locale-dependent form. For example, a Finnish
7537 locale might list non-recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30@ @ 2002}
7538 and recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30 23:45}. Locale-dependent
7539 timestamps typically consume more space than @samp{iso} timestamps and
7540 are harder for programs to parse because locale conventions vary so
7541 widely, but they are easier for many people to read.
7543 The @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the timestamp format. The
7544 default POSIX locale uses timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@
7545 @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45}; in this locale, the following two
7546 @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
7551 ls -l --time-style="+%b %e %Y$newline%b %e %H:%M"
7552 ls -l --time-style="locale"
7555 Other locales behave differently. For example, in a German locale,
7556 @option{--time-style="locale"} might be equivalent to
7557 @option{--time-style="+%e. %b %Y $newline%e. %b %H:%M"}
7558 and might generate timestamps like @samp{30. M@"ar 2002@ } and
7559 @samp{30. M@"ar 23:45}.
7561 @item posix-@var{style}
7563 List POSIX-locale timestamps if the @env{LC_TIME} locale
7564 category is POSIX, @var{style} timestamps otherwise. For
7565 example, the @samp{posix-long-iso} style lists
7566 timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45} when in
7567 the POSIX locale, and like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45} otherwise.
7572 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
7573 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
7574 the default style is @samp{locale}. GNU Emacs 21.3 and
7575 later use the @option{--dired} option and therefore can parse any date
7576 format, but if you are using Emacs 21.1 or 21.2 and specify a
7577 non-POSIX locale you may need to set
7578 @samp{TIME_STYLE="posix-long-iso"}.
7580 To avoid certain denial-of-service attacks, timestamps that would be
7581 longer than 1000 bytes may be treated as errors.
7584 @node Formatting the file names
7585 @subsection Formatting the file names
7587 These options change how file names themselves are printed.
7593 @itemx --quoting-style=escape
7596 @opindex --quoting-style
7597 @cindex backslash sequences for file names
7598 Quote nongraphic characters in file names using alphabetic and octal
7599 backslash sequences like those used in C.
7603 @itemx --quoting-style=literal
7606 @opindex --quoting-style
7607 Do not quote file names. However, with @command{ls} nongraphic
7608 characters are still printed as question marks if the output is a
7609 terminal and you do not specify the @option{--show-control-chars}
7613 @itemx --hide-control-chars
7615 @opindex --hide-control-chars
7616 Print question marks instead of nongraphic characters in file names.
7617 This is the default if the output is a terminal and the program is
7622 @itemx --quoting-style=c
7624 @opindex --quote-name
7625 @opindex --quoting-style
7626 Enclose file names in double quotes and quote nongraphic characters as
7629 @item --quoting-style=@var{word}
7630 @opindex --quoting-style
7631 @cindex quoting style
7632 Use style @var{word} to quote file names and other strings that may
7633 contain arbitrary characters. The @var{word} should
7634 be one of the following:
7638 Output strings as-is; this is the same as the @option{-N} or
7639 @option{--literal} option.
7641 Quote strings for the shell if they contain shell metacharacters or would
7642 cause ambiguous output.
7643 The quoting is suitable for POSIX-compatible shells like
7644 @command{bash}, but it does not always work for incompatible shells
7647 Quote strings for the shell, even if they would normally not require quoting.
7649 Quote strings as for C character string literals, including the
7650 surrounding double-quote characters; this is the same as the
7651 @option{-Q} or @option{--quote-name} option.
7653 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except omit the
7654 surrounding double-quote
7655 characters; this is the same as the @option{-b} or @option{--escape} option.
7657 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
7658 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the
7661 @c Use @t instead of @samp to avoid duplicate quoting in some output styles.
7662 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
7663 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the locale, and quote
7664 @t{'like this'} instead of @t{"like
7665 this"} in the default C locale. This looks nicer on many displays.
7668 You can specify the default value of the @option{--quoting-style} option
7669 with the environment variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. If that environment
7670 variable is not set, the default value is @samp{literal}, but this
7671 default may change to @samp{shell} in a future version of this package.
7673 @item --show-control-chars
7674 @opindex --show-control-chars
7675 Print nongraphic characters as-is in file names.
7676 This is the default unless the output is a terminal and the program is
7682 @node dir invocation
7683 @section @command{dir}: Briefly list directory contents
7686 @cindex directory listing, brief
7688 @command{dir} is equivalent to @code{ls -C
7689 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in columns, sorted vertically,
7690 and special characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
7692 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
7695 @node vdir invocation
7696 @section @command{vdir}: Verbosely list directory contents
7699 @cindex directory listing, verbose
7701 @command{vdir} is equivalent to @code{ls -l
7702 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in long format and special
7703 characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
7705 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
7707 @node dircolors invocation
7708 @section @command{dircolors}: Color setup for @command{ls}
7712 @cindex setup for color
7714 @command{dircolors} outputs a sequence of shell commands to set up the
7715 terminal for color output from @command{ls} (and @command{dir}, etc.).
7719 eval "$(dircolors [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}])"
7722 If @var{file} is specified, @command{dircolors} reads it to determine which
7723 colors to use for which file types and extensions. Otherwise, a
7724 precompiled database is used. For details on the format of these files,
7725 run @samp{dircolors --print-database}.
7727 To make @command{dircolors} read a @file{~/.dircolors} file if it
7728 exists, you can put the following lines in your @file{~/.bashrc} (or
7729 adapt them to your favorite shell):
7733 test -r $d && eval "$(dircolors $d)"
7737 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
7738 The output is a shell command to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment
7739 variable. You can specify the shell syntax to use on the command line,
7740 or @command{dircolors} will guess it from the value of the @env{SHELL}
7741 environment variable.
7743 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7748 @itemx --bourne-shell
7751 @opindex --bourne-shell
7752 @cindex Bourne shell syntax for color setup
7753 @cindex @command{sh} syntax for color setup
7754 Output Bourne shell commands. This is the default if the @env{SHELL}
7755 environment variable is set and does not end with @samp{csh} or
7764 @cindex C shell syntax for color setup
7765 @cindex @command{csh} syntax for color setup
7766 Output C shell commands. This is the default if @code{SHELL} ends with
7767 @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}.
7770 @itemx --print-database
7772 @opindex --print-database
7773 @cindex color database, printing
7774 @cindex database for color setup, printing
7775 @cindex printing color database
7776 Print the (compiled-in) default color configuration database. This
7777 output is itself a valid configuration file, and is fairly descriptive
7778 of the possibilities.
7785 @node Basic operations
7786 @chapter Basic operations
7788 @cindex manipulating files
7790 This chapter describes the commands for basic file manipulation:
7791 copying, moving (renaming), and deleting (removing).
7794 * cp invocation:: Copy files.
7795 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file.
7796 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes.
7797 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files.
7798 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories.
7799 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely.
7804 @section @command{cp}: Copy files and directories
7807 @cindex copying files and directories
7808 @cindex files, copying
7809 @cindex directories, copying
7811 @command{cp} copies files (or, optionally, directories). The copy is
7812 completely independent of the original. You can either copy one file to
7813 another, or copy arbitrarily many files to a destination directory.
7817 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7818 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7819 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7824 If two file names are given, @command{cp} copies the first file to the
7828 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7829 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7830 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7831 @command{cp} copies each @var{source} file to the specified directory,
7832 using the @var{source}s' names.
7835 Generally, files are written just as they are read. For exceptions,
7836 see the @option{--sparse} option below.
7838 By default, @command{cp} does not copy directories. However, the
7839 @option{-R}, @option{-a}, and @option{-r} options cause @command{cp} to
7840 copy recursively by descending into source directories and copying files
7841 to corresponding destination directories.
7843 When copying from a symbolic link, @command{cp} normally follows the
7844 link only when not copying recursively or when @option{--link}
7845 (@option{-l}) is used. This default can be overridden with the
7846 @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d}, @option{--dereference}
7847 (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-P}), and
7848 @option{-H} options. If more than one of these options is specified,
7849 the last one silently overrides the others.
7851 When copying to a symbolic link, @command{cp} follows the
7852 link only when it refers to an existing regular file.
7853 However, when copying to a dangling symbolic link, @command{cp}
7854 refuses by default, and fails with a diagnostic, since the operation
7855 is inherently dangerous. This behavior is contrary to historical
7856 practice and to POSIX@.
7857 Set @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} to make @command{cp} attempt to create
7858 the target of a dangling destination symlink, in spite of the possible risk.
7859 Also, when an option like
7860 @option{--backup} or @option{--link} acts to rename or remove the
7861 destination before copying, @command{cp} renames or removes the
7862 symbolic link rather than the file it points to.
7864 By default, @command{cp} copies the contents of special files only
7865 when not copying recursively. This default can be overridden with the
7866 @option{--copy-contents} option.
7868 @cindex self-backups
7869 @cindex backups, making only
7870 @command{cp} generally refuses to copy a file onto itself, with the
7871 following exception: if @option{--force --backup} is specified with
7872 @var{source} and @var{dest} identical, and referring to a regular file,
7873 @command{cp} will make a backup file, either regular or numbered, as
7874 specified in the usual ways (@pxref{Backup options}). This is useful when
7875 you simply want to make a backup of an existing file before changing it.
7877 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7884 Preserve as much as possible of the structure and attributes of the
7885 original files in the copy (but do not attempt to preserve internal
7886 directory structure; i.e., @samp{ls -U} may list the entries in a copied
7887 directory in a different order).
7888 Try to preserve SELinux security context and extended attributes (xattr),
7889 but ignore any failure to do that and print no corresponding diagnostic.
7890 Equivalent to @option{-dR --preserve=all} with the reduced diagnostics.
7892 @item --attributes-only
7893 @opindex --attributes-only
7894 Copy only the specified attributes of the source file to the destination.
7895 If the destination already exists, do not alter its contents.
7896 See the @option{--preserve} option for controlling which attributes to copy.
7899 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
7902 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
7903 @cindex backups, making
7904 @xref{Backup options}.
7905 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
7906 As a special case, @command{cp} makes a backup of @var{source} when the force
7907 and backup options are given and @var{source} and @var{dest} are the same
7908 name for an existing, regular file. One useful application of this
7909 combination of options is this tiny Bourne shell script:
7913 # Usage: backup FILE...
7914 # Create a GNU-style backup of each listed FILE.
7917 cp --backup --force --preserve=all -- "$i" "$i" || fail=1
7922 @item --copy-contents
7923 @cindex directories, copying recursively
7924 @cindex copying directories recursively
7925 @cindex recursively copying directories
7926 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
7927 If copying recursively, copy the contents of any special files (e.g.,
7928 FIFOs and device files) as if they were regular files. This means
7929 trying to read the data in each source file and writing it to the
7930 destination. It is usually a mistake to use this option, as it
7931 normally has undesirable effects on special files like FIFOs and the
7932 ones typically found in the @file{/dev} directory. In most cases,
7933 @code{cp -R --copy-contents} will hang indefinitely trying to read
7934 from FIFOs and special files like @file{/dev/console}, and it will
7935 fill up your destination disk if you use it to copy @file{/dev/zero}.
7936 This option has no effect unless copying recursively, and it does not
7937 affect the copying of symbolic links.
7941 @cindex symbolic links, copying
7942 @cindex hard links, preserving
7943 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
7944 they point to, and preserve hard links between source files in the copies.
7945 Equivalent to @option{--no-dereference --preserve=links}.
7951 When copying without this option and an existing destination file cannot
7952 be opened for writing, the copy fails. However, with @option{--force},
7953 when a destination file cannot be opened, @command{cp} then removes it and
7954 tries to open it again. Contrast this behavior with that enabled by
7955 @option{--link} and @option{--symbolic-link}, whereby the destination file
7956 is never opened but rather is removed unconditionally. Also see the
7957 description of @option{--remove-destination}.
7959 This option is independent of the @option{--interactive} or
7960 @option{-i} option: neither cancels the effect of the other.
7962 This option is ignored when the @option{--no-clobber} or @option{-n} option
7967 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, then copy the
7968 file it points to rather than the symbolic link itself. However,
7969 copy (preserving its nature) any symbolic link that is encountered
7970 via recursive traversal.
7973 @itemx --interactive
7975 @opindex --interactive
7976 When copying a file other than a directory, prompt whether to
7977 overwrite an existing destination file. The @option{-i} option overrides
7978 a previous @option{-n} option.
7984 Make hard links instead of copies of non-directories.
7987 @itemx --dereference
7989 @opindex --dereference
7990 Follow symbolic links when copying from them.
7991 With this option, @command{cp} cannot create a symbolic link.
7992 For example, a symlink (to regular file) in the source tree will be copied to
7993 a regular file in the destination tree.
7998 @opindex --no-clobber
7999 Do not overwrite an existing file. The @option{-n} option overrides a previous
8000 @option{-i} option. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or
8001 @option{--backup} option.
8004 @itemx --no-dereference
8006 @opindex --no-dereference
8007 @cindex symbolic links, copying
8008 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
8009 they point to. This option affects only symbolic links in the source;
8010 symbolic links in the destination are always followed if possible.
8013 @itemx --preserve[=@var{attribute_list}]
8016 @cindex file information, preserving, extended attributes, xattr
8017 Preserve the specified attributes of the original files.
8018 If specified, the @var{attribute_list} must be a comma-separated list
8019 of one or more of the following strings:
8023 Preserve the file mode bits and access control lists.
8025 Preserve the owner and group. On most modern systems,
8026 only users with appropriate privileges may change the owner of a file,
8028 may preserve the group ownership of a file only if they happen to be
8029 a member of the desired group.
8031 Preserve the times of last access and last modification, when possible.
8032 On older systems, it is not possible to preserve these attributes
8033 when the affected file is a symbolic link.
8034 However, many systems now provide the @code{utimensat} function,
8035 which makes it possible even for symbolic links.
8037 Preserve in the destination files
8038 any links between corresponding source files.
8039 Note that with @option{-L} or @option{-H}, this option can convert
8040 symbolic links to hard links. For example,
8042 $ mkdir c; : > a; ln -s a b; cp -aH a b c; ls -i1 c
8047 Note the inputs: @file{b} is a symlink to regular file @file{a},
8048 yet the files in destination directory, @file{c/}, are hard-linked.
8049 Since @option{-a} implies @option{--no-dereference} it would copy the symlink,
8050 but the later @option{-H} tells @command{cp} to dereference the command line
8051 arguments where it then sees two files with the same inode number.
8052 Then the @option{--preserve=links} option also implied by @option{-a}
8053 will preserve the perceived hard link.
8055 Here is a similar example that exercises @command{cp}'s @option{-L} option:
8057 $ mkdir b c; (cd b; : > a; ln -s a b); cp -aL b c; ls -i1 c/b
8063 Preserve SELinux security context of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
8065 Preserve extended attributes of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
8066 If @command{cp} is built without xattr support, ignore this option.
8067 If SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities are implemented using xattrs,
8068 they are preserved implicitly by this option as well, i.e., even without
8069 specifying @option{--preserve=mode} or @option{--preserve=context}.
8071 Preserve all file attributes.
8072 Equivalent to specifying all of the above, but with the difference
8073 that failure to preserve SELinux security context or extended attributes
8074 does not change @command{cp}'s exit status. In contrast to @option{-a},
8075 all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
8078 Using @option{--preserve} with no @var{attribute_list} is equivalent
8079 to @option{--preserve=mode,ownership,timestamps}.
8081 In the absence of this option, the permissions of existing destination
8082 files are unchanged. Each new file is created with the mode of the
8083 corresponding source file minus the set-user-ID, set-group-ID, and
8084 sticky bits as the create mode; the operating system then applies either
8085 the umask or a default ACL, possibly resulting in a more restrictive
8087 @xref{File permissions}.
8089 @item --no-preserve=@var{attribute_list}
8090 @cindex file information, preserving
8091 Do not preserve the specified attributes. The @var{attribute_list}
8092 has the same form as for @option{--preserve}.
8096 @cindex parent directories and @command{cp}
8097 Form the name of each destination file by appending to the target
8098 directory a slash and the specified name of the source file. The last
8099 argument given to @command{cp} must be the name of an existing directory.
8100 For example, the command:
8103 cp --parents a/b/c existing_dir
8107 copies the file @file{a/b/c} to @file{existing_dir/a/b/c}, creating
8108 any missing intermediate directories.
8115 @opindex --recursive
8116 @cindex directories, copying recursively
8117 @cindex copying directories recursively
8118 @cindex recursively copying directories
8119 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
8120 Copy directories recursively. By default, do not follow symbolic
8121 links in the source unless used together with the @option{--link}
8122 (@option{-l}) option; see the @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d},
8123 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference}
8124 (@option{-P}), and @option{-H} options. Special files are copied by
8125 creating a destination file of the same type as the source; see the
8126 @option{--copy-contents} option. It is not portable to use
8127 @option{-r} to copy symbolic links or special files. On some
8128 non-GNU systems, @option{-r} implies the equivalent of
8129 @option{-L} and @option{--copy-contents} for historical reasons.
8130 Also, it is not portable to use @option{-R} to copy symbolic links
8131 unless you also specify @option{-P}, as POSIX allows
8132 implementations that dereference symbolic links by default.
8134 @item --reflink[=@var{when}]
8135 @opindex --reflink[=@var{when}]
8138 @cindex copy on write
8139 Perform a lightweight, copy-on-write (COW) copy, if supported by the
8140 file system. Once it has succeeded, beware that the source and destination
8141 files share the same disk data blocks as long as they remain unmodified.
8142 Thus, if a disk I/O error affects data blocks of one of the files,
8143 the other suffers the same fate.
8145 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
8149 The default behavior: if the copy-on-write operation is not supported
8150 then report the failure for each file and exit with a failure status.
8153 If the copy-on-write operation is not supported then fall back
8154 to the standard copy behavior.
8157 This option is overridden by the @option{--link}, @option{--symbolic-link}
8158 and @option{--attributes-only} options, thus allowing it to be used
8159 to configure the default data copying behavior for @command{cp}.
8160 For example, with the following alias, @command{cp} will use the
8161 minimum amount of space supported by the file system.
8164 alias cp='cp --reflink=auto --sparse=always'
8167 @item --remove-destination
8168 @opindex --remove-destination
8169 Remove each existing destination file before attempting to open it
8170 (contrast with @option{-f} above).
8172 @item --sparse=@var{when}
8173 @opindex --sparse=@var{when}
8174 @cindex sparse files, copying
8175 @cindex holes, copying files with
8176 @findex read @r{system call, and holes}
8177 A @dfn{sparse file} contains @dfn{holes}---a sequence of zero bytes that
8178 does not occupy any physical disk blocks; the @samp{read} system call
8179 reads these as zeros. This can both save considerable disk space and
8180 increase speed, since many binary files contain lots of consecutive zero
8181 bytes. By default, @command{cp} detects holes in input source files via a crude
8182 heuristic and makes the corresponding output file sparse as well.
8183 Only regular files may be sparse.
8185 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
8189 The default behavior: if the input file is sparse, attempt to make
8190 the output file sparse, too. However, if an output file exists but
8191 refers to a non-regular file, then do not attempt to make it sparse.
8194 For each sufficiently long sequence of zero bytes in the input file,
8195 attempt to create a corresponding hole in the output file, even if the
8196 input file does not appear to be sparse.
8197 This is useful when the input file resides on a file system
8198 that does not support sparse files
8199 (for example, @samp{efs} file systems in SGI IRIX 5.3 and earlier),
8200 but the output file is on a type of file system that does support them.
8201 Holes may be created only in regular files, so if the destination file
8202 is of some other type, @command{cp} does not even try to make it sparse.
8205 Never make the output file sparse.
8206 This is useful in creating a file for use with the @command{mkswap} command,
8207 since such a file must not have any holes.
8210 @optStripTrailingSlashes
8213 @itemx --symbolic-link
8215 @opindex --symbolic-link
8216 @cindex symbolic links, copying with
8217 Make symbolic links instead of copies of non-directories. All source
8218 file names must be absolute (starting with @samp{/}) unless the
8219 destination files are in the current directory. This option merely
8220 results in an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
8226 @optNoTargetDirectory
8232 @cindex newer files, copying only
8233 Do not copy a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
8234 same or newer modification time. If time stamps are being preserved,
8235 the comparison is to the source time stamp truncated to the
8236 resolutions of the destination file system and of the system calls
8237 used to update time stamps; this avoids duplicate work if several
8238 @samp{cp -pu} commands are executed with the same source and destination.
8239 If @option{--preserve=links} is also specified (like with @samp{cp -au}
8240 for example), that will take precedence. Consequently, depending on the
8241 order that files are processed from the source, newer files in the destination
8242 may be replaced, to mirror hard links in the source.
8248 Print the name of each file before copying it.
8251 @itemx --one-file-system
8253 @opindex --one-file-system
8254 @cindex file systems, omitting copying to different
8255 Skip subdirectories that are on different file systems from the one that
8256 the copy started on.
8257 However, mount point directories @emph{are} copied.
8261 @itemx --context[=@var{context}]
8264 @cindex SELinux, setting/restoring security context
8265 @cindex security context
8266 Without a specified @var{context}, adjust the SELinux security context according
8267 to the system default type for destination files, similarly to the
8268 @command{restorecon} command.
8269 The long form of this option with a specific context specified,
8270 will set the context for newly created files only.
8271 With a specified context, if both SELinux and SMACK are disabled, a warning is
8275 This option is mutually exclusive with the @option{--preserve=context}
8276 option, and overrides the @option{--preserve=all} and @option{-a} options.
8284 @section @command{dd}: Convert and copy a file
8287 @cindex converting while copying a file
8289 @command{dd} copies a file (from standard input to standard output, by
8290 default) with a changeable I/O block size, while optionally performing
8291 conversions on it. Synopses:
8294 dd [@var{operand}]@dots{}
8298 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
8299 @xref{Common options}. @command{dd} accepts the following operands,
8300 whose syntax was inspired by the DD (data definition) statement of
8307 Read from @var{file} instead of standard input.
8311 Write to @var{file} instead of standard output. Unless
8312 @samp{conv=notrunc} is given, @command{dd} truncates @var{file} to zero
8313 bytes (or the size specified with @samp{seek=}).
8315 @item ibs=@var{bytes}
8317 @cindex block size of input
8318 @cindex input block size
8319 Set the input block size to @var{bytes}.
8320 This makes @command{dd} read @var{bytes} per block.
8321 The default is 512 bytes.
8323 @item obs=@var{bytes}
8325 @cindex block size of output
8326 @cindex output block size
8327 Set the output block size to @var{bytes}.
8328 This makes @command{dd} write @var{bytes} per block.
8329 The default is 512 bytes.
8331 @item bs=@var{bytes}
8334 Set both input and output block sizes to @var{bytes}.
8335 This makes @command{dd} read and write @var{bytes} per block,
8336 overriding any @samp{ibs} and @samp{obs} settings.
8337 In addition, if no data-transforming @option{conv} option is specified,
8338 input is copied to the output as soon as it's read,
8339 even if it is smaller than the block size.
8341 @item cbs=@var{bytes}
8343 @cindex block size of conversion
8344 @cindex conversion block size
8345 @cindex fixed-length records, converting to variable-length
8346 @cindex variable-length records, converting to fixed-length
8347 Set the conversion block size to @var{bytes}.
8348 When converting variable-length records to fixed-length ones
8349 (@option{conv=block}) or the reverse (@option{conv=unblock}),
8350 use @var{bytes} as the fixed record length.
8354 Skip @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks in the input file before copying.
8355 If @samp{iflag=skip_bytes} is specified, @var{n} is interpreted
8356 as a byte count rather than a block count.
8360 Skip @var{n} @samp{obs}-byte blocks in the output file before copying.
8361 if @samp{oflag=seek_bytes} is specified, @var{n} is interpreted
8362 as a byte count rather than a block count.
8366 Copy @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks from the input file, instead
8367 of everything until the end of the file.
8368 if @samp{iflag=count_bytes} is specified, @var{n} is interpreted
8369 as a byte count rather than a block count.
8370 Note if the input may return short reads as could be the case
8371 when reading from a pipe for example, @samp{iflag=fullblock}
8372 will ensure that @samp{count=} corresponds to complete input blocks
8373 rather than the traditional POSIX specified behavior of counting
8374 input read operations.
8376 @item status=@var{level}
8378 Transfer information is normally output to stderr upon
8379 receipt of the @samp{INFO} signal or when @command{dd} exits.
8380 Specifying @var{level} will adjust the amount of information printed,
8381 with the last @var{level} specified taking precedence.
8386 @opindex none @r{dd status=}
8387 Do not print any informational or warning messages to stderr.
8388 Error messages are output as normal.
8391 @opindex noxfer @r{dd status=}
8392 Do not print the final transfer rate and volume statistics
8393 that normally make up the last status line.
8396 @opindex progress @r{dd status=}
8397 Print the transfer rate and volume statistics on stderr,
8398 when processing each input block. Statistics are output
8399 on a single line at most once every second, but updates
8400 can be delayed when waiting on I/O.
8404 @item conv=@var{conversion}[,@var{conversion}]@dots{}
8406 Convert the file as specified by the @var{conversion} argument(s).
8407 (No spaces around any comma(s).)
8414 @opindex ascii@r{, converting to}
8415 Convert EBCDIC to ASCII,
8416 using the conversion table specified by POSIX@.
8417 This provides a 1:1 translation for all 256 bytes.
8418 This option implies @samp{conv=unblock}; input is converted to
8419 ASCII before trailing spaces are deleted.
8422 @opindex ebcdic@r{, converting to}
8423 Convert ASCII to EBCDIC@.
8424 This is the inverse of the @samp{ascii} conversion.
8425 This option implies @samp{conv=block}; trailing spaces are added
8426 before being converted to EBCDIC@.
8429 @opindex alternate ebcdic@r{, converting to}
8430 This acts like @samp{conv=ebcdic}, except it
8431 uses the alternate conversion table specified by POSIX@.
8432 This is not a 1:1 translation, but reflects common historical practice
8433 for @samp{~}, @samp{[}, and @samp{]}.
8435 The @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic}, and @samp{ibm} conversions are
8436 mutually exclusive. If you use any of these options, you should also
8437 use the @samp{cbs=} option.
8440 @opindex block @r{(space-padding)}
8441 For each line in the input, output @samp{cbs} bytes, replacing the
8442 input newline with a space and padding with spaces as necessary.
8446 Remove any trailing spaces in each @samp{cbs}-sized input block,
8447 and append a newline.
8449 The @samp{block} and @samp{unblock} conversions are mutually exclusive.
8452 @opindex lcase@r{, converting to}
8453 Change uppercase letters to lowercase.
8456 @opindex ucase@r{, converting to}
8457 Change lowercase letters to uppercase.
8459 The @samp{lcase} and @samp{ucase} conversions are mutually exclusive.
8463 Try to seek rather than write NUL output blocks.
8464 On a file system that supports sparse files, this will create
8465 sparse output when extending the output file.
8466 Be careful when using this option in conjunction with
8467 @samp{conv=notrunc} or @samp{oflag=append}.
8468 With @samp{conv=notrunc}, existing data in the output file
8469 corresponding to NUL blocks from the input, will be untouched.
8470 With @samp{oflag=append} the seeks performed will be ineffective.
8471 Similarly, when the output is a device rather than a file,
8472 NUL input blocks are not copied, and therefore this option
8473 is most useful with virtual or pre zeroed devices.
8476 @opindex swab @r{(byte-swapping)}
8477 @cindex byte-swapping
8478 Swap every pair of input bytes. GNU @command{dd}, unlike others, works
8479 when an odd number of bytes are read---the last byte is simply copied
8480 (since there is nothing to swap it with).
8483 @opindex sync @r{(padding with ASCII NULs)}
8484 Pad every input block to size of @samp{ibs} with trailing zero bytes.
8485 When used with @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, pad with spaces instead of
8490 The following ``conversions'' are really file flags
8491 and don't affect internal processing:
8496 @cindex creating output file, requiring
8497 Fail if the output file already exists; @command{dd} must create the
8502 @cindex creating output file, avoiding
8503 Do not create the output file; the output file must already exist.
8505 The @samp{excl} and @samp{nocreat} conversions are mutually exclusive.
8509 @cindex truncating output file, avoiding
8510 Do not truncate the output file.
8514 @cindex read errors, ignoring
8515 Continue after read errors.
8519 @cindex synchronized data writes, before finishing
8520 Synchronize output data just before finishing. This forces a physical
8521 write of output data.
8525 @cindex synchronized data and metadata writes, before finishing
8526 Synchronize output data and metadata just before finishing. This
8527 forces a physical write of output data and metadata.
8531 @item iflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
8533 Access the input file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
8534 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
8536 @item oflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
8538 Access the output file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
8539 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
8541 Here are the flags. Not every flag is supported on every operating
8548 @cindex appending to the output file
8549 Write in append mode, so that even if some other process is writing to
8550 this file, every @command{dd} write will append to the current
8551 contents of the file. This flag makes sense only for output.
8552 If you combine this flag with the @samp{of=@var{file}} operand,
8553 you should also specify @samp{conv=notrunc} unless you want the
8554 output file to be truncated before being appended to.
8558 @cindex concurrent I/O
8559 Use concurrent I/O mode for data. This mode performs direct I/O
8560 and drops the POSIX requirement to serialize all I/O to the same file.
8561 A file cannot be opened in CIO mode and with a standard open at the
8567 Use direct I/O for data, avoiding the buffer cache.
8568 Note that the kernel may impose restrictions on read or write buffer sizes.
8569 For example, with an ext4 destination file system and a Linux-based kernel,
8570 using @samp{oflag=direct} will cause writes to fail with @code{EINVAL} if the
8571 output buffer size is not a multiple of 512.
8575 @cindex directory I/O
8577 Fail unless the file is a directory. Most operating systems do not
8578 allow I/O to a directory, so this flag has limited utility.
8582 @cindex synchronized data reads
8583 Use synchronized I/O for data. For the output file, this forces a
8584 physical write of output data on each write. For the input file,
8585 this flag can matter when reading from a remote file that has been
8586 written to synchronously by some other process. Metadata (e.g.,
8587 last-access and last-modified time) is not necessarily synchronized.
8591 @cindex synchronized data and metadata I/O
8592 Use synchronized I/O for both data and metadata.
8596 @cindex discarding file cache
8597 Discard the data cache for a file.
8598 When count=0 all cache is discarded,
8599 otherwise the cache is dropped for the processed
8600 portion of the file. Also when count=0
8601 failure to discard the cache is diagnosed
8602 and reflected in the exit status.
8603 Here as some usage examples:
8606 # Advise to drop cache for whole file
8607 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache count=0
8609 # Ensure drop cache for the whole file
8610 dd of=ofile oflag=nocache conv=notrunc,fdatasync count=0
8612 # Drop cache for part of file
8613 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache skip=10 count=10 of=/dev/null
8615 # Stream data using just the read-ahead cache
8616 dd if=ifile of=ofile iflag=nocache oflag=nocache
8621 @cindex nonblocking I/O
8622 Use non-blocking I/O.
8627 Do not update the file's access time.
8628 Some older file systems silently ignore this flag, so it is a good
8629 idea to test it on your files before relying on it.
8633 @cindex controlling terminal
8634 Do not assign the file to be a controlling terminal for @command{dd}.
8635 This has no effect when the file is not a terminal.
8636 On many hosts (e.g., GNU/Linux hosts), this option has no effect
8641 @cindex symbolic links, following
8642 Do not follow symbolic links.
8647 Fail if the file has multiple hard links.
8652 Use binary I/O@. This option has an effect only on nonstandard
8653 platforms that distinguish binary from text I/O.
8658 Use text I/O@. Like @samp{binary}, this option has no effect on
8663 Accumulate full blocks from input. The @code{read} system call
8664 may return early if a full block is not available.
8665 When that happens, continue calling @code{read} to fill the remainder
8667 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
8668 This flag is useful with pipes for example
8669 as they may return short reads. In that case,
8670 this flag is needed to ensure that a @samp{count=} argument is
8671 interpreted as a block count rather than a count of read operations.
8674 @opindex count_bytes
8675 Interpret the @samp{count=} operand as a byte count,
8676 rather than a block count, which allows specifying
8677 a length that is not a multiple of the I/O block size.
8678 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
8682 Interpret the @samp{skip=} operand as a byte count,
8683 rather than a block count, which allows specifying
8684 an offset that is not a multiple of the I/O block size.
8685 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
8689 Interpret the @samp{seek=} operand as a byte count,
8690 rather than a block count, which allows specifying
8691 an offset that is not a multiple of the I/O block size.
8692 This flag can be used only with @code{oflag}.
8696 These flags are not supported on all systems, and @samp{dd} rejects
8697 attempts to use them when they are not supported. When reading from
8698 standard input or writing to standard output, the @samp{nofollow} and
8699 @samp{noctty} flags should not be specified, and the other flags
8700 (e.g., @samp{nonblock}) can affect how other processes behave with the
8701 affected file descriptors, even after @command{dd} exits.
8705 @cindex multipliers after numbers
8706 The numeric-valued strings above (@var{n} and @var{bytes})
8707 can be followed by a multiplier: @samp{b}=512, @samp{c}=1,
8708 @samp{w}=2, @samp{x@var{m}}=@var{m}, or any of the
8709 standard block size suffixes like @samp{k}=1024 (@pxref{Block size}).
8711 Any block size you specify via @samp{bs=}, @samp{ibs=}, @samp{obs=}, @samp{cbs=}
8712 should not be too large---values larger than a few megabytes
8713 are generally wasteful or (as in the gigabyte..exabyte case) downright
8714 counterproductive or error-inducing.
8716 To process data that is at an offset or size that is not a
8717 multiple of the I/O@ block size, you can use the @samp{skip_bytes},
8718 @samp{seek_bytes} and @samp{count_bytes} flags. Alternatively
8719 the traditional method of separate @command{dd} invocations can be used.
8720 For example, the following shell commands copy data
8721 in 512 KiB blocks between a disk and a tape, but do not save
8722 or restore a 4 KiB label at the start of the disk:
8725 disk=/dev/rdsk/c0t1d0s2
8728 # Copy all but the label from disk to tape.
8729 (dd bs=4k skip=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$disk >$tape
8731 # Copy from tape back to disk, but leave the disk label alone.
8732 (dd bs=4k seek=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$tape >$disk
8736 @cindex disks, failing
8737 For failing disks, other tools come with a great variety of extra
8738 functionality to ease the saving of as much data as possible before the
8739 disk finally dies, e.g.
8740 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/ddrescue/, GNU @command{ddrescue}}.
8741 However, in some cases such a tool is not available or the administrator
8742 feels more comfortable with the handling of @command{dd}.
8743 As a simple rescue method, call @command{dd} as shown in the following
8744 example: the options @samp{conv=noerror,sync} are used to continue
8745 after read errors and to pad out bad reads with NULs, while
8746 @samp{iflag=fullblock} caters for short reads (which traditionally never
8747 occur on disk based devices):
8750 # Rescue data from an (unmounted!) partition of a failing disk.
8751 dd conv=noerror,sync iflag=fullblock </dev/sda1 > /mnt/rescue.img
8754 Sending an @samp{INFO} signal (or @samp{USR1} signal where that is unavailable)
8755 to a running @command{dd} process makes it print I/O statistics to
8756 standard error and then resume copying. In the example below,
8757 @command{dd} is run in the background to copy 5GB of data.
8758 The @command{kill} command makes it output intermediate I/O statistics,
8759 and when @command{dd} completes normally or is killed by the
8760 @code{SIGINT} signal, it outputs the final statistics.
8763 # Ignore the signal so we never inadvertently terminate the dd child.
8764 # Note this is not needed when SIGINFO is available.
8767 # Run dd with the fullblock iflag to avoid short reads
8768 # which can be triggered by reception of signals.
8769 dd iflag=fullblock if=/dev/zero of=/dev/null count=5000000 bs=1000 & pid=$!
8771 # Output stats every half second
8772 until ! kill -s USR1 $pid 2>/dev/null; do sleep .5; done
8775 The above script will output in the following format
8780 4295000000 bytes (4.3 GB) copied, 0.539934 s, 8.0 GB/s
8783 5000000000 bytes (5.0 GB) copied, 0.630785 s, 7.9 GB/s
8786 Note also the @samp{status=progress} option which periodically updates
8787 the last line of the transfer statistics above.
8789 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
8790 On systems lacking the @samp{INFO} signal @command{dd} responds to the
8791 @samp{USR1} signal instead, unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
8792 environment variable is set.
8797 @node install invocation
8798 @section @command{install}: Copy files and set attributes
8801 @cindex copying files and setting attributes
8803 @command{install} copies files while setting their file mode bits and, if
8804 possible, their owner and group. Synopses:
8807 install [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
8808 install [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
8809 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
8810 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -d @var{directory}@dots{}
8815 If two file names are given, @command{install} copies the first file to the
8819 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8820 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8821 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8822 @command{install} copies each @var{source} file to the specified
8823 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
8826 If the @option{--directory} (@option{-d}) option is given,
8827 @command{install} creates each @var{directory} and any missing parent
8828 directories. Parent directories are created with mode
8829 @samp{u=rwx,go=rx} (755), regardless of the @option{-m} option or the
8830 current umask. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
8831 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of parent directories are inherited.
8834 @cindex Makefiles, installing programs in
8835 @command{install} is similar to @command{cp}, but allows you to control the
8836 attributes of destination files. It is typically used in Makefiles to
8837 copy programs into their destination directories. It refuses to copy
8838 files onto themselves.
8840 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
8841 @command{install} never preserves extended attributes (xattr).
8843 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8853 Compare each pair of source and destination files, and if the destination has
8854 identical content and any specified owner, group, permissions, and possibly
8855 SELinux context, then do not modify the destination at all.
8856 Note this option is best used in conjunction with @option{--user},
8857 @option{--group} and @option{--mode} options, lest @command{install}
8858 incorrectly determines the default attributes that installed files would have
8859 (as it doesn't consider setgid directories and POSIX default ACLs for example).
8860 This could result in redundant copies or attributes that are not reset to the
8865 Ignored; for compatibility with old Unix versions of @command{install}.
8869 Create any missing parent directories of @var{dest},
8870 then copy @var{source} to @var{dest}.
8871 Explicitly specifying the @option{--target-directory=@var{dir}} will similarly
8872 ensure the presence of that hierarchy before copying @var{source} arguments.
8877 @opindex --directory
8878 @cindex directories, creating with given attributes
8879 @cindex parent directories, creating missing
8880 @cindex leading directories, creating missing
8881 Create any missing parent directories, giving them the default
8882 attributes. Then create each given directory, setting their owner,
8883 group and mode as given on the command line or to the defaults.
8885 @item -g @var{group}
8886 @itemx --group=@var{group}
8889 @cindex group ownership of installed files, setting
8890 Set the group ownership of installed files or directories to
8891 @var{group}. The default is the process's current group. @var{group}
8892 may be either a group name or a numeric group ID.
8895 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8898 @cindex permissions of installed files, setting
8899 Set the file mode bits for the installed file or directory to @var{mode},
8900 which can be either an octal number, or a symbolic mode as in
8901 @command{chmod}, with @samp{a=} (no access allowed to anyone) as the
8902 point of departure (@pxref{File permissions}).
8903 The default mode is @samp{u=rwx,go=rx,a-s}---read, write, and
8904 execute for the owner, read and execute for group and other, and with
8905 set-user-ID and set-group-ID disabled.
8906 This default is not quite the same as @samp{755}, since it disables
8907 instead of preserving set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
8908 @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}.
8910 @item -o @var{owner}
8911 @itemx --owner=@var{owner}
8914 @cindex ownership of installed files, setting
8915 @cindex appropriate privileges
8916 @vindex root @r{as default owner}
8917 If @command{install} has appropriate privileges (is run as root), set the
8918 ownership of installed files or directories to @var{owner}. The default
8919 is @code{root}. @var{owner} may be either a user name or a numeric user
8922 @item --preserve-context
8923 @opindex --preserve-context
8925 @cindex security context
8926 Preserve the SELinux security context of files and directories.
8927 Failure to preserve the context in all of the files or directories
8928 will result in an exit status of 1. If SELinux is disabled then
8929 print a warning and ignore the option.
8932 @itemx --preserve-timestamps
8934 @opindex --preserve-timestamps
8935 @cindex timestamps of installed files, preserving
8936 Set the time of last access and the time of last modification of each
8937 installed file to match those of each corresponding original file.
8938 When a file is installed without this option, its last access and
8939 last modification times are both set to the time of installation.
8940 This option is useful if you want to use the last modification times
8941 of installed files to keep track of when they were last built as opposed
8942 to when they were last installed.
8948 @cindex symbol table information, stripping
8949 @cindex stripping symbol table information
8950 Strip the symbol tables from installed binary executables.
8952 @item --strip-program=@var{program}
8953 @opindex --strip-program
8954 @cindex symbol table information, stripping, program
8955 Program used to strip binaries.
8961 @optNoTargetDirectory
8967 Print the name of each file before copying it.
8970 This option is mutually exclusive with the @option{--preserve-context} option.
8979 @section @command{mv}: Move (rename) files
8983 @command{mv} moves or renames files (or directories). Synopses:
8986 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
8987 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
8988 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
8993 If two file names are given, @command{mv} moves the first file to the
8997 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8998 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8999 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
9000 @command{mv} moves each @var{source} file to the specified
9001 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
9004 @command{mv} can move any type of file from one file system to another.
9005 Prior to version @code{4.0} of the fileutils,
9006 @command{mv} could move only regular files between file systems.
9007 For example, now @command{mv} can move an entire directory hierarchy
9008 including special device files from one partition to another. It first
9009 uses some of the same code that's used by @code{cp -a} to copy the
9010 requested directories and files, then (assuming the copy succeeded)
9011 it removes the originals. If the copy fails, then the part that was
9012 copied to the destination partition is removed. If you were to copy
9013 three directories from one partition to another and the copy of the first
9014 directory succeeded, but the second didn't, the first would be left on
9015 the destination partition and the second and third would be left on the
9018 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
9019 @command{mv} always tries to copy extended attributes (xattr), which may
9020 include SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities.
9021 Upon failure all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
9023 @cindex prompting, and @command{mv}
9024 If a destination file exists but is normally unwritable, standard input
9025 is a terminal, and the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given,
9026 @command{mv} prompts the user for whether to replace the file. (You might
9027 own the file, or have write permission on its directory.) If the
9028 response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
9030 @emph{Warning}: Avoid specifying a source name with a trailing slash,
9031 when it might be a symlink to a directory.
9032 Otherwise, @command{mv} may do something very surprising, since
9033 its behavior depends on the underlying rename system call.
9034 On a system with a modern Linux-based kernel, it fails with
9035 @code{errno=ENOTDIR}@.
9036 However, on other systems (at least FreeBSD 6.1 and Solaris 10) it silently
9037 renames not the symlink but rather the directory referenced by the symlink.
9038 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
9040 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9050 @cindex prompts, omitting
9051 Do not prompt the user before removing a destination file.
9053 If you specify more than one of the @option{-i}, @option{-f}, @option{-n}
9054 options, only the final one takes effect.
9059 @itemx --interactive
9061 @opindex --interactive
9062 @cindex prompts, forcing
9063 Prompt whether to overwrite each existing destination file, regardless
9065 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
9071 @opindex --no-clobber
9072 @cindex prompts, omitting
9073 Do not overwrite an existing file.
9075 This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or @option{--backup} option.
9081 @cindex newer files, moving only
9082 Do not move a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
9083 same or newer modification time.
9084 If the move is across file system boundaries, the comparison is to the
9085 source time stamp truncated to the resolutions of the destination file
9086 system and of the system calls used to update time stamps; this avoids
9087 duplicate work if several @samp{mv -u} commands are executed with the
9088 same source and destination.
9094 Print the name of each file before moving it.
9096 @optStripTrailingSlashes
9102 @optNoTargetDirectory
9108 @cindex SELinux, restoring security context
9109 @cindex security context
9110 This option functions similarly to the @command{restorecon} command,
9111 by adjusting the SELinux security context according
9112 to the system default type for destination files.
9120 @section @command{rm}: Remove files or directories
9123 @cindex removing files or directories
9125 @command{rm} removes each given @var{file}. By default, it does not remove
9126 directories. Synopsis:
9129 rm [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9132 @cindex prompting, and @command{rm}
9133 If the @option{-I} or @option{--interactive=once} option is given,
9134 and there are more than three files or the @option{-r}, @option{-R},
9135 or @option{--recursive} are given, then @command{rm} prompts the user
9136 for whether to proceed with the entire operation. If the response is
9137 not affirmative, the entire command is aborted.
9139 Otherwise, if a file is unwritable, standard input is a terminal, and
9140 the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given, or the
9141 @option{-i} or @option{--interactive=always} option @emph{is} given,
9142 @command{rm} prompts the user for whether to remove the file.
9143 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
9145 Any attempt to remove a file whose last file name component is
9146 @file{.} or @file{..} is rejected without any prompting, as mandated
9149 @emph{Warning}: If you use @command{rm} to remove a file, it is usually
9150 possible to recover the contents of that file. If you want more assurance
9151 that the contents are truly unrecoverable, consider using @command{shred}.
9153 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9161 @cindex directories, removing
9162 Remove the listed directories if they are empty.
9168 Ignore nonexistent files and missing operands, and never prompt the user.
9169 Ignore any previous @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option.
9173 Prompt whether to remove each file.
9174 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
9175 Ignore any previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option.
9176 Equivalent to @option{--interactive=always}.
9180 Prompt once whether to proceed with the command, if more than three
9181 files are named or if a recursive removal is requested. Ignore any
9182 previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option. Equivalent to
9183 @option{--interactive=once}.
9185 @item --interactive [=@var{when}]
9186 @opindex --interactive
9187 Specify when to issue an interactive prompt. @var{when} may be
9191 @vindex never @r{interactive option}
9192 - Do not prompt at all.
9194 @vindex once @r{interactive option}
9195 - Prompt once if more than three files are named or if a recursive
9196 removal is requested. Equivalent to @option{-I}.
9198 @vindex always @r{interactive option}
9199 - Prompt for every file being removed. Equivalent to @option{-i}.
9201 @option{--interactive} with no @var{when} is equivalent to
9202 @option{--interactive=always}.
9204 @item --one-file-system
9205 @opindex --one-file-system
9206 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{rm} to
9207 When removing a hierarchy recursively, skip any directory that is on a
9208 file system different from that of the corresponding command line argument.
9211 This option is useful when removing a build ``chroot'' hierarchy,
9212 which normally contains no valuable data. However, it is not uncommon
9213 to bind-mount @file{/home} into such a hierarchy, to make it easier to
9214 use one's start-up file. The catch is that it's easy to forget to
9215 unmount @file{/home}. Then, when you use @command{rm -rf} to remove
9216 your normally throw-away chroot, that command will remove everything
9217 under @file{/home}, too.
9218 Use the @option{--one-file-system} option, and it will
9219 warn about and skip directories on other file systems.
9220 Of course, this will not save your @file{/home} if it and your
9221 chroot happen to be on the same file system.
9223 @item --preserve-root
9224 @opindex --preserve-root
9225 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive destruction
9226 Fail upon any attempt to remove the root directory, @file{/},
9227 when used with the @option{--recursive} option.
9228 This is the default behavior.
9229 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9231 @item --no-preserve-root
9232 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9233 @cindex root directory, allow recursive destruction
9234 Do not treat @file{/} specially when removing recursively.
9235 This option is not recommended unless you really want to
9236 remove all the files on your computer.
9237 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9244 @opindex --recursive
9245 @cindex directories, removing (recursively)
9246 Remove the listed directories and their contents recursively.
9252 Print the name of each file before removing it.
9256 @cindex files beginning with @samp{-}, removing
9257 @cindex @samp{-}, removing files beginning with
9258 One common question is how to remove files whose names begin with a
9259 @samp{-}. GNU @command{rm}, like every program that uses the @code{getopt}
9260 function to parse its arguments, lets you use the @samp{--} option to
9261 indicate that all following arguments are non-options. To remove a file
9262 called @file{-f} in the current directory, you could type either:
9275 @opindex - @r{and Unix @command{rm}}
9276 The Unix @command{rm} program's use of a single @samp{-} for this purpose
9277 predates the development of the @code{getopt} standard syntax.
9282 @node shred invocation
9283 @section @command{shred}: Remove files more securely
9286 @cindex data, erasing
9287 @cindex erasing data
9289 @command{shred} overwrites devices or files, to help prevent even
9290 very expensive hardware from recovering the data.
9292 Ordinarily when you remove a file (@pxref{rm invocation}), the data is
9293 not actually destroyed. Only the index listing where the file is
9294 stored is destroyed, and the storage is made available for reuse.
9295 There are undelete utilities that will attempt to reconstruct the index
9296 and can bring the file back if the parts were not reused.
9298 On a busy system with a nearly-full drive, space can get reused in a few
9299 seconds. But there is no way to know for sure. If you have sensitive
9300 data, you may want to be sure that recovery is not possible by actually
9301 overwriting the file with non-sensitive data.
9303 However, even after doing that, it is possible to take the disk back
9304 to a laboratory and use a lot of sensitive (and expensive) equipment
9305 to look for the faint ``echoes'' of the original data underneath the
9306 overwritten data. If the data has only been overwritten once, it's not
9309 The best way to remove something irretrievably is to destroy the media
9310 it's on with acid, melt it down, or the like. For cheap removable media
9311 like floppy disks, this is the preferred method. However, hard drives
9312 are expensive and hard to melt, so the @command{shred} utility tries
9313 to achieve a similar effect non-destructively.
9315 This uses many overwrite passes, with the data patterns chosen to
9316 maximize the damage they do to the old data. While this will work on
9317 floppies, the patterns are designed for best effect on hard drives.
9318 For more details, see the source code and Peter Gutmann's paper
9319 @uref{http://www.cs.auckland.ac.nz/~pgut001/pubs/secure_del.html,
9320 @cite{Secure Deletion of Data from Magnetic and Solid-State Memory}},
9321 from the proceedings of the Sixth USENIX Security Symposium (San Jose,
9322 California, July 22--25, 1996).
9324 @strong{Please note} that @command{shred} relies on a very important assumption:
9325 that the file system overwrites data in place. This is the traditional
9326 way to do things, but many modern file system designs do not satisfy this
9327 assumption. Exceptions include:
9332 Log-structured or journaled file systems, such as those supplied with
9333 AIX and Solaris, and JFS, ReiserFS, XFS, Ext3 (in @code{data=journal} mode),
9334 BFS, NTFS, etc., when they are configured to journal @emph{data}.
9337 File systems that write redundant data and carry on even if some writes
9338 fail, such as RAID-based file systems.
9341 File systems that make snapshots, such as Network Appliance's NFS server.
9344 File systems that cache in temporary locations, such as NFS version 3
9348 Compressed file systems.
9351 In the particular case of ext3 file systems, the above disclaimer applies (and
9352 @command{shred} is thus of limited effectiveness) only in @code{data=journal}
9353 mode, which journals file data in addition to just metadata. In both
9354 the @code{data=ordered} (default) and @code{data=writeback} modes,
9355 @command{shred} works as usual. Ext3 journaling modes can be changed
9356 by adding the @code{data=something} option to the mount options for a
9357 particular file system in the @file{/etc/fstab} file, as documented in
9358 the mount man page (man mount).
9360 If you are not sure how your file system operates, then you should assume
9361 that it does not overwrite data in place, which means that shred cannot
9362 reliably operate on regular files in your file system.
9364 Generally speaking, it is more reliable to shred a device than a file,
9365 since this bypasses the problem of file system design mentioned above.
9366 However, even shredding devices is not always completely reliable. For
9367 example, most disks map out bad sectors invisibly to the application; if
9368 the bad sectors contain sensitive data, @command{shred} won't be able to
9371 @command{shred} makes no attempt to detect or report this problem, just as
9372 it makes no attempt to do anything about backups. However, since it is
9373 more reliable to shred devices than files, @command{shred} by default does
9374 not truncate or remove the output file. This default is more suitable
9375 for devices, which typically cannot be truncated and should not be
9378 Finally, consider the risk of backups and mirrors.
9379 File system backups and remote mirrors may contain copies of the
9380 file that cannot be removed, and that will allow a shredded file
9381 to be recovered later. So if you keep any data you may later want
9382 to destroy using @command{shred}, be sure that it is not backed up or mirrored.
9385 shred [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}[@dots{}]
9388 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9396 @cindex force deletion
9397 Override file permissions if necessary to allow overwriting.
9400 @itemx -n @var{number}
9401 @itemx --iterations=@var{number}
9402 @opindex -n @var{number}
9403 @opindex --iterations=@var{number}
9404 @cindex iterations, selecting the number of
9405 By default, @command{shred} uses @value{SHRED_DEFAULT_PASSES} passes of
9406 overwrite. You can reduce this to save time, or increase it if you think it's
9407 appropriate. After 25 passes all of the internal overwrite patterns will have
9408 been used at least once.
9410 @item --random-source=@var{file}
9411 @opindex --random-source
9412 @cindex random source for shredding
9413 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to overwrite and to
9414 choose pass ordering. @xref{Random sources}.
9416 @item -s @var{bytes}
9417 @itemx --size=@var{bytes}
9418 @opindex -s @var{bytes}
9419 @opindex --size=@var{bytes}
9420 @cindex size of file to shred
9421 Shred the first @var{bytes} bytes of the file. The default is to shred
9422 the whole file. @var{bytes} can be followed by a size specification like
9423 @samp{K}, @samp{M}, or @samp{G} to specify a multiple. @xref{Block size}.
9426 @itemx --remove[=@var{how}]
9429 @opindex --remove=unlink
9430 @opindex --remove=wipe
9431 @opindex --remove=wipesync
9432 @cindex removing files after shredding
9433 After shredding a file, truncate it (if possible) and then remove it.
9434 If a file has multiple links, only the named links will be removed.
9435 Often the file name is less sensitive than the file data, in which case
9436 the optional @var{how} parameter, supported with the long form option,
9437 gives control of how to more efficiently remove each directory entry.
9438 The @samp{unlink} parameter will just use a standard unlink call,
9439 @samp{wipe} will also first obfuscate bytes in the name, and
9440 @samp{wipesync} will also sync each obfuscated byte in the name to disk.
9441 Note @samp{wipesync} is the default method, but can be expensive,
9442 requiring a sync for every character in every file. This can become
9443 significant with many files, or is redundant if your file system provides
9444 synchronous metadata updates.
9450 Display to standard error all status updates as sterilization proceeds.
9456 By default, @command{shred} rounds the size of a regular file up to the next
9457 multiple of the file system block size to fully erase the slack space in
9458 the last block of the file. This space may contain portions of the current
9459 system memory on some systems for example.
9460 Use @option{--exact} to suppress that behavior.
9461 Thus, by default if you shred a 10-byte regular file on a system with 512-byte
9462 blocks, the resulting file will be 512 bytes long. With this option,
9463 shred does not increase the apparent size of the file.
9469 Normally, the last pass that @command{shred} writes is made up of
9470 random data. If this would be conspicuous on your hard drive (for
9471 example, because it looks like encrypted data), or you just think
9472 it's tidier, the @option{--zero} option adds an additional overwrite pass with
9473 all zero bits. This is in addition to the number of passes specified
9474 by the @option{--iterations} option.
9478 You might use the following command to erase all trace of the
9479 file system you'd created on the floppy disk in your first drive.
9480 That command takes about 20 minutes to erase a ``1.44MB'' (actually
9484 shred --verbose /dev/fd0
9487 Similarly, to erase all data on a selected partition of
9488 your hard disk, you could give a command like this:
9491 shred --verbose /dev/sda5
9494 On modern disks, a single pass should be adequate,
9495 and it will take one third the time of the default three-pass approach.
9498 # 1 pass, write pseudo-random data; 3x faster than the default
9499 shred --verbose -n1 /dev/sda5
9502 To be on the safe side, use at least one pass that overwrites using
9503 pseudo-random data. I.e., don't be tempted to use @samp{-n0 --zero},
9504 in case some disk controller optimizes the process of writing blocks
9505 of all zeros, and thereby does not clear all bytes in a block.
9506 Some SSDs may do just that.
9508 A @var{file} of @samp{-} denotes standard output.
9509 The intended use of this is to shred a removed temporary file.
9516 echo "Hello, world" >&3
9521 However, the command @samp{shred - >file} does not shred the contents
9522 of @var{file}, since the shell truncates @var{file} before invoking
9523 @command{shred}. Use the command @samp{shred file} or (if using a
9524 Bourne-compatible shell) the command @samp{shred - 1<>file} instead.
9529 @node Special file types
9530 @chapter Special file types
9532 @cindex special file types
9533 @cindex file types, special
9535 This chapter describes commands which create special types of files (and
9536 @command{rmdir}, which removes directories, one special file type).
9538 @cindex special file types
9540 Although Unix-like operating systems have markedly fewer special file
9541 types than others, not @emph{everything} can be treated only as the
9542 undifferentiated byte stream of @dfn{normal files}. For example, when a
9543 file is created or removed, the system must record this information,
9544 which it does in a @dfn{directory}---a special type of file. Although
9545 you can read directories as normal files, if you're curious, in order
9546 for the system to do its job it must impose a structure, a certain
9547 order, on the bytes of the file. Thus it is a ``special'' type of file.
9549 Besides directories, other special file types include named pipes
9550 (FIFOs), symbolic links, sockets, and so-called @dfn{special files}.
9553 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
9554 * ln invocation:: Make links between files.
9555 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories.
9556 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes).
9557 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files.
9558 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name.
9559 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories.
9560 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via the unlink syscall
9564 @node link invocation
9565 @section @command{link}: Make a hard link via the link syscall
9568 @cindex links, creating
9569 @cindex hard links, creating
9570 @cindex creating links (hard only)
9572 @command{link} creates a single hard link at a time.
9573 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
9574 @code{link} function. @xref{Hard Links, , , libc,
9575 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
9576 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
9577 @command{ln} command (@pxref{ln invocation}).
9581 link @var{filename} @var{linkname}
9584 @var{filename} must specify an existing file, and @var{linkname}
9585 must specify a nonexistent entry in an existing directory.
9586 @command{link} simply calls @code{link (@var{filename}, @var{linkname})}
9589 On a GNU system, this command acts like @samp{ln --directory
9590 --no-target-directory @var{filename} @var{linkname}}. However, the
9591 @option{--directory} and @option{--no-target-directory} options are
9592 not specified by POSIX, and the @command{link} command is
9593 more portable in practice.
9595 If @var{filename} is a symbolic link, it is unspecified whether
9596 @var{linkname} will be a hard link to the symbolic link or to the
9597 target of the symbolic link. Use @command{ln -P} or @command{ln -L}
9598 to specify which behavior is desired.
9604 @section @command{ln}: Make links between files
9607 @cindex links, creating
9608 @cindex hard links, creating
9609 @cindex symbolic (soft) links, creating
9610 @cindex creating links (hard or soft)
9612 @cindex file systems and hard links
9613 @command{ln} makes links between files. By default, it makes hard links;
9614 with the @option{-s} option, it makes symbolic (or @dfn{soft}) links.
9618 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{target} @var{linkname}
9619 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}
9620 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}@dots{} @var{directory}
9621 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{target}@dots{}
9627 If two file names are given, @command{ln} creates a link to the first
9628 file from the second.
9631 If one @var{target} is given, @command{ln} creates a link to that file
9632 in the current directory.
9635 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
9636 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
9637 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
9638 @command{ln} creates a link to each @var{target} file in the specified
9639 directory, using the @var{target}s' names.
9643 Normally @command{ln} does not remove existing files. Use the
9644 @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option to remove them unconditionally,
9645 the @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option to remove them
9646 conditionally, and the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option to
9649 @cindex hard link, defined
9650 @cindex inode, and hard links
9651 A @dfn{hard link} is another name for an existing file; the link and the
9652 original are indistinguishable. Technically speaking, they share the
9653 same inode, and the inode contains all the information about a
9654 file---indeed, it is not incorrect to say that the inode @emph{is} the
9655 file. Most systems prohibit making a hard link to
9656 a directory; on those where it is allowed, only the super-user can do
9657 so (and with caution, since creating a cycle will cause problems to many
9658 other utilities). Hard links cannot cross file system boundaries. (These
9659 restrictions are not mandated by POSIX, however.)
9661 @cindex dereferencing symbolic links
9662 @cindex symbolic link, defined
9663 @dfn{Symbolic links} (@dfn{symlinks} for short), on the other hand, are
9664 a special file type (which not all kernels support: System V release 3
9665 (and older) systems lack symlinks) in which the link file actually
9666 refers to a different file, by name. When most operations (opening,
9667 reading, writing, and so on) are passed the symbolic link file, the
9668 kernel automatically @dfn{dereferences} the link and operates on the
9669 target of the link. But some operations (e.g., removing) work on the
9670 link file itself, rather than on its target. The owner and group of a
9671 symlink are not significant to file access performed through
9672 the link, but do have implications on deleting a symbolic link from a
9673 directory with the restricted deletion bit set. On the GNU system,
9674 the mode of a symlink has no significance and cannot be changed, but
9675 on some BSD systems, the mode can be changed and will affect whether
9676 the symlink will be traversed in file name resolution. @xref{Symbolic Links,,,
9677 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
9679 Symbolic links can contain arbitrary strings; a @dfn{dangling symlink}
9680 occurs when the string in the symlink does not resolve to a file.
9681 There are no restrictions against creating dangling symbolic links.
9682 There are trade-offs to using absolute or relative symlinks. An
9683 absolute symlink always points to the same file, even if the directory
9684 containing the link is moved. However, if the symlink is visible from
9685 more than one machine (such as on a networked file system), the file
9686 pointed to might not always be the same. A relative symbolic link is
9687 resolved in relation to the directory that contains the link, and is
9688 often useful in referring to files on the same device without regards
9689 to what name that device is mounted on when accessed via networked
9692 When creating a relative symlink in a different location than the
9693 current directory, the resolution of the symlink will be different
9694 than the resolution of the same string from the current directory.
9695 Therefore, many users prefer to first change directories to the
9696 location where the relative symlink will be created, so that
9697 tab-completion or other file resolution will find the same target as
9698 what will be placed in the symlink.
9700 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9711 @opindex --directory
9712 @cindex hard links to directories
9713 Allow users with appropriate privileges to attempt to make hard links
9715 However, note that this will probably fail due to
9716 system restrictions, even for the super-user.
9722 Remove existing destination files.
9725 @itemx --interactive
9727 @opindex --interactive
9728 @cindex prompting, and @command{ln}
9729 Prompt whether to remove existing destination files.
9735 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
9736 link, create the hard link to the file referred to by the symbolic
9737 link, rather than the symbolic link itself.
9740 @itemx --no-dereference
9742 @opindex --no-dereference
9743 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a symbolic link to
9744 a directory. Instead, treat it as if it were a normal file.
9746 When the destination is an actual directory (not a symlink to one),
9747 there is no ambiguity. The link is created in that directory.
9748 But when the specified destination is a symlink to a directory,
9749 there are two ways to treat the user's request. @command{ln} can
9750 treat the destination just as it would a normal directory and create
9751 the link in it. On the other hand, the destination can be viewed as a
9752 non-directory---as the symlink itself. In that case, @command{ln}
9753 must delete or backup that symlink before creating the new link.
9754 The default is to treat a destination that is a symlink to a directory
9755 just like a directory.
9757 This option is weaker than the @option{--no-target-directory}
9758 (@option{-T}) option, so it has no effect if both options are given.
9764 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
9765 link, create the hard link to the symbolic link itself. On platforms
9766 where this is not supported by the kernel, this option creates a
9767 symbolic link with identical contents; since symbolic link contents
9768 cannot be edited, any file name resolution performed through either
9769 link will be the same as if a hard link had been created.
9775 Make symbolic links relative to the link location.
9780 ln -srv /a/file /tmp
9781 '/tmp/file' -> '../a/file'
9784 Relative symbolic links are generated based on their canonicalized
9785 containing directory, and canonicalized targets. I.e., all symbolic
9786 links in these file names will be resolved.
9787 @xref{realpath invocation}, which gives greater control
9788 over relative file name generation, as demonstrated in the following example:
9793 test "$1" = --no-symlinks && { nosym=$1; shift; }
9795 test -d "$2" && link="$2/." || link="$2"
9796 rtarget="$(realpath $nosym -m "$target" \
9797 --relative-to "$(dirname "$link")")"
9798 ln -s -v "$rtarget" "$link"
9807 Make symbolic links instead of hard links. This option merely produces
9808 an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
9814 @optNoTargetDirectory
9820 Print the name of each file after linking it successfully.
9824 @cindex hard links to symbolic links
9825 @cindex symbolic links and @command{ln}
9826 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
9827 precedence. If @option{-s} is also given, @option{-L} and @option{-P}
9828 are silently ignored. If neither option is given, then this
9829 implementation defaults to @option{-P} if the system @code{link} supports
9830 hard links to symbolic links (such as the GNU system), and @option{-L}
9831 if @code{link} follows symbolic links (such as on BSD).
9840 # Create link ../a pointing to a in that directory.
9841 # Not really useful because it points to itself.
9846 # Change to the target before creating symlinks to avoid being confused.
9852 # Hard coded file names don't move well.
9853 ln -s $(pwd)/a /some/dir/
9857 # Relative file names survive directory moves and also
9858 # work across networked file systems.
9859 ln -s afile anotherfile
9860 ln -s ../adir/afile yetanotherfile
9864 @node mkdir invocation
9865 @section @command{mkdir}: Make directories
9868 @cindex directories, creating
9869 @cindex creating directories
9871 @command{mkdir} creates directories with the specified names. Synopsis:
9874 mkdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
9877 @command{mkdir} creates each directory @var{name} in the order given.
9878 It reports an error if @var{name} already exists, unless the
9879 @option{-p} option is given and @var{name} is a directory.
9881 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9886 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
9889 @cindex modes of created directories, setting
9890 Set the file permission bits of created directories to @var{mode},
9891 which uses the same syntax as
9892 in @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rwx} (read, write and execute allowed for
9893 everyone) for the point of the departure. @xref{File permissions}.
9895 Normally the directory has the desired file mode bits at the moment it
9896 is created. As a GNU extension, @var{mode} may also mention
9897 special mode bits, but in this case there may be a temporary window
9898 during which the directory exists but its special mode bits are
9899 incorrect. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
9900 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of directories are inherited unless
9901 overridden in this way.
9907 @cindex parent directories, creating
9908 Make any missing parent directories for each argument, setting their
9909 file permission bits to the umask modified by @samp{u+wx}. Ignore
9910 existing parent directories, and do not change their file permission
9913 To set the file permission bits of any newly-created parent
9914 directories to a value that includes @samp{u+wx}, you can set the
9915 umask before invoking @command{mkdir}. For example, if the shell
9916 command @samp{(umask u=rwx,go=rx; mkdir -p P/Q)} creates the parent
9917 @file{P} it sets the parent's permission bits to @samp{u=rwx,go=rx}.
9918 To set a parent's special mode bits as well, you can invoke
9919 @command{chmod} after @command{mkdir}. @xref{Directory Setuid and
9920 Setgid}, for how the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of
9921 newly-created parent directories are inherited.
9927 Print a message for each created directory. This is most useful with
9937 @node mkfifo invocation
9938 @section @command{mkfifo}: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
9941 @cindex FIFOs, creating
9942 @cindex named pipes, creating
9943 @cindex creating FIFOs (named pipes)
9945 @command{mkfifo} creates FIFOs (also called @dfn{named pipes}) with the
9946 specified names. Synopsis:
9949 mkfifo [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
9952 A @dfn{FIFO} is a special file type that permits independent processes
9953 to communicate. One process opens the FIFO file for writing, and
9954 another for reading, after which data can flow as with the usual
9955 anonymous pipe in shells or elsewhere.
9957 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9962 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
9965 @cindex modes of created FIFOs, setting
9966 Set the mode of created FIFOs to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
9967 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} (read and write allowed for everyone)
9968 for the point of departure. @var{mode} should specify only file
9969 permission bits. @xref{File permissions}.
9978 @node mknod invocation
9979 @section @command{mknod}: Make block or character special files
9982 @cindex block special files, creating
9983 @cindex character special files, creating
9985 @command{mknod} creates a FIFO, character special file, or block special
9986 file with the specified name. Synopsis:
9989 mknod [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name} @var{type} [@var{major} @var{minor}]
9992 @cindex special files
9993 @cindex block special files
9994 @cindex character special files
9995 Unlike the phrase ``special file type'' above, the term @dfn{special
9996 file} has a technical meaning on Unix: something that can generate or
9997 receive data. Usually this corresponds to a physical piece of hardware,
9998 e.g., a printer or a disk. (These files are typically created at
9999 system-configuration time.) The @command{mknod} command is what creates
10000 files of this type. Such devices can be read either a character at a
10001 time or a ``block'' (many characters) at a time, hence we say there are
10002 @dfn{block special} files and @dfn{character special} files.
10004 @c mknod is a shell built-in at least with OpenBSD's /bin/sh
10005 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{mknod}
10007 The arguments after @var{name} specify the type of file to make:
10012 @opindex p @r{for FIFO file}
10016 @opindex b @r{for block special file}
10017 for a block special file
10020 @c Don't document the 'u' option -- it's just a synonym for 'c'.
10021 @c Do *any* versions of mknod still use it?
10023 @opindex c @r{for character special file}
10024 @c @opindex u @r{for character special file}
10025 for a character special file
10029 When making a block or character special file, the major and minor
10030 device numbers must be given after the file type.
10031 If a major or minor device number begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X},
10032 it is interpreted as hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0},
10033 as octal; otherwise, as decimal.
10035 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10039 @item -m @var{mode}
10040 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
10043 Set the mode of created files to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
10044 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} as the point of departure.
10045 @var{mode} should specify only file permission bits.
10046 @xref{File permissions}.
10055 @node readlink invocation
10056 @section @command{readlink}: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
10059 @cindex displaying value of a symbolic link
10060 @cindex canonical file name
10061 @cindex canonicalize a file name
10064 @command{readlink} may work in one of two supported modes:
10068 @item Readlink mode
10070 @command{readlink} outputs the value of the given symbolic links.
10071 If @command{readlink} is invoked with an argument other than the name
10072 of a symbolic link, it produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
10074 @item Canonicalize mode
10076 @command{readlink} outputs the absolute name of the given files which contain
10077 no @file{.}, @file{..} components nor any repeated separators
10078 (@file{/}) or symbolic links.
10083 readlink [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
10086 By default, @command{readlink} operates in readlink mode.
10088 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10093 @itemx --canonicalize
10095 @opindex --canonicalize
10096 Activate canonicalize mode.
10097 If any component of the file name except the last one is missing or unavailable,
10098 @command{readlink} produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit
10099 code. A trailing slash is ignored.
10102 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
10104 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
10105 Activate canonicalize mode.
10106 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} produces
10107 no output and exits with a nonzero exit code. A trailing slash
10108 requires that the name resolve to a directory.
10111 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
10113 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
10114 Activate canonicalize mode.
10115 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} treats it
10119 @itemx --no-newline
10121 @opindex --no-newline
10122 Do not print the output delimiter, when a single @var{file} is specified.
10123 Print a warning if specified along with multiple @var{file}s.
10133 Suppress most error messages.
10139 Report error messages.
10145 The @command{readlink} utility first appeared in OpenBSD 2.1.
10147 The @command{realpath} command without options, operates like
10148 @command{readlink} in canonicalize mode.
10153 @node rmdir invocation
10154 @section @command{rmdir}: Remove empty directories
10157 @cindex removing empty directories
10158 @cindex directories, removing empty
10160 @command{rmdir} removes empty directories. Synopsis:
10163 rmdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{directory}@dots{}
10166 If any @var{directory} argument does not refer to an existing empty
10167 directory, it is an error.
10169 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10173 @item --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
10174 @opindex --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
10175 @cindex directory deletion, ignoring failures
10176 Ignore each failure to remove a directory that is solely because
10177 the directory is non-empty.
10183 @cindex parent directories, removing
10184 Remove @var{directory}, then try to remove each component of @var{directory}.
10185 So, for example, @samp{rmdir -p a/b/c} is similar to @samp{rmdir a/b/c a/b a}.
10186 As such, it fails if any of those directories turns out not to be empty.
10187 Use the @option{--ignore-fail-on-non-empty} option to make it so such
10188 a failure does not evoke a diagnostic and does not cause @command{rmdir} to
10189 exit unsuccessfully.
10195 @cindex directory deletion, reporting
10196 Give a diagnostic for each successful removal.
10197 @var{directory} is removed.
10201 @xref{rm invocation}, for how to remove non-empty directories (recursively).
10206 @node unlink invocation
10207 @section @command{unlink}: Remove files via the unlink syscall
10210 @cindex removing files or directories (via the unlink syscall)
10212 @command{unlink} deletes a single specified file name.
10213 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
10214 @code{unlink} function. @xref{Deleting Files, , , libc,
10215 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}. Synopsis:
10216 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
10217 @command{rm} command (@pxref{rm invocation}).
10220 unlink @var{filename}
10223 On some systems @code{unlink} can be used to delete the name of a
10224 directory. On others, it can be used that way only by a privileged user.
10225 In the GNU system @code{unlink} can never delete the name of a directory.
10227 The @command{unlink} command honors the @option{--help} and
10228 @option{--version} options. To remove a file whose name begins with
10229 @samp{-}, prefix the name with @samp{./}, e.g., @samp{unlink ./--help}.
10234 @node Changing file attributes
10235 @chapter Changing file attributes
10237 @cindex changing file attributes
10238 @cindex file attributes, changing
10239 @cindex attributes, file
10241 A file is not merely its contents, a name, and a file type
10242 (@pxref{Special file types}). A file also has an owner (a user ID), a
10243 group (a group ID), permissions (what the owner can do with the file,
10244 what people in the group can do, and what everyone else can do), various
10245 timestamps, and other information. Collectively, we call these a file's
10248 These commands change file attributes.
10251 * chown invocation:: Change file owners and groups.
10252 * chgrp invocation:: Change file groups.
10253 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions.
10254 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps.
10258 @node chown invocation
10259 @section @command{chown}: Change file owner and group
10262 @cindex file ownership, changing
10263 @cindex group ownership, changing
10264 @cindex changing file ownership
10265 @cindex changing group ownership
10267 @command{chown} changes the user and/or group ownership of each given @var{file}
10268 to @var{new-owner} or to the user and group of an existing reference file.
10272 chown [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{new-owner} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
10276 If used, @var{new-owner} specifies the new owner and/or group as follows
10277 (with no embedded white space):
10280 [@var{owner}] [ : [@var{group}] ]
10287 If only an @var{owner} (a user name or numeric user ID) is given, that
10288 user is made the owner of each given file, and the files' group is not
10291 @item owner@samp{:}group
10292 If the @var{owner} is followed by a colon and a @var{group} (a
10293 group name or numeric group ID), with no spaces between them, the group
10294 ownership of the files is changed as well (to @var{group}).
10296 @item owner@samp{:}
10297 If a colon but no group name follows @var{owner}, that user is
10298 made the owner of the files and the group of the files is changed to
10299 @var{owner}'s login group.
10301 @item @samp{:}group
10302 If the colon and following @var{group} are given, but the owner
10303 is omitted, only the group of the files is changed; in this case,
10304 @command{chown} performs the same function as @command{chgrp}.
10307 If only a colon is given, or if @var{new-owner} is empty, neither the
10308 owner nor the group is changed.
10312 If @var{owner} or @var{group} is intended to represent a numeric user
10313 or group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
10314 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
10316 Some older scripts may still use @samp{.} in place of the @samp{:} separator.
10317 POSIX 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) does not
10318 require support for that, but for backward compatibility GNU
10319 @command{chown} supports @samp{.} so long as no ambiguity results.
10320 New scripts should avoid the use of @samp{.} because it is not
10321 portable, and because it has undesirable results if the entire
10322 @var{owner@samp{.}group} happens to identify a user whose name
10325 @macro chownGroupRestrictions
10326 It is system dependent whether a user can change the group to an arbitrary one,
10327 or the more portable behavior of being restricted to setting a group of
10328 which the user is a member.
10330 @chownGroupRestrictions
10332 The @command{chown} command sometimes clears the set-user-ID or
10333 set-group-ID permission bits. This behavior depends on the policy and
10334 functionality of the underlying @code{chown} system call, which may
10335 make system-dependent file mode modifications outside the control of
10336 the @command{chown} command. For example, the @command{chown} command
10337 might not affect those bits when invoked by a user with appropriate
10338 privileges, or when the
10339 bits signify some function other than executable permission (e.g.,
10340 mandatory locking).
10341 When in doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
10343 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10351 @cindex changed owners, verbosely describing
10352 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose ownership
10361 @cindex error messages, omitting
10362 Do not print error messages about files whose ownership cannot be
10365 @item --from=@var{old-owner}
10367 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10368 Change a @var{file}'s ownership only if it has current attributes specified
10369 by @var{old-owner}. @var{old-owner} has the same form as @var{new-owner}
10371 This option is useful primarily from a security standpoint in that
10372 it narrows considerably the window of potential abuse.
10373 For example, to reflect a user ID numbering change for one user's files
10374 without an option like this, @code{root} might run
10377 find / -owner OLDUSER -print0 | xargs -0 chown -h NEWUSER
10380 But that is dangerous because the interval between when the @command{find}
10381 tests the existing file's owner and when the @command{chown} is actually run
10382 may be quite large.
10383 One way to narrow the gap would be to invoke chown for each file
10387 find / -owner OLDUSER -exec chown -h NEWUSER @{@} \;
10390 But that is very slow if there are many affected files.
10391 With this option, it is safer (the gap is narrower still)
10392 though still not perfect:
10395 chown -h -R --from=OLDUSER NEWUSER /
10398 @item --dereference
10399 @opindex --dereference
10400 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10402 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
10403 This is the default.
10406 @itemx --no-dereference
10408 @opindex --no-dereference
10409 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10411 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
10412 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
10413 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
10414 @command{chown} fails when a file specified on the command line
10415 is a symbolic link.
10416 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
10417 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
10419 @item --preserve-root
10420 @opindex --preserve-root
10421 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
10422 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
10423 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
10424 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10426 @item --no-preserve-root
10427 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10428 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
10429 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
10430 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10432 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
10433 @opindex --reference
10434 Change the user and group of each @var{file} to be the same as those of
10435 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
10436 user and group of the symbolic link, but rather those of the file it
10443 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
10444 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
10445 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
10446 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
10447 its referent is being changed.
10452 @opindex --recursive
10453 @cindex recursively changing file ownership
10454 Recursively change ownership of directories and their contents.
10457 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10460 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10463 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10472 # Change the owner of /u to "root".
10475 # Likewise, but also change its group to "staff".
10476 chown root:staff /u
10478 # Change the owner of /u and subfiles to "root".
10483 @node chgrp invocation
10484 @section @command{chgrp}: Change group ownership
10487 @cindex group ownership, changing
10488 @cindex changing group ownership
10490 @command{chgrp} changes the group ownership of each given @var{file}
10491 to @var{group} (which can be either a group name or a numeric group ID)
10492 or to the group of an existing reference file. @xref{chown invocation}.
10496 chgrp [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{group} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
10500 If @var{group} is intended to represent a
10501 numeric group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
10502 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
10504 @chownGroupRestrictions
10506 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10514 @cindex changed files, verbosely describing
10515 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose group actually
10524 @cindex error messages, omitting
10525 Do not print error messages about files whose group cannot be
10528 @item --dereference
10529 @opindex --dereference
10530 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10532 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
10533 This is the default.
10536 @itemx --no-dereference
10538 @opindex --no-dereference
10539 @cindex symbolic links, changing group
10541 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
10542 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
10543 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
10544 @command{chgrp} fails when a file specified on the command line
10545 is a symbolic link.
10546 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
10547 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
10549 @item --preserve-root
10550 @opindex --preserve-root
10551 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
10552 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
10553 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
10554 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10556 @item --no-preserve-root
10557 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10558 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
10559 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
10560 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10562 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
10563 @opindex --reference
10564 Change the group of each @var{file} to be the same as that of
10565 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
10566 group of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
10572 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
10573 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
10574 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
10575 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
10576 its referent is being changed.
10581 @opindex --recursive
10582 @cindex recursively changing group ownership
10583 Recursively change the group ownership of directories and their contents.
10586 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10589 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10592 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10601 # Change the group of /u to "staff".
10604 # Change the group of /u and subfiles to "staff".
10609 @node chmod invocation
10610 @section @command{chmod}: Change access permissions
10613 @cindex changing access permissions
10614 @cindex access permissions, changing
10615 @cindex permissions, changing access
10617 @command{chmod} changes the access permissions of the named files. Synopsis:
10620 chmod [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{mode} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
10624 @cindex symbolic links, permissions of
10625 @command{chmod} never changes the permissions of symbolic links, since
10626 the @command{chmod} system call cannot change their permissions.
10627 This is not a problem since the permissions of symbolic links are
10628 never used. However, for each symbolic link listed on the command
10629 line, @command{chmod} changes the permissions of the pointed-to file.
10630 In contrast, @command{chmod} ignores symbolic links encountered during
10631 recursive directory traversals.
10633 A successful use of @command{chmod} clears the set-group-ID bit of a
10634 regular file if the file's group ID does not match the user's
10635 effective group ID or one of the user's supplementary group IDs,
10636 unless the user has appropriate privileges. Additional restrictions
10637 may cause the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of @var{mode} or
10638 @var{ref_file} to be ignored. This behavior depends on the policy and
10639 functionality of the underlying @code{chmod} system call. When in
10640 doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
10642 If used, @var{mode} specifies the new file mode bits.
10643 For details, see the section on @ref{File permissions}.
10644 If you really want @var{mode} to have a leading @samp{-}, you should
10645 use @option{--} first, e.g., @samp{chmod -- -w file}. Typically,
10646 though, @samp{chmod a-w file} is preferable, and @command{chmod -w
10647 file} (without the @option{--}) complains if it behaves differently
10648 from what @samp{chmod a-w file} would do.
10650 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10658 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose permissions
10667 @cindex error messages, omitting
10668 Do not print error messages about files whose permissions cannot be
10671 @item --preserve-root
10672 @opindex --preserve-root
10673 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
10674 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
10675 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
10676 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10678 @item --no-preserve-root
10679 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10680 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
10681 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
10682 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10688 Verbosely describe the action or non-action taken for every @var{file}.
10690 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
10691 @opindex --reference
10692 Change the mode of each @var{file} to be the same as that of @var{ref_file}.
10693 @xref{File permissions}.
10694 If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the mode
10695 of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
10700 @opindex --recursive
10701 @cindex recursively changing access permissions
10702 Recursively change permissions of directories and their contents.
10709 @node touch invocation
10710 @section @command{touch}: Change file timestamps
10713 @cindex changing file timestamps
10714 @cindex file timestamps, changing
10715 @cindex timestamps, changing file
10717 @command{touch} changes the access and/or modification times of the
10718 specified files. Synopsis:
10721 touch [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
10724 @cindex empty files, creating
10725 Any @var{file} argument that does not exist is created empty, unless
10726 option @option{--no-create} (@option{-c}) or @option{--no-dereference}
10727 (@option{-h}) was in effect.
10729 A @var{file} argument string of @samp{-} is handled specially and
10730 causes @command{touch} to change the times of the file associated with
10734 By default, @command{touch} sets file timestamps to the current time.
10735 Because @command{touch} acts on its operands left to right, the
10736 resulting timestamps of earlier and later operands may disagree.
10737 Also, the determination of what time is ``current'' depends on the
10738 platform. Platforms with network file systems often use different
10739 clocks for the operating system and for file systems; because
10740 @command{touch} typically uses file systems' clocks by default, clock
10741 skew can cause the resulting file timestamps to appear to be in a
10742 program's ``future'' or ``past''.
10744 @cindex file timestamp resolution
10745 The @command{touch} command sets the file's timestamp to the greatest
10746 representable value that is not greater than the requested time. This
10747 can differ from the requested time for several reasons. First, the
10748 requested time may have a higher resolution than supported. Second, a
10749 file system may use different resolutions for different types of
10750 times. Third, file timestamps may use a different resolution than
10751 operating system timestamps. Fourth, the operating system primitives
10752 used to update timestamps may employ yet a different resolution. For
10753 example, in theory a file system might use 10-microsecond resolution
10754 for access time and 100-nanosecond resolution for modification time,
10755 and the operating system might use nanosecond resolution for the
10756 current time and microsecond resolution for the primitive that
10757 @command{touch} uses to set a file's timestamp to an arbitrary value.
10759 @cindex permissions, for changing file timestamps
10760 When setting file timestamps to the current time, @command{touch} can
10761 change the timestamps for files that the user does not own but has
10762 write permission for. Otherwise, the user must own the files. Some
10763 older systems have a further restriction: the user must own the files
10764 unless both the access and modification times are being set to the
10767 Although @command{touch} provides options for changing two of the times---the
10768 times of last access and modification---of a file, there is actually
10769 a standard third one as well: the inode change time. This is often
10770 referred to as a file's @code{ctime}.
10771 The inode change time represents the time when the file's meta-information
10772 last changed. One common example of this is when the permissions of a
10773 file change. Changing the permissions doesn't access the file, so
10774 the atime doesn't change, nor does it modify the file, so the mtime
10775 doesn't change. Yet, something about the file itself has changed,
10776 and this must be noted somewhere. This is the job of the ctime field.
10777 This is necessary, so that, for example, a backup program can make a
10778 fresh copy of the file, including the new permissions value.
10779 Another operation that modifies a file's ctime without affecting
10780 the others is renaming. In any case, it is not possible, in normal
10781 operations, for a user to change the ctime field to a user-specified value.
10782 Some operating systems and file systems support a fourth time: the
10783 birth time, when the file was first created; by definition, this
10784 timestamp never changes.
10787 Time stamps assume the time zone rules specified by the @env{TZ}
10788 environment variable, or by the system default rules if @env{TZ} is
10789 not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with @env{TZ},
10790 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
10791 You can avoid ambiguities during
10792 daylight saving transitions by using UTC time stamps.
10794 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10799 @itemx --time=atime
10800 @itemx --time=access
10804 @opindex atime@r{, changing}
10805 @opindex access @r{time, changing}
10806 @opindex use @r{time, changing}
10807 Change the access time only.
10812 @opindex --no-create
10813 Do not warn about or create files that do not exist.
10816 @itemx --date=@var{time}
10820 Use @var{time} instead of the current time. It can contain month names,
10821 time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm}, @samp{yesterday}, etc. For
10822 example, @option{--date="2004-02-27 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"}
10823 specifies the instant of time that is 489,392,193 nanoseconds after
10824 February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a time zone that is 5 hours and 30
10825 minutes east of UTC@. @xref{Date input formats}.
10826 File systems that do not support high-resolution time stamps
10827 silently ignore any excess precision here.
10831 @cindex BSD @command{touch} compatibility
10832 Ignored; for compatibility with BSD versions of @command{touch}.
10835 @itemx --no-dereference
10837 @opindex --no-dereference
10838 @cindex symbolic links, changing time
10840 Attempt to change the timestamps of a symbolic link, rather than what
10841 the link refers to. When using this option, empty files are not
10842 created, but option @option{-c} must also be used to avoid warning
10843 about files that do not exist. Not all systems support changing the
10844 timestamps of symlinks, since underlying system support for this
10845 action was not required until POSIX 2008. Also, on some
10846 systems, the mere act of examining a symbolic link changes the access
10847 time, such that only changes to the modification time will persist
10848 long enough to be observable. When coupled with option @option{-r}, a
10849 reference timestamp is taken from a symbolic link rather than the file
10853 @itemx --time=mtime
10854 @itemx --time=modify
10857 @opindex mtime@r{, changing}
10858 @opindex modify @r{time, changing}
10859 Change the modification time only.
10861 @item -r @var{file}
10862 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
10864 @opindex --reference
10865 Use the times of the reference @var{file} instead of the current time.
10866 If this option is combined with the @option{--date=@var{time}}
10867 (@option{-d @var{time}}) option, the reference @var{file}'s time is
10868 the origin for any relative @var{time}s given, but is otherwise ignored.
10869 For example, @samp{-r foo -d '-5 seconds'} specifies a time stamp
10870 equal to five seconds before the corresponding time stamp for @file{foo}.
10871 If @var{file} is a symbolic link, the reference timestamp is taken
10872 from the target of the symlink, unless @option{-h} was also in effect.
10874 @item -t [[@var{cc}]@var{yy}]@var{mmddhhmm}[.@var{ss}]
10875 @cindex leap seconds
10876 Use the argument (optional four-digit or two-digit years, months,
10877 days, hours, minutes, optional seconds) instead of the current time.
10878 If the year is specified with only two digits, then @var{cc}
10879 is 20 for years in the range 0 @dots{} 68, and 19 for years in
10880 69 @dots{} 99. If no digits of the year are specified,
10881 the argument is interpreted as a date in the current year.
10882 On the atypical systems that support leap seconds, @var{ss} may be
10887 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
10888 On older systems, @command{touch} supports an obsolete syntax, as follows.
10889 If no timestamp is given with any of the @option{-d}, @option{-r}, or
10890 @option{-t} options, and if there are two or more @var{file}s and the
10891 first @var{file} is of the form @samp{@var{mmddhhmm}[@var{yy}]} and this
10892 would be a valid argument to the @option{-t} option (if the @var{yy}, if
10893 any, were moved to the front), and if the represented year
10894 is in the range 1969--1999, that argument is interpreted as the time
10895 for the other files instead of as a file name.
10896 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
10897 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
10898 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
10899 behavior depends on this variable.
10900 For example, use @samp{touch ./12312359 main.c} or @samp{touch -t
10901 12312359 main.c} rather than the ambiguous @samp{touch 12312359 main.c}.
10907 @chapter Disk usage
10911 No disk can hold an infinite amount of data. These commands report
10912 how much disk storage is in use or available, report other file and
10913 file status information, and write buffers to disk.
10916 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage.
10917 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage.
10918 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status.
10919 * sync invocation:: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage.
10920 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file.
10924 @node df invocation
10925 @section @command{df}: Report file system disk space usage
10928 @cindex file system disk usage
10929 @cindex disk usage by file system
10931 @command{df} reports the amount of disk space used and available on
10932 file systems. Synopsis:
10935 df [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
10938 With no arguments, @command{df} reports the space used and available on all
10939 currently mounted file systems (of all types). Otherwise, @command{df}
10940 reports on the file system containing each argument @var{file}.
10942 Normally the disk space is printed in units of
10943 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
10944 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
10946 For bind mounts and without arguments, @command{df} only outputs the statistics
10947 for that device with the shortest mount point name in the list of file systems
10948 (@var{mtab}), i.e., it hides duplicate entries, unless the @option{-a} option is
10951 With the same logic, @command{df} elides a mount entry of a dummy pseudo device
10952 if there is another mount entry of a real block device for that mount point with
10953 the same device number, e.g. the early-boot pseudo file system @samp{rootfs} is
10954 not shown per default when already the real root device has been mounted.
10956 @cindex disk device file
10957 @cindex device file, disk
10958 If an argument @var{file} resolves to a special file containing
10959 a mounted file system, @command{df} shows the space available on that
10960 file system rather than on the file system containing the device node.
10961 GNU @command{df} does not attempt to determine the disk usage
10962 on unmounted file systems, because on most kinds of systems doing so
10963 requires extremely nonportable intimate knowledge of file system structures.
10965 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10973 @cindex ignore file systems
10974 Include in the listing dummy, duplicate, or inaccessible file systems, which
10975 are omitted by default. Dummy file systems are typically special purpose
10976 pseudo file systems such as @samp{/proc}, with no associated storage.
10977 Duplicate file systems are local or remote file systems that are mounted
10978 at separate locations in the local file hierarchy, or bind mounted locations.
10979 Inaccessible file systems are those which are mounted but subsequently
10980 over-mounted by another file system at that point, or otherwise inaccessible
10981 due to permissions of the mount point etc.
10983 @item -B @var{size}
10984 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
10986 @opindex --block-size
10987 @cindex file system sizes
10988 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
10989 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
10995 Equivalent to @option{--si}.
11001 @cindex inode usage
11002 List inode usage information instead of block usage. An inode (short
11003 for index node) contains information about a file such as its owner,
11004 permissions, timestamps, and location on the disk.
11008 @cindex kibibytes for file system sizes
11009 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
11010 (@pxref{Block size}).
11011 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
11017 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
11018 Limit the listing to local file systems. By default, remote file systems
11023 @cindex file system space, retrieving old data more quickly
11024 Do not invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data.
11025 This may make @command{df} run significantly faster on systems with many
11026 disks, but on some systems (notably SunOS) the results may be slightly
11027 out of date. This is the default.
11030 @itemx --output[=@var{field_list}]
11032 Use the output format defined by @var{field_list}, or print all fields if
11033 @var{field_list} is omitted. In the latter case, the order of the columns
11034 conforms to the order of the field descriptions below.
11036 The use of the @option{--output} together with each of the options @option{-i},
11037 @option{-P}, and @option{-T} is mutually exclusive.
11039 FIELD_LIST is a comma-separated list of columns to be included in @command{df}'s
11040 output and therefore effectively controls the order of output columns.
11041 Each field can thus be used at the place of choice, but yet must only be
11044 Valid field names in the @var{field_list} are:
11047 The source of the mount point, usually a device.
11052 Total number of inodes.
11054 Number of used inodes.
11056 Number of available inodes.
11058 Percentage of @var{iused} divided by @var{itotal}.
11061 Total number of blocks.
11063 Number of used blocks.
11065 Number of available blocks.
11067 Percentage of @var{used} divided by @var{size}.
11070 The file name if specified on the command line.
11075 The fields for block and inodes statistics are affected by the scaling
11076 options like @option{-h} as usual.
11078 The definition of the @var{field_list} can even be split among several
11079 @option{--output} uses.
11083 # Print the TARGET (i.e., the mount point) along with their percentage
11084 # statistic regarding the blocks and the inodes.
11085 df --out=target --output=pcent,ipcent
11087 # Print all available fields.
11093 @itemx --portability
11095 @opindex --portability
11096 @cindex one-line output format
11097 @cindex POSIX output format
11098 @cindex portable output format
11099 @cindex output format, portable
11100 Use the POSIX output format. This is like the default format except
11105 The information about each file system is always printed on exactly
11106 one line; a mount device is never put on a line by itself. This means
11107 that if the mount device name is more than 20 characters long (e.g., for
11108 some network mounts), the columns are misaligned.
11111 The labels in the header output line are changed to conform to POSIX.
11114 The default block size and output format are unaffected by the
11115 @env{DF_BLOCK_SIZE}, @env{BLOCK_SIZE} and @env{BLOCKSIZE} environment
11116 variables. However, the default block size is still affected by
11117 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}: it is 512 if @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, 1024
11118 otherwise. @xref{Block size}.
11125 @cindex file system space, retrieving current data more slowly
11126 Invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data. On
11127 some systems (notably SunOS), doing this yields more up to date results,
11128 but in general this option makes @command{df} much slower, especially when
11129 there are many or very busy file systems.
11133 @cindex grand total of disk size, usage and available space
11134 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
11135 been processed. This can be used to find out the total disk size, usage
11136 and available space of all listed devices. If no arguments are specified
11137 df will try harder to elide file systems insignificant to the total
11138 available space, by suppressing duplicate remote file systems.
11140 For the grand total line, @command{df} prints @samp{"total"} into the
11141 @var{source} column, and @samp{"-"} into the @var{target} column.
11142 If there is no @var{source} column (see @option{--output}), then
11143 @command{df} prints @samp{"total"} into the @var{target} column,
11146 @item -t @var{fstype}
11147 @itemx --type=@var{fstype}
11150 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
11151 Limit the listing to file systems of type @var{fstype}. Multiple
11152 file system types can be specified by giving multiple @option{-t} options.
11153 By default, nothing is omitted.
11156 @itemx --print-type
11158 @opindex --print-type
11159 @cindex file system types, printing
11160 Print each file system's type. The types printed here are the same ones
11161 you can include or exclude with @option{-t} and @option{-x}. The particular
11162 types printed are whatever is supported by the system. Here are some of
11163 the common names (this list is certainly not exhaustive):
11168 @cindex NFS file system type
11169 An NFS file system, i.e., one mounted over a network from another
11170 machine. This is the one type name which seems to be used uniformly by
11173 @item ext2@r{, }ext3@r{, }ext4@r{, }xfs@r{, }btrfs@dots{}
11174 @cindex Linux file system types
11175 @cindex local file system types
11176 @opindex ext2 @r{file system type}
11177 @opindex ext3 @r{file system type}
11178 @opindex ext4 @r{file system type}
11179 @opindex xfs @r{file system type}
11180 @opindex btrfs @r{file system type}
11181 A file system on a locally-mounted hard disk. (The system might even
11182 support more than one type here; Linux does.)
11184 @item iso9660@r{, }cdfs
11185 @cindex CD-ROM file system type
11186 @cindex DVD file system type
11187 @cindex ISO9660 file system type
11188 @opindex iso9660 @r{file system type}
11189 @opindex cdfs @r{file system type}
11190 A file system on a CD or DVD drive. HP-UX uses @samp{cdfs}, most other
11191 systems use @samp{iso9660}.
11194 @cindex NTFS file system
11195 @cindex DOS file system
11196 @cindex MS-DOS file system
11197 @cindex MS-Windows file system
11198 @opindex ntfs @r{file system file}
11199 @opindex fat @r{file system file}
11200 File systems used by MS-Windows / MS-DOS.
11204 @item -x @var{fstype}
11205 @itemx --exclude-type=@var{fstype}
11207 @opindex --exclude-type
11208 Limit the listing to file systems not of type @var{fstype}.
11209 Multiple file system types can be eliminated by giving multiple
11210 @option{-x} options. By default, no file system types are omitted.
11213 Ignored; for compatibility with System V versions of @command{df}.
11217 @command{df} is installed only on systems that have usable mount tables,
11218 so portable scripts should not rely on its existence.
11221 Failure includes the case where no output is generated, so you can
11222 inspect the exit status of a command like @samp{df -t ext3 -t reiserfs
11223 @var{dir}} to test whether @var{dir} is on a file system of type
11224 @samp{ext3} or @samp{reiserfs}.
11226 Since the list of file systems (@var{mtab}) is needed to determine the
11227 file system type, failure includes the cases when that list cannot
11228 be read and one or more of the options @option{-a}, @option{-l}, @option{-t}
11229 or @option{-x} is used together with a file name argument.
11232 @node du invocation
11233 @section @command{du}: Estimate file space usage
11236 @cindex file space usage
11237 @cindex disk usage for files
11239 @command{du} reports the amount of disk space used by the set of specified files
11240 and for each subdirectory (of directory arguments). Synopsis:
11243 du [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
11246 With no arguments, @command{du} reports the disk space for the current
11247 directory. Normally the disk space is printed in units of
11248 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
11249 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
11251 If two or more hard links point to the same file, only one of the hard
11252 links is counted. The @var{file} argument order affects which links
11253 are counted, and changing the argument order may change the numbers
11254 and entries that @command{du} outputs.
11256 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11266 Show counts for all files, not just directories.
11268 @item --apparent-size
11269 @opindex --apparent-size
11270 Print apparent sizes, rather than disk usage. The apparent size of a
11271 file is the number of bytes reported by @code{wc -c} on regular files,
11272 or more generally, @code{ls -l --block-size=1} or @code{stat --format=%s}.
11273 For example, a file containing the word @samp{zoo} with no newline would,
11274 of course, have an apparent size of 3. Such a small file may require
11275 anywhere from 0 to 16 KiB or more of disk space, depending on
11276 the type and configuration of the file system on which the file resides.
11277 However, a sparse file created with this command:
11280 dd bs=1 seek=2GiB if=/dev/null of=big
11284 has an apparent size of 2 GiB, yet on most modern
11285 systems, it actually uses almost no disk space.
11287 @item -B @var{size}
11288 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
11290 @opindex --block-size
11292 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
11293 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
11299 Equivalent to @code{--apparent-size --block-size=1}.
11305 @cindex grand total of disk space
11306 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
11307 been processed. This can be used to find out the total disk usage of
11308 a given set of files or directories.
11311 @itemx --dereference-args
11313 @opindex --dereference-args
11314 Dereference symbolic links that are command line arguments.
11315 Does not affect other symbolic links. This is helpful for finding
11316 out the disk usage of directories, such as @file{/usr/tmp}, which
11317 are often symbolic links.
11319 @item -d @var{depth}
11320 @itemx --max-depth=@var{depth}
11321 @opindex -d @var{depth}
11322 @opindex --max-depth=@var{depth}
11323 @cindex limiting output of @command{du}
11324 Show the total for each directory (and file if --all) that is at
11325 most MAX_DEPTH levels down from the root of the hierarchy. The root
11326 is at level 0, so @code{du --max-depth=0} is equivalent to @code{du -s}.
11328 @c --files0-from=FILE
11329 @filesZeroFromOption{du,, with the @option{--total} (@option{-c}) option}
11333 Equivalent to @option{--dereference-args} (@option{-D}).
11339 @cindex inode usage, dereferencing in @command{du}
11340 List inode usage information instead of block usage.
11341 This option is useful for finding directories which contain many files, and
11342 therefore eat up most of the inodes space of a file system (see @command{df},
11343 option @option{--inodes}).
11344 It can well be combined with the options @option{-a}, @option{-c},
11345 @option{-h}, @option{-l}, @option{-s}, @option{-S}, @option{-t} and
11346 @option{-x}; however, passing other options regarding the block size, for
11347 example @option{-b}, @option{-m} and @option{--apparent-size}, is ignored.
11351 @cindex kibibytes for file sizes
11352 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
11353 (@pxref{Block size}).
11354 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
11357 @itemx --dereference
11359 @opindex --dereference
11360 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
11361 Dereference symbolic links (show the disk space used by the file
11362 or directory that the link points to instead of the space used by
11366 @itemx --count-links
11368 @opindex --count-links
11369 @cindex hard links, counting in @command{du}
11370 Count the size of all files, even if they have appeared already (as a
11375 @cindex mebibytes for file sizes
11376 Print sizes in 1,048,576-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
11377 (@pxref{Block size}).
11378 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1M}.
11381 @itemx --no-dereference
11383 @opindex --no-dereference
11384 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
11385 For each symbolic links encountered by @command{du},
11386 consider the disk space used by the symbolic link.
11389 @itemx --separate-dirs
11391 @opindex --separate-dirs
11392 Normally, in the output of @command{du} (when not using @option{--summarize}),
11393 the size listed next to a directory name, @var{d}, represents the sum
11394 of sizes of all entries beneath @var{d} as well as the size of @var{d} itself.
11395 With @option{--separate-dirs}, the size reported for a directory name,
11396 @var{d}, will exclude the size of any subdirectories.
11403 @opindex --summarize
11404 Display only a total for each argument.
11406 @item -t @var{size}
11407 @itemx --threshold=@var{size}
11409 @opindex --threshold
11410 Exclude entries based on a given @var{size}. The @var{size} refers to used
11411 blocks in normal mode (@pxref{Block size}), or inodes count in conjunction
11412 with the @option{--inodes} option.
11414 If @var{size} is positive, then @command{du} will only print entries with a size
11415 greater than or equal to that.
11417 If @var{size} is negative, then @command{du} will only print entries with a size
11418 smaller than or equal to that.
11420 Although GNU @command{find} can be used to find files of a certain size,
11421 @command{du}'s @option{--threshold} option can be used to also filter
11422 directories based on a given size.
11424 Please note that the @option{--threshold} option can be combined with the
11425 @option{--apparent-size} option, and in this case would elide entries based on
11428 Please note that the @option{--threshold} option can be combined with the
11429 @option{--inodes} option, and in this case would elide entries based on
11432 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories with a size
11433 greater than or equal to 200 megabytes:
11436 du --threshold=200MB
11439 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories and files -
11440 note the @option{-a} - with an apparent size smaller than or equal to 500 bytes:
11443 du -a -t -500 --apparent-size
11446 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories on the root
11447 file system with more than 20000 inodes used in the directory tree below:
11450 du --inodes -x --threshold=20000 /
11456 @cindex last modified dates, displaying in @command{du}
11457 Show time of the most recent modification of any file in the directory,
11458 or any of its subdirectories.
11461 @itemx --time=status
11464 @opindex ctime@r{, show the most recent}
11465 @opindex status time@r{, show the most recent}
11466 @opindex use time@r{, show the most recent}
11467 Show the most recent status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) of
11468 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
11471 @itemx --time=access
11473 @opindex atime@r{, show the most recent}
11474 @opindex access time@r{, show the most recent}
11475 Show the most recent access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode) of
11476 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
11478 @item --time-style=@var{style}
11479 @opindex --time-style
11481 List timestamps in style @var{style}. This option has an effect only if
11482 the @option{--time} option is also specified. The @var{style} should
11483 be one of the following:
11486 @item +@var{format}
11488 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
11489 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
11490 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
11491 @command{du} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
11492 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
11493 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
11496 List timestamps in full using ISO 8601 date, time, and time zone
11497 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
11498 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
11499 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
11502 List ISO 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
11503 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
11504 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
11505 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
11508 List ISO 8601 dates for timestamps, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30}.
11509 This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d}.
11513 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
11514 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
11515 the default style is @samp{long-iso}. For compatibility with @command{ls},
11516 if @env{TIME_STYLE} begins with @samp{+} and contains a newline,
11517 the newline and any later characters are ignored; if @env{TIME_STYLE}
11518 begins with @samp{posix-} the @samp{posix-} is ignored; and if
11519 @env{TIME_STYLE} is @samp{locale} it is ignored.
11521 @item -X @var{file}
11522 @itemx --exclude-from=@var{file}
11523 @opindex -X @var{file}
11524 @opindex --exclude-from=@var{file}
11525 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
11526 Like @option{--exclude}, except take the patterns to exclude from @var{file},
11527 one per line. If @var{file} is @samp{-}, take the patterns from standard
11530 @item --exclude=@var{pattern}
11531 @opindex --exclude=@var{pattern}
11532 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
11533 When recursing, skip subdirectories or files matching @var{pattern}.
11534 For example, @code{du --exclude='*.o'} excludes files whose names
11538 @itemx --one-file-system
11540 @opindex --one-file-system
11541 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{du} to
11542 Skip directories that are on different file systems from the one that
11543 the argument being processed is on.
11547 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
11548 On BSD systems, @command{du} reports sizes that are half the correct
11549 values for files that are NFS-mounted from HP-UX systems. On HP-UX
11550 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for
11551 files that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw
11552 in HP-UX; it also affects the HP-UX @command{du} program.
11557 @node stat invocation
11558 @section @command{stat}: Report file or file system status
11561 @cindex file status
11562 @cindex file system status
11564 @command{stat} displays information about the specified file(s). Synopsis:
11567 stat [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
11570 With no option, @command{stat} reports all information about the given files.
11571 But it also can be used to report the information of the file systems the
11572 given files are located on. If the files are links, @command{stat} can
11573 also give information about the files the links point to.
11575 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{stat}
11580 @itemx --dereference
11582 @opindex --dereference
11583 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{stat}
11584 Change how @command{stat} treats symbolic links.
11585 With this option, @command{stat} acts on the file referenced
11586 by each symbolic link argument.
11587 Without it, @command{stat} acts on any symbolic link argument directly.
11590 @itemx --file-system
11592 @opindex --file-system
11593 @cindex file systems
11594 Report information about the file systems where the given files are located
11595 instead of information about the files themselves.
11596 This option implies the @option{-L} option.
11599 @itemx --format=@var{format}
11601 @opindex --format=@var{format}
11602 @cindex output format
11603 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
11604 @var{format} is automatically newline-terminated, so
11605 running a command like the following with two or more @var{file}
11606 operands produces a line of output for each operand:
11608 $ stat --format=%d:%i / /usr
11613 @item --printf=@var{format}
11614 @opindex --printf=@var{format}
11615 @cindex output format
11616 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
11617 Like @option{--format}, but interpret backslash escapes,
11618 and do not output a mandatory trailing newline.
11619 If you want a newline, include @samp{\n} in the @var{format}.
11620 Here's how you would use @option{--printf} to print the device
11621 and inode numbers of @file{/} and @file{/usr}:
11623 $ stat --printf='%d:%i\n' / /usr
11632 @cindex terse output
11633 Print the information in terse form, suitable for parsing by other programs.
11635 The output of the following commands are identical and the @option{--format}
11636 also identifies the items printed (in fuller form) in the default format.
11637 Note the format string would include another @samp{%C} at the end with an
11638 active SELinux security context.
11640 $ stat --format="%n %s %b %f %u %g %D %i %h %t %T %X %Y %Z %W %o" ...
11644 The same illustrating terse output in @option{--file-system} mode:
11646 $ stat -f --format="%n %i %l %t %s %S %b %f %a %c %d" ...
11647 $ stat -f --terse ...
11651 The valid @var{format} directives for files with @option{--format} and
11652 @option{--printf} are:
11655 @item %a - Access rights in octal
11656 @item %A - Access rights in human readable form
11657 @item %b - Number of blocks allocated (see @samp{%B})
11658 @item %B - The size in bytes of each block reported by @samp{%b}
11659 @item %C - The SELinux security context of a file, if available
11660 @item %d - Device number in decimal
11661 @item %D - Device number in hex
11662 @item %f - Raw mode in hex
11663 @item %F - File type
11664 @item %g - Group ID of owner
11665 @item %G - Group name of owner
11666 @item %h - Number of hard links
11667 @item %i - Inode number
11668 @item %m - Mount point (See note below)
11669 @item %n - File name
11670 @item %N - Quoted file name with dereference if symbolic link
11671 @item %o - Optimal I/O transfer size hint
11672 @item %s - Total size, in bytes
11673 @item %t - Major device type in hex (see below)
11674 @item %T - Minor device type in hex (see below)
11675 @item %u - User ID of owner
11676 @item %U - User name of owner
11677 @item %w - Time of file birth, or @samp{-} if unknown
11678 @item %W - Time of file birth as seconds since Epoch, or @samp{0}
11679 @item %x - Time of last access
11680 @item %X - Time of last access as seconds since Epoch
11681 @item %y - Time of last data modification
11682 @item %Y - Time of last data modification as seconds since Epoch
11683 @item %z - Time of last status change
11684 @item %Z - Time of last status change as seconds since Epoch
11687 The @samp{%t} and @samp{%T} formats operate on the st_rdev member of
11688 the stat(2) structure, and are only defined for character and block
11689 special files. On some systems or file types, st_rdev may be used to
11690 represent other quantities.
11692 The @samp{%W}, @samp{%X}, @samp{%Y}, and @samp{%Z} formats accept a
11693 precision preceded by a period to specify the number of digits to
11694 print after the decimal point. For example, @samp{%.3X} outputs the
11695 last access time to millisecond precision. If a period is given but no
11696 precision, @command{stat} uses 9 digits, so @samp{%.X} is equivalent to
11697 @samp{%.9X}@. When discarding excess precision, time stamps are truncated
11698 toward minus infinity.
11702 $ stat -c '[%015Y]' /usr
11705 $ stat -c '[%15Y]' /usr
11707 $ stat -c '[%-15Y]' /usr
11710 $ stat -c '[%.3Y]' /usr
11712 $ stat -c '[%.Y]' /usr
11713 [1288929712.114951834]
11716 The mount point printed by @samp{%m} is similar to that output
11717 by @command{df}, except that:
11720 stat does not dereference symlinks by default
11721 (unless @option{-L} is specified)
11723 stat does not search for specified device nodes in the
11724 file system list, instead operating on them directly
11727 stat outputs the alias for a bind mounted file, rather than
11728 the initial mount point of its backing device.
11729 One can recursively call stat until there is no change in output,
11730 to get the current base mount point
11733 When listing file system information (@option{--file-system} (@option{-f})),
11734 you must use a different set of @var{format} directives:
11737 @item %a - Free blocks available to non-super-user
11738 @item %b - Total data blocks in file system
11739 @item %c - Total file nodes in file system
11740 @item %d - Free file nodes in file system
11741 @item %f - Free blocks in file system
11742 @item %i - File System ID in hex
11743 @item %l - Maximum length of file names
11744 @item %n - File name
11745 @item %s - Block size (for faster transfers)
11746 @item %S - Fundamental block size (for block counts)
11747 @item %t - Type in hex
11748 @item %T - Type in human readable form
11752 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
11753 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
11754 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
11755 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
11760 @node sync invocation
11761 @section @command{sync}: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
11764 @cindex synchronize disk and memory
11765 @cindex Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
11767 @command{sync} synchronizes in memory files or file systems to persistent
11771 sync [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
11774 @cindex superblock, writing
11775 @cindex inodes, written buffered
11776 @command{sync} writes any data buffered in memory out to disk. This can
11777 include (but is not limited to) modified superblocks, modified inodes,
11778 and delayed reads and writes. This must be implemented by the kernel;
11779 The @command{sync} program does nothing but exercise the @code{sync},
11780 @code{syncfs}, @code{fsync}, and @code{fdatasync} system calls.
11782 @cindex crashes and corruption
11783 The kernel keeps data in memory to avoid doing (relatively slow) disk
11784 reads and writes. This improves performance, but if the computer
11785 crashes, data may be lost or the file system corrupted as a
11786 result. The @command{sync} command instructs the kernel to write
11787 data in memory to persistent storage.
11789 If any argument is specified then only those files will be
11790 synchronized using the fsync(2) syscall by default.
11792 If at least one file is specified, it is possible to change the
11793 synchronization method with the following options. Also see
11794 @ref{Common options}.
11800 Use fdatasync(2) to sync only the data for the file,
11801 and any metadata required to maintain file system consistency.
11804 @itemx --file-system
11805 @opindex --file-system
11806 Synchronize all the I/O waiting for the file systems that contain the file,
11807 using the syscall syncfs(2). Note you would usually @emph{not} specify
11808 this option if passing a device node like @samp{/dev/sda} for example,
11809 as that would sync the containing file system rather than the referenced one.
11810 Note also that depending on the system, passing individual device nodes or files
11811 may have different sync characteristics than using no arguments.
11812 I.e., arguments passed to fsync(2) may provide greater guarantees through
11813 write barriers, than a global sync(2) used when no arguments are provided.
11819 @node truncate invocation
11820 @section @command{truncate}: Shrink or extend the size of a file
11823 @cindex truncating, file sizes
11825 @command{truncate} shrinks or extends the size of each @var{file} to the
11826 specified size. Synopsis:
11829 truncate @var{option}@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
11832 @cindex files, creating
11833 Any @var{file} that does not exist is created.
11835 @cindex sparse files, creating
11836 @cindex holes, creating files with
11837 If a @var{file} is larger than the specified size, the extra data is lost.
11838 If a @var{file} is shorter, it is extended and the extended part (or hole)
11839 reads as zero bytes.
11841 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11848 @opindex --no-create
11849 Do not create files that do not exist.
11854 @opindex --io-blocks
11855 Treat @var{size} as number of I/O blocks of the @var{file} rather than bytes.
11857 @item -r @var{rfile}
11858 @itemx --reference=@var{rfile}
11860 @opindex --reference
11861 Base the size of each @var{file} on the size of @var{rfile}.
11863 @item -s @var{size}
11864 @itemx --size=@var{size}
11867 Set or adjust the size of each @var{file} according to @var{size}.
11868 @var{size} is in bytes unless @option{--io-blocks} is specified.
11869 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
11871 @var{size} may also be prefixed by one of the following to adjust
11872 the size of each @var{file} based on its current size:
11874 @samp{+} => extend by
11875 @samp{-} => reduce by
11876 @samp{<} => at most
11877 @samp{>} => at least
11878 @samp{/} => round down to multiple of
11879 @samp{%} => round up to multiple of
11887 @node Printing text
11888 @chapter Printing text
11890 @cindex printing text, commands for
11891 @cindex commands for printing text
11893 This section describes commands that display text strings.
11896 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text.
11897 * printf invocation:: Format and print data.
11898 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted.
11902 @node echo invocation
11903 @section @command{echo}: Print a line of text
11906 @cindex displaying text
11907 @cindex printing text
11908 @cindex text, displaying
11909 @cindex arbitrary text, displaying
11911 @command{echo} writes each given @var{string} to standard output, with a
11912 space between each and a newline after the last one. Synopsis:
11915 echo [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{string}]@dots{}
11918 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{echo}
11920 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11921 Options must precede operands, and the normally-special argument
11922 @samp{--} has no special meaning and is treated like any other
11928 Do not output the trailing newline.
11932 @cindex backslash escapes
11933 Enable interpretation of the following backslash-escaped characters in
11942 produce no further output
11958 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
11959 (zero to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
11960 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
11962 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
11963 (one to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
11964 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
11966 the eight-bit value that is the hexadecimal number @var{hh}
11967 (one or two hexadecimal digits)
11972 @cindex backslash escapes
11973 Disable interpretation of backslash escapes in each @var{string}.
11974 This is the default. If @option{-e} and @option{-E} are both
11975 specified, the last one given takes effect.
11979 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
11980 If the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, then when
11981 @command{echo}'s first argument is not @option{-n} it outputs
11982 option-like arguments instead of treating them as options. For
11983 example, @code{echo -ne hello} outputs @samp{-ne hello} instead of
11984 plain @samp{hello}.
11986 POSIX does not require support for any options, and says
11987 that the behavior of @command{echo} is implementation-defined if any
11988 @var{string} contains a backslash or if the first argument is
11989 @option{-n}. Portable programs can use the @command{printf} command
11990 if they need to omit trailing newlines or output control characters or
11991 backslashes. @xref{printf invocation}.
11996 @node printf invocation
11997 @section @command{printf}: Format and print data
12000 @command{printf} does formatted printing of text. Synopsis:
12003 printf @var{format} [@var{argument}]@dots{}
12006 @command{printf} prints the @var{format} string, interpreting @samp{%}
12007 directives and @samp{\} escapes to format numeric and string arguments
12008 in a way that is mostly similar to the C @samp{printf} function.
12009 @xref{Output Conversion Syntax,, @command{printf} format directives,
12010 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for details.
12011 The differences are listed below.
12013 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{printf}
12018 The @var{format} argument is reused as necessary to convert all the
12019 given @var{argument}s. For example, the command @samp{printf %s a b}
12023 Missing @var{argument}s are treated as null strings or as zeros,
12024 depending on whether the context expects a string or a number. For
12025 example, the command @samp{printf %sx%d} prints @samp{x0}.
12029 An additional escape, @samp{\c}, causes @command{printf} to produce no
12030 further output. For example, the command @samp{printf 'A%sC\cD%sF' B
12031 E} prints @samp{ABC}.
12034 The hexadecimal escape sequence @samp{\x@var{hh}} has at most two
12035 digits, as opposed to C where it can have an unlimited number of
12036 digits. For example, the command @samp{printf '\x07e'} prints two
12037 bytes, whereas the C statement @samp{printf ("\x07e")} prints just
12042 @command{printf} has an additional directive, @samp{%b}, which prints its
12043 argument string with @samp{\} escapes interpreted in the same way as in
12044 the @var{format} string, except that octal escapes are of the form
12045 @samp{\0@var{ooo}} where @var{ooo} is 0 to 3 octal digits. If
12046 @samp{\@var{ooo}} is nine-bit value, ignore the ninth bit.
12047 If a precision is also given, it limits the number of bytes printed
12048 from the converted string.
12051 Numeric arguments must be single C constants, possibly with leading
12052 @samp{+} or @samp{-}. For example, @samp{printf %.4d -3} outputs
12056 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
12057 If the leading character of a numeric argument is @samp{"} or @samp{'}
12058 then its value is the numeric value of the immediately following
12059 character. Any remaining characters are silently ignored if the
12060 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set; otherwise, a
12061 warning is printed. For example, @samp{printf "%d" "'a"} outputs
12062 @samp{97} on hosts that use the ASCII character set, since
12063 @samp{a} has the numeric value 97 in ASCII.
12068 A floating-point argument must use a period before any fractional
12069 digits, but is printed according to the @env{LC_NUMERIC} category of the
12070 current locale. For example, in a locale whose radix character is a
12071 comma, the command @samp{printf %g 3.14} outputs @samp{3,14} whereas
12072 the command @samp{printf %g 3,14} is an error.
12073 @xref{Floating point}.
12077 @command{printf} interprets @samp{\@var{ooo}} in @var{format} as an octal number
12078 (if @var{ooo} is 1 to 3 octal digits) specifying a byte to print,
12079 and @samp{\x@var{hh}} as a hexadecimal number (if @var{hh} is 1 to 2 hex
12080 digits) specifying a character to print.
12081 Note however that when @samp{\@var{ooo}} specifies a number larger than 255,
12082 @command{printf} ignores the ninth bit.
12083 For example, @samp{printf '\400'} is equivalent to @samp{printf '\0'}.
12088 @cindex ISO/IEC 10646
12090 @command{printf} interprets two character syntaxes introduced in
12092 @samp{\u} for 16-bit Unicode (ISO/IEC 10646)
12093 characters, specified as
12094 four hexadecimal digits @var{hhhh}, and @samp{\U} for 32-bit Unicode
12095 characters, specified as eight hexadecimal digits @var{hhhhhhhh}.
12096 @command{printf} outputs the Unicode characters
12097 according to the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale. Unicode characters in the ranges
12098 U+0000@dots{}U+009F, U+D800@dots{}U+DFFF cannot be specified by this syntax,
12099 except for U+0024 ($), U+0040 (@@), and U+0060 (@`).
12101 The processing of @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} requires a full-featured
12102 @code{iconv} facility. It is activated on systems with glibc 2.2 (or newer),
12103 or when @code{libiconv} is installed prior to this package. Otherwise
12104 @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} will print as-is.
12106 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
12107 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
12108 Options must precede operands.
12110 The Unicode character syntaxes are useful for writing strings in a locale
12111 independent way. For example, a string containing the Euro currency symbol
12114 $ env printf '\u20AC 14.95'
12118 will be output correctly in all locales supporting the Euro symbol
12119 (ISO-8859-15, UTF-8, and others). Similarly, a Chinese string
12122 $ env printf '\u4e2d\u6587'
12126 will be output correctly in all Chinese locales (GB2312, BIG5, UTF-8, etc).
12128 Note that in these examples, the @command{printf} command has been
12129 invoked via @command{env} to ensure that we run the program found via
12130 your shell's search path, and not a shell alias or a built-in function.
12132 For larger strings, you don't need to look up the hexadecimal code
12133 values of each character one by one. ASCII characters mixed with \u
12134 escape sequences is also known as the JAVA source file encoding. You can
12135 use GNU recode 3.5c (or newer) to convert strings to this encoding. Here
12136 is how to convert a piece of text into a shell script which will output
12137 this text in a locale-independent way:
12140 $ LC_CTYPE=zh_CN.big5 /usr/local/bin/printf \
12141 '\u4e2d\u6587\n' > sample.txt
12142 $ recode BIG5..JAVA < sample.txt \
12143 | sed -e "s|^|/usr/local/bin/printf '|" -e "s|$|\\\\n'|" \
12150 @node yes invocation
12151 @section @command{yes}: Print a string until interrupted
12154 @cindex repeated output of a string
12156 @command{yes} prints the command line arguments, separated by spaces and
12157 followed by a newline, forever until it is killed. If no arguments are
12158 given, it prints @samp{y} followed by a newline forever until killed.
12160 Upon a write error, @command{yes} exits with status @samp{1}.
12162 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
12163 To output an argument that begins with
12164 @samp{-}, precede it with @option{--}, e.g., @samp{yes -- --help}.
12165 @xref{Common options}.
12169 @chapter Conditions
12172 @cindex commands for exit status
12173 @cindex exit status commands
12175 This section describes commands that are primarily useful for their exit
12176 status, rather than their output. Thus, they are often used as the
12177 condition of shell @code{if} statements, or as the last command in a
12181 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
12182 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully.
12183 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values.
12184 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions.
12188 @node false invocation
12189 @section @command{false}: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
12192 @cindex do nothing, unsuccessfully
12193 @cindex failure exit status
12194 @cindex exit status of @command{false}
12196 @command{false} does nothing except return an exit status of 1, meaning
12197 @dfn{failure}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
12198 where an unsuccessful command is needed.
12199 In most modern shells, @command{false} is a built-in command, so when
12200 you use @samp{false} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
12201 command, not the one documented here.
12203 @command{false} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
12205 This version of @command{false} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
12206 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
12207 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
12209 Note that @command{false} (unlike all other programs documented herein)
12210 exits unsuccessfully, even when invoked with
12211 @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
12213 Portable programs should not assume that the exit status of
12214 @command{false} is 1, as it is greater than 1 on some
12218 @node true invocation
12219 @section @command{true}: Do nothing, successfully
12222 @cindex do nothing, successfully
12224 @cindex successful exit
12225 @cindex exit status of @command{true}
12227 @command{true} does nothing except return an exit status of 0, meaning
12228 @dfn{success}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
12229 where a successful command is needed, although the shell built-in
12230 command @code{:} (colon) may do the same thing faster.
12231 In most modern shells, @command{true} is a built-in command, so when
12232 you use @samp{true} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
12233 command, not the one documented here.
12235 @command{true} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
12237 Note, however, that it is possible to cause @command{true}
12238 to exit with nonzero status: with the @option{--help} or @option{--version}
12239 option, and with standard
12240 output already closed or redirected to a file that evokes an I/O error.
12241 For example, using a Bourne-compatible shell:
12244 $ ./true --version >&-
12245 ./true: write error: Bad file number
12246 $ ./true --version > /dev/full
12247 ./true: write error: No space left on device
12250 This version of @command{true} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
12251 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
12252 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
12254 @node test invocation
12255 @section @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
12258 @cindex check file types
12259 @cindex compare values
12260 @cindex expression evaluation
12262 @command{test} returns a status of 0 (true) or 1 (false) depending on the
12263 evaluation of the conditional expression @var{expr}. Each part of the
12264 expression must be a separate argument.
12266 @command{test} has file status checks, string operators, and numeric
12267 comparison operators.
12269 @command{test} has an alternate form that uses opening and closing
12270 square brackets instead a leading @samp{test}. For example, instead
12271 of @samp{test -d /}, you can write @samp{[ -d / ]}. The square
12272 brackets must be separate arguments; for example, @samp{[-d /]} does
12273 not have the desired effect. Since @samp{test @var{expr}} and @samp{[
12274 @var{expr} ]} have the same meaning, only the former form is discussed
12280 test @var{expression}
12282 [ @var{expression} ]
12287 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{test}
12289 If @var{expression} is omitted, @command{test} returns false.
12290 If @var{expression} is a single argument,
12291 @command{test} returns false if the argument is null and true
12292 otherwise. The argument
12293 can be any string, including strings like @samp{-d}, @samp{-1},
12294 @samp{--}, @samp{--help}, and @samp{--version} that most other
12295 programs would treat as options. To get help and version information,
12296 invoke the commands @samp{[ --help} and @samp{[ --version}, without
12297 the usual closing brackets. @xref{Common options}.
12299 @cindex exit status of @command{test}
12303 0 if the expression is true,
12304 1 if the expression is false,
12305 2 if an error occurred.
12309 * File type tests:: -[bcdfhLpSt]
12310 * Access permission tests:: -[gkruwxOG]
12311 * File characteristic tests:: -e -s -nt -ot -ef
12312 * String tests:: -z -n = == !=
12313 * Numeric tests:: -eq -ne -lt -le -gt -ge
12314 * Connectives for test:: ! -a -o
12318 @node File type tests
12319 @subsection File type tests
12321 @cindex file type tests
12323 These options test for particular types of files. (Everything's a file,
12324 but not all files are the same!)
12328 @item -b @var{file}
12330 @cindex block special check
12331 True if @var{file} exists and is a block special device.
12333 @item -c @var{file}
12335 @cindex character special check
12336 True if @var{file} exists and is a character special device.
12338 @item -d @var{file}
12340 @cindex directory check
12341 True if @var{file} exists and is a directory.
12343 @item -f @var{file}
12345 @cindex regular file check
12346 True if @var{file} exists and is a regular file.
12348 @item -h @var{file}
12349 @itemx -L @var{file}
12352 @cindex symbolic link check
12353 True if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
12354 Unlike all other file-related tests, this test does not dereference
12355 @var{file} if it is a symbolic link.
12357 @item -p @var{file}
12359 @cindex named pipe check
12360 True if @var{file} exists and is a named pipe.
12362 @item -S @var{file}
12364 @cindex socket check
12365 True if @var{file} exists and is a socket.
12369 @cindex terminal check
12370 True if @var{fd} is a file descriptor that is associated with a
12376 @node Access permission tests
12377 @subsection Access permission tests
12379 @cindex access permission tests
12380 @cindex permission tests
12382 These options test for particular access permissions.
12386 @item -g @var{file}
12388 @cindex set-group-ID check
12389 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-group-ID bit set.
12391 @item -k @var{file}
12393 @cindex sticky bit check
12394 True if @var{file} exists and has its @dfn{sticky} bit set.
12396 @item -r @var{file}
12398 @cindex readable file check
12399 True if @var{file} exists and read permission is granted.
12401 @item -u @var{file}
12403 @cindex set-user-ID check
12404 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-user-ID bit set.
12406 @item -w @var{file}
12408 @cindex writable file check
12409 True if @var{file} exists and write permission is granted.
12411 @item -x @var{file}
12413 @cindex executable file check
12414 True if @var{file} exists and execute permission is granted
12415 (or search permission, if it is a directory).
12417 @item -O @var{file}
12419 @cindex owned by effective user ID check
12420 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective user ID.
12422 @item -G @var{file}
12424 @cindex owned by effective group ID check
12425 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective group ID.
12429 @node File characteristic tests
12430 @subsection File characteristic tests
12432 @cindex file characteristic tests
12434 These options test other file characteristics.
12438 @item -e @var{file}
12440 @cindex existence-of-file check
12441 True if @var{file} exists.
12443 @item -s @var{file}
12445 @cindex nonempty file check
12446 True if @var{file} exists and has a size greater than zero.
12448 @item @var{file1} -nt @var{file2}
12450 @cindex newer-than file check
12451 True if @var{file1} is newer (according to modification date) than
12452 @var{file2}, or if @var{file1} exists and @var{file2} does not.
12454 @item @var{file1} -ot @var{file2}
12456 @cindex older-than file check
12457 True if @var{file1} is older (according to modification date) than
12458 @var{file2}, or if @var{file2} exists and @var{file1} does not.
12460 @item @var{file1} -ef @var{file2}
12462 @cindex same file check
12463 @cindex hard link check
12464 True if @var{file1} and @var{file2} have the same device and inode
12465 numbers, i.e., if they are hard links to each other.
12471 @subsection String tests
12473 @cindex string tests
12475 These options test string characteristics. You may need to quote
12476 @var{string} arguments for the shell. For example:
12482 The quotes here prevent the wrong arguments from being passed to
12483 @command{test} if @samp{$V} is empty or contains special characters.
12487 @item -z @var{string}
12489 @cindex zero-length string check
12490 True if the length of @var{string} is zero.
12492 @item -n @var{string}
12493 @itemx @var{string}
12495 @cindex nonzero-length string check
12496 True if the length of @var{string} is nonzero.
12498 @item @var{string1} = @var{string2}
12500 @cindex equal string check
12501 True if the strings are equal.
12503 @item @var{string1} == @var{string2}
12505 @cindex equal string check
12506 True if the strings are equal (synonym for =).
12508 @item @var{string1} != @var{string2}
12510 @cindex not-equal string check
12511 True if the strings are not equal.
12516 @node Numeric tests
12517 @subsection Numeric tests
12519 @cindex numeric tests
12520 @cindex arithmetic tests
12522 Numeric relational operators. The arguments must be entirely numeric
12523 (possibly negative), or the special expression @w{@code{-l @var{string}}},
12524 which evaluates to the length of @var{string}.
12528 @item @var{arg1} -eq @var{arg2}
12529 @itemx @var{arg1} -ne @var{arg2}
12530 @itemx @var{arg1} -lt @var{arg2}
12531 @itemx @var{arg1} -le @var{arg2}
12532 @itemx @var{arg1} -gt @var{arg2}
12533 @itemx @var{arg1} -ge @var{arg2}
12540 These arithmetic binary operators return true if @var{arg1} is equal,
12541 not-equal, less-than, less-than-or-equal, greater-than, or
12542 greater-than-or-equal than @var{arg2}, respectively.
12549 test -1 -gt -2 && echo yes
12551 test -l abc -gt 1 && echo yes
12554 @error{} test: integer expression expected before -eq
12558 @node Connectives for test
12559 @subsection Connectives for @command{test}
12561 @cindex logical connectives
12562 @cindex connectives, logical
12564 The usual logical connectives.
12570 True if @var{expr} is false.
12572 @item @var{expr1} -a @var{expr2}
12574 @cindex logical and operator
12575 @cindex and operator
12576 True if both @var{expr1} and @var{expr2} are true.
12578 @item @var{expr1} -o @var{expr2}
12580 @cindex logical or operator
12581 @cindex or operator
12582 True if either @var{expr1} or @var{expr2} is true.
12587 @node expr invocation
12588 @section @command{expr}: Evaluate expressions
12591 @cindex expression evaluation
12592 @cindex evaluation of expressions
12594 @command{expr} evaluates an expression and writes the result on standard
12595 output. Each token of the expression must be a separate argument.
12597 Operands are either integers or strings. Integers consist of one or
12598 more decimal digits, with an optional leading @samp{-}.
12599 @command{expr} converts
12600 anything appearing in an operand position to an integer or a string
12601 depending on the operation being applied to it.
12603 Strings are not quoted for @command{expr} itself, though you may need to
12604 quote them to protect characters with special meaning to the shell,
12605 e.g., spaces. However, regardless of whether it is quoted, a string
12606 operand should not be a parenthesis or any of @command{expr}'s
12607 operators like @code{+}, so you cannot safely pass an arbitrary string
12608 @code{$str} to expr merely by quoting it to the shell. One way to
12609 work around this is to use the GNU extension @code{+},
12610 (e.g., @code{+ "$str" = foo}); a more portable way is to use
12611 @code{@w{" $str"}} and to adjust the rest of the expression to take
12612 the leading space into account (e.g., @code{@w{" $str" = " foo"}}).
12614 You should not pass a negative integer or a string with leading
12615 @samp{-} as @command{expr}'s first argument, as it might be
12616 misinterpreted as an option; this can be avoided by parenthesization.
12617 Also, portable scripts should not use a string operand that happens to
12618 take the form of an integer; this can be worked around by inserting
12619 leading spaces as mentioned above.
12621 @cindex parentheses for grouping
12622 Operators may be given as infix symbols or prefix keywords. Parentheses
12623 may be used for grouping in the usual manner. You must quote
12624 parentheses and many operators to avoid the shell evaluating them,
12627 When built with support for the GNU MP library, @command{expr} uses
12628 arbitrary-precision arithmetic; otherwise, it uses native arithmetic
12629 types and may fail due to arithmetic overflow.
12631 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12632 options}. Options must precede operands.
12634 @cindex exit status of @command{expr}
12638 0 if the expression is neither null nor 0,
12639 1 if the expression is null or 0,
12640 2 if the expression is invalid,
12641 3 if an internal error occurred (e.g., arithmetic overflow).
12645 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
12646 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
12647 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
12648 * Examples of expr:: Examples.
12652 @node String expressions
12653 @subsection String expressions
12655 @cindex string expressions
12656 @cindex expressions, string
12658 @command{expr} supports pattern matching and other string operators. These
12659 have higher precedence than both the numeric and relational operators (in
12660 the next sections).
12664 @item @var{string} : @var{regex}
12665 @cindex pattern matching
12666 @cindex regular expression matching
12667 @cindex matching patterns
12668 Perform pattern matching. The arguments are converted to strings and the
12669 second is considered to be a (basic, a la GNU @code{grep}) regular
12670 expression, with a @code{^} implicitly prepended. The first argument is
12671 then matched against this regular expression.
12673 If the match succeeds and @var{regex} uses @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the
12674 @code{:} expression returns the part of @var{string} that matched the
12675 subexpression; otherwise, it returns the number of characters matched.
12677 If the match fails, the @code{:} operator returns the null string if
12678 @samp{\(} and @samp{\)} are used in @var{regex}, otherwise 0.
12680 @kindex \( @r{regexp operator}
12681 Only the first @samp{\( @dots{} \)} pair is relevant to the return
12682 value; additional pairs are meaningful only for grouping the regular
12683 expression operators.
12685 @kindex \+ @r{regexp operator}
12686 @kindex \? @r{regexp operator}
12687 @kindex \| @r{regexp operator}
12688 In the regular expression, @code{\+}, @code{\?}, and @code{\|} are
12689 operators which respectively match one or more, zero or one, or separate
12690 alternatives. SunOS and other @command{expr}'s treat these as regular
12691 characters. (POSIX allows either behavior.)
12692 @xref{Top, , Regular Expression Library, regex, Regex}, for details of
12693 regular expression syntax. Some examples are in @ref{Examples of expr}.
12695 @item match @var{string} @var{regex}
12697 An alternative way to do pattern matching. This is the same as
12698 @w{@samp{@var{string} : @var{regex}}}.
12700 @item substr @var{string} @var{position} @var{length}
12702 Returns the substring of @var{string} beginning at @var{position}
12703 with length at most @var{length}. If either @var{position} or
12704 @var{length} is negative, zero, or non-numeric, returns the null string.
12706 @item index @var{string} @var{charset}
12708 Returns the first position in @var{string} where the first character in
12709 @var{charset} was found. If no character in @var{charset} is found in
12710 @var{string}, return 0.
12712 @item length @var{string}
12714 Returns the length of @var{string}.
12716 @item + @var{token}
12718 Interpret @var{token} as a string, even if it is a keyword like @var{match}
12719 or an operator like @code{/}.
12720 This makes it possible to test @code{expr length + "$x"} or
12721 @code{expr + "$x" : '.*/\(.\)'} and have it do the right thing even if
12722 the value of @var{$x} happens to be (for example) @code{/} or @code{index}.
12723 This operator is a GNU extension. Portable shell scripts should use
12724 @code{@w{" $token"} : @w{' \(.*\)'}} instead of @code{+ "$token"}.
12728 To make @command{expr} interpret keywords as strings, you must use the
12729 @code{quote} operator.
12732 @node Numeric expressions
12733 @subsection Numeric expressions
12735 @cindex numeric expressions
12736 @cindex expressions, numeric
12738 @command{expr} supports the usual numeric operators, in order of increasing
12739 precedence. These numeric operators have lower precedence than the
12740 string operators described in the previous section, and higher precedence
12741 than the connectives (next section).
12749 @cindex subtraction
12750 Addition and subtraction. Both arguments are converted to integers;
12751 an error occurs if this cannot be done.
12757 @cindex multiplication
12760 Multiplication, division, remainder. Both arguments are converted to
12761 integers; an error occurs if this cannot be done.
12766 @node Relations for expr
12767 @subsection Relations for @command{expr}
12769 @cindex connectives, logical
12770 @cindex logical connectives
12771 @cindex relations, numeric or string
12773 @command{expr} supports the usual logical connectives and relations. These
12774 have lower precedence than the string and numeric operators
12775 (previous sections). Here is the list, lowest-precedence operator first.
12781 @cindex logical or operator
12782 @cindex or operator
12783 Returns its first argument if that is neither null nor zero, otherwise
12784 its second argument if it is neither null nor zero, otherwise 0. It
12785 does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is neither
12790 @cindex logical and operator
12791 @cindex and operator
12792 Return its first argument if neither argument is null or zero, otherwise
12793 0. It does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is
12796 @item < <= = == != >= >
12803 @cindex comparison operators
12805 Compare the arguments and return 1 if the relation is true, 0 otherwise.
12806 @code{==} is a synonym for @code{=}. @command{expr} first tries to convert
12807 both arguments to integers and do a numeric comparison; if either
12808 conversion fails, it does a lexicographic comparison using the character
12809 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
12814 @node Examples of expr
12815 @subsection Examples of using @command{expr}
12817 @cindex examples of @command{expr}
12818 Here are a few examples, including quoting for shell metacharacters.
12820 To add 1 to the shell variable @code{foo}, in Bourne-compatible shells:
12823 foo=$(expr $foo + 1)
12826 To print the non-directory part of the file name stored in
12827 @code{$fname}, which need not contain a @code{/}:
12830 expr $fname : '.*/\(.*\)' '|' $fname
12833 An example showing that @code{\+} is an operator:
12841 expr abc : 'a\(.\)c'
12843 expr index abcdef cz
12846 @error{} expr: syntax error
12847 expr index + index a
12853 @chapter Redirection
12855 @cindex redirection
12856 @cindex commands for redirection
12858 Unix shells commonly provide several forms of @dfn{redirection}---ways
12859 to change the input source or output destination of a command. But one
12860 useful redirection is performed by a separate command, not by the shell;
12861 it's described here.
12864 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes.
12868 @node tee invocation
12869 @section @command{tee}: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
12872 @cindex pipe fitting
12873 @cindex destinations, multiple output
12874 @cindex read from stdin and write to stdout and files
12876 The @command{tee} command copies standard input to standard output and also
12877 to any files given as arguments. This is useful when you want not only
12878 to send some data down a pipe, but also to save a copy. Synopsis:
12881 tee [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
12884 If a file being written to does not already exist, it is created. If a
12885 file being written to already exists, the data it previously contained
12886 is overwritten unless the @option{-a} option is used.
12888 In previous versions of GNU coreutils (v5.3.0 - v8.23), a @var{file} of @samp{-}
12889 caused @command{tee} to send another copy of input to standard output.
12890 However, as the interleaved output was not very useful, @command{tee} now
12891 conforms to POSIX which explicitly mandates it to treat @samp{-} as a file
12894 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12901 Append standard input to the given files rather than overwriting
12905 @itemx --ignore-interrupts
12907 @opindex --ignore-interrupts
12908 Ignore interrupt signals.
12911 @itemx --output-error[=@var{mode}]
12913 @opindex --output-error
12914 Adjust the behavior with errors on the outputs,
12915 with the long form option supporting selection
12916 between the following @var{mode}s:
12920 Warn on error opening or writing any output, including pipes.
12921 Writing is continued to still open files/pipes.
12922 Exit status indicates failure if any output has an error.
12925 This is the default @var{mode} when not specified,
12926 or when the short form @option{-p} is used.
12927 Warn on error opening or writing any output, except pipes.
12928 Writing is continued to still open files/pipes.
12929 Exit status indicates failure if any non pipe output had an error.
12932 Exit on error opening or writing any output, including pipes.
12935 Exit on error opening or writing any output, except pipes.
12940 The @command{tee} command is useful when you happen to be transferring a large
12941 amount of data and also want to summarize that data without reading
12942 it a second time. For example, when you are downloading a DVD image,
12943 you often want to verify its signature or checksum right away.
12944 The inefficient way to do it is simply:
12947 wget http://example.com/some.iso && sha1sum some.iso
12950 One problem with the above is that it makes you wait for the
12951 download to complete before starting the time-consuming SHA1 computation.
12952 Perhaps even more importantly, the above requires reading
12953 the DVD image a second time (the first was from the network).
12955 The efficient way to do it is to interleave the download
12956 and SHA1 computation. Then, you'll get the checksum for
12957 free, because the entire process parallelizes so well:
12960 # slightly contrived, to demonstrate process substitution
12961 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
12962 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) > dvd.iso
12965 That makes @command{tee} write not just to the expected output file,
12966 but also to a pipe running @command{sha1sum} and saving the final
12967 checksum in a file named @file{dvd.sha1}.
12969 Note, however, that this example relies on a feature of modern shells
12970 called @dfn{process substitution}
12971 (the @samp{>(command)} syntax, above;
12972 @xref{Process Substitution,,Process Substitution, bash,
12973 The Bash Reference Manual}.),
12974 so it works with @command{zsh}, @command{bash}, and @command{ksh},
12975 but not with @command{/bin/sh}. So if you write code like this
12976 in a shell script, be sure to start the script with @samp{#!/bin/bash}.
12978 Since the above example writes to one file and one process,
12979 a more conventional and portable use of @command{tee} is even better:
12982 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
12983 | tee dvd.iso | sha1sum > dvd.sha1
12986 You can extend this example to make @command{tee} write to two processes,
12987 computing MD5 and SHA1 checksums in parallel. In this case,
12988 process substitution is required:
12991 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
12992 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) \
12993 >(md5sum > dvd.md5) \
12997 This technique is also useful when you want to make a @emph{compressed}
12998 copy of the contents of a pipe.
12999 Consider a tool to graphically summarize disk usage data from @samp{du -ak}.
13000 For a large hierarchy, @samp{du -ak} can run for a long time,
13001 and can easily produce terabytes of data, so you won't want to
13002 rerun the command unnecessarily. Nor will you want to save
13003 the uncompressed output.
13005 Doing it the inefficient way, you can't even start the GUI
13006 until after you've compressed all of the @command{du} output:
13009 du -ak | gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz
13010 gzip -d /tmp/du.gz | xdiskusage -a
13013 With @command{tee} and process substitution, you start the GUI
13014 right away and eliminate the decompression completely:
13017 du -ak | tee >(gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz) | xdiskusage -a
13020 Finally, if you regularly create more than one type of
13021 compressed tarball at once, for example when @code{make dist} creates
13022 both @command{gzip}-compressed and @command{bzip2}-compressed tarballs,
13023 there may be a better way.
13024 Typical @command{automake}-generated @file{Makefile} rules create
13025 the two compressed tar archives with commands in sequence, like this
13026 (slightly simplified):
13029 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
13030 tar chof - "$tardir" | gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz
13031 tar chof - "$tardir" | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
13034 However, if the hierarchy you are archiving and compressing is larger
13035 than a couple megabytes, and especially if you are using a multi-processor
13036 system with plenty of memory, then you can do much better by reading the
13037 directory contents only once and running the compression programs in parallel:
13040 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
13041 tar chof - "$tardir" \
13042 | tee >(gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz) \
13043 | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
13049 @node File name manipulation
13050 @chapter File name manipulation
13052 @cindex file name manipulation
13053 @cindex manipulation of file names
13054 @cindex commands for file name manipulation
13056 This section describes commands that manipulate file names.
13059 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name.
13060 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component.
13061 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability.
13062 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory.
13063 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names.
13067 @node basename invocation
13068 @section @command{basename}: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
13071 @cindex strip directory and suffix from file names
13072 @cindex directory, stripping from file names
13073 @cindex suffix, stripping from file names
13074 @cindex file names, stripping directory and suffix
13075 @cindex leading directory components, stripping
13077 @command{basename} removes any leading directory components from
13078 @var{name}. Synopsis:
13081 basename @var{name} [@var{suffix}]
13082 basename @var{option}@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
13085 If @var{suffix} is specified and is identical to the end of @var{name},
13086 it is removed from @var{name} as well. Note that since trailing slashes
13087 are removed prior to suffix matching, @var{suffix} will do nothing if it
13088 contains slashes. @command{basename} prints the result on standard
13091 @c This test is used both here and in the section on dirname.
13092 @macro basenameAndDirname
13093 Together, @command{basename} and @command{dirname} are designed such
13094 that if @samp{ls "$name"} succeeds, then the command sequence @samp{cd
13095 "$(dirname "$name")"; ls "$(basename "$name")"} will, too. This works
13096 for everything except file names containing a trailing newline.
13098 @basenameAndDirname
13100 POSIX allows the implementation to define the results if
13101 @var{name} is empty or @samp{//}. In the former case, GNU
13102 @command{basename} returns the empty string. In the latter case, the
13103 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
13104 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
13106 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13107 Options must precede operands.
13114 @opindex --multiple
13115 Support more than one argument. Treat every argument as a @var{name}.
13116 With this, an optional @var{suffix} must be specified using the
13117 @option{-s} option.
13119 @item -s @var{suffix}
13120 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
13123 Remove a trailing @var{suffix}.
13124 This option implies the @option{-a} option.
13136 basename /usr/bin/sort
13139 basename include/stdio.h .h
13142 basename -s .h include/stdio.h
13144 # Output "stdio" followed by "stdlib"
13145 basename -a -s .h include/stdio.h include/stdlib.h
13149 @node dirname invocation
13150 @section @command{dirname}: Strip last file name component
13153 @cindex directory components, printing
13154 @cindex stripping non-directory suffix
13155 @cindex non-directory suffix, stripping
13157 @command{dirname} prints all but the final slash-delimited component
13158 of each @var{name}. Slashes on either side of the final component are
13159 also removed. If the string contains no slash, @command{dirname}
13160 prints @samp{.} (meaning the current directory). Synopsis:
13163 dirname [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
13166 @var{name} need not be a file name, but if it is, this operation
13167 effectively lists the directory that contains the final component,
13168 including the case when the final component is itself a directory.
13170 @basenameAndDirname
13172 POSIX allows the implementation to define the results if
13173 @var{name} is @samp{//}. With GNU @command{dirname}, the
13174 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
13175 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
13177 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13190 # Output "/usr/bin".
13191 dirname /usr/bin/sort
13192 dirname /usr/bin//.//
13194 # Output "dir1" followed by "dir2"
13195 dirname dir1/str dir2/str
13202 @node pathchk invocation
13203 @section @command{pathchk}: Check file name validity and portability
13206 @cindex file names, checking validity and portability
13207 @cindex valid file names, checking for
13208 @cindex portable file names, checking for
13210 @command{pathchk} checks validity and portability of file names. Synopsis:
13213 pathchk [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
13216 For each @var{name}, @command{pathchk} prints an error message if any of
13217 these conditions is true:
13221 One of the existing directories in @var{name} does not have search
13222 (execute) permission,
13224 The length of @var{name} is larger than the maximum supported by the
13227 The length of one component of @var{name} is longer than
13228 its file system's maximum.
13231 A nonexistent @var{name} is not an error, so long a file with that
13232 name could be created under the above conditions.
13234 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13235 Options must precede operands.
13241 Instead of performing checks based on the underlying file system,
13242 print an error message if any of these conditions is true:
13246 A file name is empty.
13249 A file name contains a character outside the POSIX portable file
13250 name character set, namely, the ASCII letters and digits, @samp{.},
13251 @samp{_}, @samp{-}, and @samp{/}.
13254 The length of a file name or one of its components exceeds the
13255 POSIX minimum limits for portability.
13260 Print an error message if a file name is empty, or if it contains a component
13261 that begins with @samp{-}.
13263 @item --portability
13264 @opindex --portability
13265 Print an error message if a file name is not portable to all POSIX
13266 hosts. This option is equivalent to @samp{-p -P}.
13270 @cindex exit status of @command{pathchk}
13274 0 if all specified file names passed all checks,
13278 @node mktemp invocation
13279 @section @command{mktemp}: Create temporary file or directory
13282 @cindex file names, creating temporary
13283 @cindex directory, creating temporary
13284 @cindex temporary files and directories
13286 @command{mktemp} manages the creation of temporary files and
13287 directories. Synopsis:
13290 mktemp [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{template}]
13293 Safely create a temporary file or directory based on @var{template},
13294 and print its name. If given, @var{template} must include at least
13295 three consecutive @samp{X}s in the last component. If omitted, the template
13296 @samp{tmp.XXXXXXXXXX} is used, and option @option{--tmpdir} is
13297 implied. The final run of @samp{X}s in the @var{template} will be replaced
13298 by alpha-numeric characters; thus, on a case-sensitive file system,
13299 and with a @var{template} including a run of @var{n} instances of @samp{X},
13300 there are @samp{62**@var{n}} potential file names.
13302 Older scripts used to create temporary files by simply joining the
13303 name of the program with the process id (@samp{$$}) as a suffix.
13304 However, that naming scheme is easily predictable, and suffers from a
13305 race condition where the attacker can create an appropriately named
13306 symbolic link, such that when the script then opens a handle to what
13307 it thought was an unused file, it is instead modifying an existing
13308 file. Using the same scheme to create a directory is slightly safer,
13309 since the @command{mkdir} will fail if the target already exists, but
13310 it is still inferior because it allows for denial of service attacks.
13311 Therefore, modern scripts should use the @command{mktemp} command to
13312 guarantee that the generated name will be unpredictable, and that
13313 knowledge of the temporary file name implies that the file was created
13314 by the current script and cannot be modified by other users.
13316 When creating a file, the resulting file has read and write
13317 permissions for the current user, but no permissions for the group or
13318 others; these permissions are reduced if the current umask is more
13321 Here are some examples (although note that if you repeat them, you
13322 will most likely get different file names):
13327 Create a temporary file in the current directory.
13334 Create a temporary file with a known suffix.
13336 $ mktemp --suffix=.txt file-XXXX
13338 $ mktemp file-XXXX-XXXX.txt
13343 Create a secure fifo relative to the user's choice of @env{TMPDIR},
13344 but falling back to the current directory rather than @file{/tmp}.
13345 Note that @command{mktemp} does not create fifos, but can create a
13346 secure directory in which the fifo can live. Exit the shell if the
13347 directory or fifo could not be created.
13349 $ dir=$(mktemp -p "$@{TMPDIR:-.@}" -d dir-XXXX) || exit 1
13351 $ mkfifo "$fifo" || @{ rmdir "$dir"; exit 1; @}
13355 Create and use a temporary file if possible, but ignore failure. The
13356 file will reside in the directory named by @env{TMPDIR}, if specified,
13357 or else in @file{/tmp}.
13359 $ file=$(mktemp -q) && @{
13360 > # Safe to use $file only within this block. Use quotes,
13361 > # since $TMPDIR, and thus $file, may contain whitespace.
13362 > echo ... > "$file"
13368 Act as a semi-random character generator (it is not fully random,
13369 since it is impacted by the contents of the current directory). To
13370 avoid security holes, do not use the resulting names to create a file.
13380 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13387 @opindex --directory
13388 Create a directory rather than a file. The directory will have read,
13389 write, and search permissions for the current user, but no permissions
13390 for the group or others; these permissions are reduced if the current
13391 umask is more restrictive.
13397 Suppress diagnostics about failure to create a file or directory. The
13398 exit status will still reflect whether a file was created.
13404 Generate a temporary name that does not name an existing file, without
13405 changing the file system contents. Using the output of this command
13406 to create a new file is inherently unsafe, as there is a window of
13407 time between generating the name and using it where another process
13408 can create an object by the same name.
13411 @itemx --tmpdir[=@var{dir}]
13414 Treat @var{template} relative to the directory @var{dir}. If
13415 @var{dir} is not specified (only possible with the long option
13416 @option{--tmpdir}) or is the empty string, use the value of
13417 @env{TMPDIR} if available, otherwise use @samp{/tmp}. If this is
13418 specified, @var{template} must not be absolute. However,
13419 @var{template} can still contain slashes, although intermediate
13420 directories must already exist.
13422 @item --suffix=@var{suffix}
13424 Append @var{suffix} to the @var{template}. @var{suffix} must not
13425 contain slash. If @option{--suffix} is specified, @var{template} must
13426 end in @samp{X}; if it is not specified, then an appropriate
13427 @option{--suffix} is inferred by finding the last @samp{X} in
13428 @var{template}. This option exists for use with the default
13429 @var{template} and for the creation of a @var{suffix} that starts with
13434 Treat @var{template} as a single file relative to the value of
13435 @env{TMPDIR} if available, or to the directory specified by
13436 @option{-p}, otherwise to @samp{/tmp}. @var{template} must not
13437 contain slashes. This option is deprecated; the use of @option{-p}
13438 without @option{-t} offers better defaults (by favoring the command
13439 line over @env{TMPDIR}) and more flexibility (by allowing intermediate
13444 @cindex exit status of @command{mktemp}
13448 0 if the file was created,
13453 @node realpath invocation
13454 @section @command{realpath}: Print the resolved file name.
13457 @cindex file names, canonicalization
13458 @cindex symlinks, resolution
13459 @cindex canonical file name
13460 @cindex canonicalize a file name
13464 @command{realpath} expands all symbolic links and resolves references to
13465 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and extra @samp{/} characters. By default,
13466 all but the last component of the specified files must exist. Synopsis:
13469 realpath [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
13472 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13477 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
13479 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
13480 Ensure that all components of the specified file names exist.
13481 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{realpath} will output
13482 a diagnostic unless the @option{-q} option is specified, and exit with a
13483 nonzero exit code. A trailing slash requires that the name resolve to a
13487 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
13489 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
13490 If any component of a specified file name is missing or unavailable,
13491 treat it as a directory.
13497 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
13498 but they are resolved after any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
13503 @opindex --physical
13504 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
13505 and they are resolved before any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
13506 This is the default mode of operation.
13512 Suppress diagnostic messages for specified file names.
13514 @item --relative-to=@var{file}
13515 @opindex --relative-to
13517 Print the resolved file names relative to the specified file.
13518 Note this option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e} options
13519 pertaining to file existence.
13521 @item --relative-base=@var{base}
13522 @opindex --relative-base
13523 This option is valid when used with @option{--relative-to}, and will restrict
13524 the output of @option{--relative-to} so that relative names are output,
13525 only when @var{file}s are descendants of @var{base}. Otherwise output the
13526 absolute file name. If @option{--relative-to} was not specified, then
13527 the descendants of @var{base} are printed relative to @var{base}. If
13528 @option{--relative-to} is specified, then that directory must be a
13529 descendant of @var{base} for this option to have an effect.
13530 Note: this option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e}
13531 options pertaining to file existence. For example:
13534 realpath --relative-to=/usr /tmp /usr/bin
13537 realpath --relative-base=/usr /tmp /usr/bin
13544 @itemx --no-symlinks
13547 @opindex --no-symlinks
13548 Do not resolve symbolic links. Only resolve references to
13549 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and remove extra @samp{/} characters.
13550 When combined with the @option{-m} option, realpath operates
13551 only on the file name, and does not touch any actual file.
13557 @cindex exit status of @command{realpath}
13561 0 if all file names were printed without issue.
13566 @node Working context
13567 @chapter Working context
13569 @cindex working context
13570 @cindex commands for printing the working context
13572 This section describes commands that display or alter the context in
13573 which you are working: the current directory, the terminal settings, and
13574 so forth. See also the user-related commands in the next section.
13577 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory.
13578 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics.
13579 * printenv invocation:: Print environment variables.
13580 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input.
13584 @node pwd invocation
13585 @section @command{pwd}: Print working directory
13588 @cindex print name of current directory
13589 @cindex current working directory, printing
13590 @cindex working directory, printing
13593 @command{pwd} prints the name of the current directory. Synopsis:
13596 pwd [@var{option}]@dots{}
13599 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13606 If the contents of the environment variable @env{PWD} provide an
13607 absolute name of the current directory with no @samp{.} or @samp{..}
13608 components, but possibly with symbolic links, then output those
13609 contents. Otherwise, fall back to default @option{-P} handling.
13614 @opindex --physical
13615 Print a fully resolved name for the current directory. That is, all
13616 components of the printed name will be actual directory names---none
13617 will be symbolic links.
13620 @cindex symbolic links and @command{pwd}
13621 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
13622 precedence. If neither option is given, then this implementation uses
13623 @option{-P} as the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
13624 environment variable is set.
13626 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{pwd}
13631 @node stty invocation
13632 @section @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
13635 @cindex change or print terminal settings
13636 @cindex terminal settings
13637 @cindex line settings of terminal
13639 @command{stty} prints or changes terminal characteristics, such as baud rate.
13643 stty [@var{option}] [@var{setting}]@dots{}
13644 stty [@var{option}]
13647 If given no line settings, @command{stty} prints the baud rate, line
13648 discipline number (on systems that support it), and line settings
13649 that have been changed from the values set by @samp{stty sane}.
13650 By default, mode reading and setting are performed on the tty line
13651 connected to standard input, although this can be modified by the
13652 @option{--file} option.
13654 @command{stty} accepts many non-option arguments that change aspects of
13655 the terminal line operation, as described below.
13657 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13664 Print all current settings in human-readable form. This option may not
13665 be used in combination with any line settings.
13667 @item -F @var{device}
13668 @itemx --file=@var{device}
13671 Set the line opened by the file name specified in @var{device} instead of
13672 the tty line connected to standard input. This option is necessary
13673 because opening a POSIX tty requires use of the
13674 @code{O_NONDELAY} flag to prevent a POSIX tty from blocking
13675 until the carrier detect line is high if
13676 the @code{clocal} flag is not set. Hence, it is not always possible
13677 to allow the shell to open the device in the traditional manner.
13683 @cindex machine-readable @command{stty} output
13684 Print all current settings in a form that can be used as an argument to
13685 another @command{stty} command to restore the current settings. This option
13686 may not be used in combination with any line settings.
13690 Many settings can be turned off by preceding them with a @samp{-}.
13691 Such arguments are marked below with ``May be negated'' in their
13692 description. The descriptions themselves refer to the positive
13693 case, that is, when @emph{not} negated (unless stated otherwise,
13696 Some settings are not available on all POSIX systems, since they use
13697 extensions. Such arguments are marked below with
13698 ``Non-POSIX'' in their description. On non-POSIX
13699 systems, those or other settings also may not
13700 be available, but it's not feasible to document all the variations: just
13703 @command{stty} is installed only on platforms with the POSIX terminal
13704 interface, so portable scripts should not rely on its existence on
13705 non-POSIX platforms.
13710 * Control:: Control settings
13711 * Input:: Input settings
13712 * Output:: Output settings
13713 * Local:: Local settings
13714 * Combination:: Combination settings
13715 * Characters:: Special characters
13716 * Special:: Special settings
13721 @subsection Control settings
13723 @cindex control settings
13729 @cindex two-way parity
13730 Generate parity bit in output and expect parity bit in input.
13736 @cindex even parity
13737 Set odd parity (even if negated). May be negated.
13741 @cindex constant parity
13742 @cindex stick parity
13743 @cindex mark parity
13744 @cindex space parity
13745 Use "stick" (mark/space) parity. If parodd is set, the parity bit is
13746 always 1; if parodd is not set, the parity bit is always zero.
13747 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13754 @cindex character size
13755 @cindex eight-bit characters
13756 Set character size to 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits.
13761 Send a hangup signal when the last process closes the tty. May be
13767 Use two stop bits per character (one if negated). May be negated.
13771 Allow input to be received. May be negated.
13775 @cindex modem control
13776 Disable modem control signals. May be negated.
13780 @cindex hardware flow control
13781 @cindex flow control, hardware
13782 @cindex RTS/CTS flow control
13783 Enable RTS/CTS flow control. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13787 @cindex hardware flow control
13788 @cindex flow control, hardware
13789 @cindex DTR/DSR flow control
13790 Enable DTR/DSR flow control. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13795 @subsection Input settings
13797 @cindex input settings
13798 These settings control operations on data received from the terminal.
13803 @cindex breaks, ignoring
13804 Ignore break characters. May be negated.
13808 @cindex breaks, cause interrupts
13809 Make breaks cause an interrupt signal. May be negated.
13813 @cindex parity, ignoring
13814 Ignore characters with parity errors. May be negated.
13818 @cindex parity errors, marking
13819 Mark parity errors (with a 255-0-character sequence). May be negated.
13823 Enable input parity checking. May be negated.
13827 @cindex eight-bit input
13828 Clear high (8th) bit of input characters. May be negated.
13832 @cindex newline, translating to return
13833 Translate newline to carriage return. May be negated.
13837 @cindex return, ignoring
13838 Ignore carriage return. May be negated.
13842 @cindex return, translating to newline
13843 Translate carriage return to newline. May be negated.
13847 @cindex input encoding, UTF-8
13848 Assume input characters are UTF-8 encoded. May be negated.
13852 @kindex C-s/C-q flow control
13853 @cindex XON/XOFF flow control
13854 Enable XON/XOFF flow control (that is, @kbd{Ctrl-S}/@kbd{Ctrl-Q}). May
13861 @cindex software flow control
13862 @cindex flow control, software
13863 Enable sending of @code{stop} character when the system input buffer
13864 is almost full, and @code{start} character when it becomes almost
13865 empty again. May be negated.
13869 @cindex uppercase, translating to lowercase
13870 Translate uppercase characters to lowercase. Non-POSIX@. May be
13871 negated. Note ilcuc is not implemented, as one would not be able to issue
13872 almost any (lowercase) Unix command, after invoking it.
13876 Allow any character to restart output (only the start character
13877 if negated). Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13881 @cindex beeping at input buffer full
13882 Enable beeping and not flushing input buffer if a character arrives
13883 when the input buffer is full. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13888 @subsection Output settings
13890 @cindex output settings
13891 These settings control operations on data sent to the terminal.
13896 Postprocess output. May be negated.
13900 @cindex lowercase, translating to output
13901 Translate lowercase characters to uppercase. Non-POSIX@. May be
13902 negated. (Note ouclc is not currently implemented.)
13906 @cindex return, translating to newline
13907 Translate carriage return to newline. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13911 @cindex newline, translating to crlf
13912 Translate newline to carriage return-newline. Non-POSIX@. May be
13917 Do not print carriage returns in the first column. Non-POSIX@.
13922 Newline performs a carriage return. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13926 @cindex pad instead of timing for delaying
13927 Use fill (padding) characters instead of timing for delays.
13933 @cindex pad character
13934 Use ASCII DEL characters for fill instead of
13935 ASCII NUL characters. Non-POSIX@.
13941 Newline delay style. Non-POSIX.
13948 Carriage return delay style. Non-POSIX.
13954 @opindex tab@var{n}
13955 Horizontal tab delay style. Non-POSIX.
13960 Backspace delay style. Non-POSIX.
13965 Vertical tab delay style. Non-POSIX.
13970 Form feed delay style. Non-POSIX.
13975 @subsection Local settings
13977 @cindex local settings
13982 Enable @code{interrupt}, @code{quit}, and @code{suspend} special
13983 characters. May be negated.
13987 Enable @code{erase}, @code{kill}, @code{werase}, and @code{rprnt}
13988 special characters. May be negated.
13992 Enable non-POSIX special characters. May be negated.
13996 Echo input characters. May be negated.
14002 Echo @code{erase} characters as backspace-space-backspace. May be
14007 @cindex newline echoing after @code{kill}
14008 Echo a newline after a @code{kill} character. May be negated.
14012 @cindex newline, echoing
14013 Echo newline even if not echoing other characters. May be negated.
14017 @cindex flushing, disabling
14018 Disable flushing after @code{interrupt} and @code{quit} special
14019 characters. May be negated.
14023 @cindex case translation
14024 Enable input and output of uppercase characters by preceding their
14025 lowercase equivalents with @samp{\}, when @code{icanon} is set.
14026 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14030 @cindex background jobs, stopping at terminal write
14031 Stop background jobs that try to write to the terminal. Non-POSIX@.
14038 Echo erased characters backward, between @samp{\} and @samp{/}.
14039 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14045 @cindex control characters, using @samp{^@var{c}}
14046 @cindex hat notation for control characters
14047 Echo control characters in hat notation (@samp{^@var{c}}) instead
14048 of literally. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14054 Echo the @code{kill} special character by erasing each character on
14055 the line as indicated by the @code{echoprt} and @code{echoe} settings,
14056 instead of by the @code{echoctl} and @code{echok} settings.
14062 Enable @samp{LINEMODE}, which is used to avoid echoing
14063 each character over high latency links. See also
14064 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc1116.txt, Internet RFC 1116}.
14071 @subsection Combination settings
14073 @cindex combination settings
14074 Combination settings:
14081 Same as @code{parenb -parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
14082 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
14086 Same as @code{parenb parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
14087 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
14091 Same as @code{-icrnl -onlcr}. May be negated. If negated, same as
14092 @code{icrnl -inlcr -igncr onlcr -ocrnl -onlret}.
14096 Reset the @code{erase} and @code{kill} special characters to their default
14103 @c This is too long to write inline.
14105 cread -ignbrk brkint -inlcr -igncr icrnl
14106 icanon iexten echo echoe echok -echonl -noflsh
14107 -ixoff -iutf8 -iuclc -ixany imaxbel -xcase -olcuc -ocrnl
14108 opost -ofill onlcr -onocr -onlret nl0 cr0 tab0 bs0 vt0 ff0
14109 isig -tostop -ofdel -echoprt echoctl echoke -extproc
14113 and also sets all special characters to their default values.
14117 Same as @code{brkint ignpar istrip icrnl ixon opost isig icanon}, plus
14118 sets the @code{eof} and @code{eol} characters to their default values
14119 if they are the same as the @code{min} and @code{time} characters.
14120 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{raw}.
14127 -ignbrk -brkint -ignpar -parmrk -inpck -istrip
14128 -inlcr -igncr -icrnl -ixon -ixoff -icanon -opost
14129 -isig -iuclc -ixany -imaxbel -xcase min 1 time 0
14133 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{cooked}.
14137 Same as @option{-icanon}. May be negated. If negated, same as
14142 @cindex eight-bit characters
14143 Same as @code{-parenb -istrip cs8}. May be negated. If negated,
14144 same as @code{parenb istrip cs7}.
14148 Same as @option{-parenb -istrip -opost cs8}. May be negated.
14149 If negated, same as @code{parenb istrip opost cs7}.
14153 Same as @option{-ixany}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14157 Same as @code{tab0}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated. If negated, same
14164 Same as @code{xcase iuclc olcuc}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14165 (Used for terminals with uppercase characters only.)
14169 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke}.
14173 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke -ixany intr ^C erase ^? kill C-u}.
14178 @subsection Special characters
14180 @cindex special characters
14181 @cindex characters, special
14183 The special characters' default values vary from system to system.
14184 They are set with the syntax @samp{name value}, where the names are
14185 listed below and the value can be given either literally, in hat
14186 notation (@samp{^@var{c}}), or as an integer which may start with
14187 @samp{0x} to indicate hexadecimal, @samp{0} to indicate octal, or
14188 any other digit to indicate decimal.
14190 @cindex disabling special characters
14191 @kindex u@r{, and disabling special characters}
14192 For GNU stty, giving a value of @code{^-} or @code{undef} disables that
14193 special character. (This is incompatible with Ultrix @command{stty},
14194 which uses a value of @samp{u} to disable a special character. GNU
14195 @command{stty} treats a value @samp{u} like any other, namely to set that
14196 special character to @key{U}.)
14202 Send an interrupt signal.
14206 Send a quit signal.
14210 Erase the last character typed.
14214 Erase the current line.
14218 Send an end of file (terminate the input).
14226 Alternate character to end the line. Non-POSIX.
14231 Alternate character to toggle discarding of output. Non-POSIX.
14235 Switch to a different shell layer. Non-POSIX.
14239 Send an info signal. Not currently supported on Linux. Non-POSIX.
14243 Restart the output after stopping it.
14251 Send a terminal stop signal.
14255 Send a terminal stop signal after flushing the input. Non-POSIX.
14259 Redraw the current line. Non-POSIX.
14263 Erase the last word typed. Non-POSIX.
14267 Enter the next character typed literally, even if it is a special
14268 character. Non-POSIX.
14273 @subsection Special settings
14275 @cindex special settings
14280 Set the minimum number of characters that will satisfy a read until
14281 the time value has expired, when @option{-icanon} is set.
14285 Set the number of tenths of a second before reads time out if the minimum
14286 number of characters have not been read, when @option{-icanon} is set.
14288 @item ispeed @var{n}
14290 Set the input speed to @var{n}.
14292 @item ospeed @var{n}
14294 Set the output speed to @var{n}.
14298 Tell the tty kernel driver that the terminal has @var{n} rows.
14302 @itemx columns @var{n}
14305 Tell the kernel that the terminal has @var{n} columns. Non-POSIX.
14311 Print the number of rows and columns that the kernel thinks the
14312 terminal has. (Systems that don't support rows and columns in the kernel
14313 typically use the environment variables @env{LINES} and @env{COLUMNS}
14314 instead; however, GNU @command{stty} does not know anything about them.)
14319 Use line discipline @var{n}. Non-POSIX.
14323 Print the terminal speed.
14326 @cindex baud rate, setting
14327 Set the input and output speeds to @var{n}. @var{n} can be one of: 0
14328 50 75 110 134 134.5 150 200 300 600 1200 1800 2400 4800 9600 19200
14329 38400 @code{exta} @code{extb}. @code{exta} is the same as 19200;
14330 @code{extb} is the same as 38400. Many systems, including GNU/Linux,
14331 support higher speeds. The @command{stty} command includes support
14348 4000000 where the system supports these.
14349 0 hangs up the line if @option{-clocal} is set.
14353 @node printenv invocation
14354 @section @command{printenv}: Print all or some environment variables
14357 @cindex printing all or some environment variables
14358 @cindex environment variables, printing
14360 @command{printenv} prints environment variable values. Synopsis:
14363 printenv [@var{option}] [@var{variable}]@dots{}
14366 If no @var{variable}s are specified, @command{printenv} prints the value of
14367 every environment variable. Otherwise, it prints the value of each
14368 @var{variable} that is set, and nothing for those that are not set.
14370 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14378 @cindex exit status of @command{printenv}
14382 0 if all variables specified were found
14383 1 if at least one specified variable was not found
14384 2 if a write error occurred
14388 @node tty invocation
14389 @section @command{tty}: Print file name of terminal on standard input
14392 @cindex print terminal file name
14393 @cindex terminal file name, printing
14395 @command{tty} prints the file name of the terminal connected to its standard
14396 input. It prints @samp{not a tty} if standard input is not a terminal.
14400 tty [@var{option}]@dots{}
14403 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14413 Print nothing; only return an exit status.
14417 @cindex exit status of @command{tty}
14421 0 if standard input is a terminal
14422 1 if standard input is not a terminal
14423 2 if given incorrect arguments
14424 3 if a write error occurs
14428 @node User information
14429 @chapter User information
14431 @cindex user information, commands for
14432 @cindex commands for printing user information
14434 This section describes commands that print user-related information:
14435 logins, groups, and so forth.
14438 * id invocation:: Print user identity.
14439 * logname invocation:: Print current login name.
14440 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID.
14441 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in.
14442 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in.
14443 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in.
14447 @node id invocation
14448 @section @command{id}: Print user identity
14451 @cindex real user and group IDs, printing
14452 @cindex effective user and group IDs, printing
14453 @cindex printing real and effective user and group IDs
14455 @command{id} prints information about the given user, or the process
14456 running it if no user is specified. Synopsis:
14459 id [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{user}]
14462 @var{user} can be either a user ID or a name, with name look-up
14463 taking precedence unless the ID is specified with a leading @samp{+}.
14464 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
14466 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
14467 By default, it prints the real user ID, real group ID, effective user ID
14468 if different from the real user ID, effective group ID if different from
14469 the real group ID, and supplemental group IDs.
14470 In addition, if SELinux
14471 is enabled and the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is not set,
14472 then print @samp{context=@var{c}}, where @var{c} is the security context.
14474 Each of these numeric values is preceded by an identifying string and
14475 followed by the corresponding user or group name in parentheses.
14477 The options cause @command{id} to print only part of the above information.
14478 Also see @ref{Common options}.
14485 Print only the group ID.
14491 Print only the group ID and the supplementary groups.
14497 Print the user or group name instead of the ID number. Requires
14498 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
14504 Print the real, instead of effective, user or group ID@. Requires
14505 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
14511 Print only the user ID.
14518 @cindex security context
14519 Print only the security context of the process, which is generally
14520 the user's security context inherited from the parent process.
14521 If neither SELinux or SMACK is enabled then print a warning and
14522 set the exit status to 1.
14528 Delimit output items with NUL characters.
14529 This option is not permitted when using the default format.
14534 users <NUL> devs <NUL>
14539 @macro primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{cmd,arg}
14540 Primary and supplementary groups for a process are normally inherited
14541 from its parent and are usually unchanged since login. This means
14542 that if you change the group database after logging in, @command{\cmd\}
14543 will not reflect your changes within your existing login session.
14544 Running @command{\cmd\} with a \arg\ causes the user and group
14545 database to be consulted afresh, and so will give a different result.
14547 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{id,user argument}
14551 @node logname invocation
14552 @section @command{logname}: Print current login name
14555 @cindex printing user's login name
14556 @cindex login name, printing
14557 @cindex user name, printing
14560 @command{logname} prints the calling user's name, as found in a
14561 system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
14562 @file{/etc/utmp}), and exits with a status of 0. If there is no entry
14563 for the calling process, @command{logname} prints
14564 an error message and exits with a status of 1.
14566 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14572 @node whoami invocation
14573 @section @command{whoami}: Print effective user ID
14576 @cindex effective user ID, printing
14577 @cindex printing the effective user ID
14579 @command{whoami} prints the user name associated with the current
14580 effective user ID@. It is equivalent to the command @samp{id -un}.
14582 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14588 @node groups invocation
14589 @section @command{groups}: Print group names a user is in
14592 @cindex printing groups a user is in
14593 @cindex supplementary groups, printing
14595 @command{groups} prints the names of the primary and any supplementary
14596 groups for each given @var{username}, or the current process if no names
14597 are given. If more than one name is given, the name of each user is
14599 the list of that user's groups and the user name is separated from the
14600 group list by a colon. Synopsis:
14603 groups [@var{username}]@dots{}
14606 The group lists are equivalent to the output of the command @samp{id -Gn}.
14608 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14611 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{groups,list of users}
14615 @node users invocation
14616 @section @command{users}: Print login names of users currently logged in
14619 @cindex printing current usernames
14620 @cindex usernames, printing current
14622 @cindex login sessions, printing users with
14623 @command{users} prints on a single line a blank-separated list of user
14624 names of users currently logged in to the current host. Each user name
14625 corresponds to a login session, so if a user has more than one login
14626 session, that user's name will appear the same number of times in the
14635 With no @var{file} argument, @command{users} extracts its information from
14636 a system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
14637 @file{/etc/utmp}). If a file argument is given, @command{users} uses
14638 that file instead. A common choice is @file{/var/log/wtmp}.
14640 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14643 The @command{users} command is installed only on platforms with the
14644 POSIX @code{<utmpx.h>} include file or equivalent, so portable scripts
14645 should not rely on its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
14650 @node who invocation
14651 @section @command{who}: Print who is currently logged in
14654 @cindex printing current user information
14655 @cindex information, about current users
14657 @command{who} prints information about users who are currently logged on.
14661 @command{who} [@var{option}] [@var{file}] [am i]
14664 @cindex terminal lines, currently used
14666 @cindex remote hostname
14667 If given no non-option arguments, @command{who} prints the following
14668 information for each user currently logged on: login name, terminal
14669 line, login time, and remote hostname or X display.
14673 If given one non-option argument, @command{who} uses that instead of
14674 a default system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
14675 @file{/etc/utmp}) as the name of the file containing the record of
14676 users logged on. @file{/var/log/wtmp} is commonly given as an argument
14677 to @command{who} to look at who has previously logged on.
14681 If given two non-option arguments, @command{who} prints only the entry
14682 for the user running it (determined from its standard input), preceded
14683 by the hostname. Traditionally, the two arguments given are @samp{am
14684 i}, as in @samp{who am i}.
14687 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
14688 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
14689 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
14690 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
14692 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14700 Same as @samp{-b -d --login -p -r -t -T -u}.
14706 Print the date and time of last system boot.
14712 Print information corresponding to dead processes.
14718 Print a line of column headings.
14724 List only the entries that correspond to processes via which the
14725 system is waiting for a user to login. The user name is always @samp{LOGIN}.
14729 Attempt to canonicalize hostnames found in utmp through a DNS lookup. This
14730 is not the default because it can cause significant delays on systems with
14731 automatic dial-up internet access.
14735 Same as @samp{who am i}.
14741 List active processes spawned by init.
14747 Print only the login names and the number of users logged on.
14748 Overrides all other options.
14753 @opindex --runlevel
14754 Print the current (and maybe previous) run-level of the init process.
14758 Ignored; for compatibility with other versions of @command{who}.
14764 Print last system clock change.
14769 After the login time, print the number of hours and minutes that the
14770 user has been idle. @samp{.} means the user was active in the last minute.
14771 @samp{old} means the user has been idle for more than 24 hours.
14782 @opindex --writable
14783 @cindex message status
14784 @pindex write@r{, allowed}
14785 After each login name print a character indicating the user's message status:
14788 @samp{+} allowing @code{write} messages
14789 @samp{-} disallowing @code{write} messages
14790 @samp{?} cannot find terminal device
14795 The @command{who} command is installed only on platforms with the
14796 POSIX @code{<utmpx.h>} include file or equivalent, so portable scripts
14797 should not rely on its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
14802 @node System context
14803 @chapter System context
14805 @cindex system context
14806 @cindex context, system
14807 @cindex commands for system context
14809 This section describes commands that print or change system-wide
14813 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time.
14814 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name.
14815 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors.
14816 * uname invocation:: Print system information.
14817 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name.
14818 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
14819 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load.
14822 @node date invocation
14823 @section @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
14826 @cindex time, printing or setting
14827 @cindex printing the current time
14832 date [@var{option}]@dots{} [+@var{format}]
14833 date [-u|--utc|--universal] @c this avoids a newline in the output
14834 [ MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss] ]
14838 Invoking @command{date} with no @var{format} argument is equivalent to invoking
14839 it with a default format that depends on the @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
14840 In the default C locale, this format is @samp{'+%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'},
14841 so the output looks like @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 13:47:51 PST 2005}.
14844 Normally, @command{date} uses the time zone rules indicated by the
14845 @env{TZ} environment variable, or the system default rules if @env{TZ}
14846 is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with
14847 @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
14849 @findex strftime @r{and @command{date}}
14850 @cindex time formats
14851 @cindex formatting times
14852 If given an argument that starts with a @samp{+}, @command{date} prints the
14853 current date and time (or the date and time specified by the
14854 @option{--date} option, see below) in the format defined by that argument,
14855 which is similar to that of the @code{strftime} function. Except for
14856 conversion specifiers, which start with @samp{%}, characters in the
14857 format string are printed unchanged. The conversion specifiers are
14863 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
14864 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
14865 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
14866 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
14867 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
14868 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
14870 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
14872 * Examples of date:: Examples.
14875 @node Time conversion specifiers
14876 @subsection Time conversion specifiers
14878 @cindex time conversion specifiers
14879 @cindex conversion specifiers, time
14881 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to times.
14885 hour (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{23})
14887 hour (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
14889 hour, space padded (@samp{ 0}@dots{}@samp{23}); equivalent to @samp{%_H}@.
14890 This is a GNU extension.
14892 hour, space padded (@samp{ 1}@dots{}@samp{12}); equivalent to @samp{%_I}@.
14893 This is a GNU extension.
14895 minute (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{59})
14897 nanoseconds (@samp{000000000}@dots{}@samp{999999999}).
14898 This is a GNU extension.
14900 locale's equivalent of either @samp{AM} or @samp{PM};
14901 blank in many locales.
14902 Noon is treated as @samp{PM} and midnight as @samp{AM}.
14904 like @samp{%p}, except lower case.
14905 This is a GNU extension.
14907 locale's 12-hour clock time (e.g., @samp{11:11:04 PM})
14909 24-hour hour and minute. Same as @samp{%H:%M}.
14911 @cindex epoch, seconds since
14912 @cindex seconds since the epoch
14913 @cindex beginning of time
14914 @cindex leap seconds
14915 seconds since the epoch, i.e., since 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC@.
14916 Leap seconds are not counted unless leap second support is available.
14917 @xref{%s-examples}, for examples.
14918 This is a GNU extension.
14920 @cindex leap seconds
14921 second (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{60}).
14922 This may be @samp{60} if leap seconds are supported.
14924 24-hour hour, minute, and second. Same as @samp{%H:%M:%S}.
14926 locale's time representation (e.g., @samp{23:13:48})
14928 @w{RFC 2822/ISO 8601} style numeric time zone
14929 (e.g., @samp{-0600} or @samp{+0530}), or nothing if no
14930 time zone is determinable. This value reflects the numeric time zone
14931 appropriate for the current time, using the time zone rules specified
14932 by the @env{TZ} environment variable.
14933 The time (and optionally, the time zone rules) can be overridden
14934 by the @option{--date} option.
14936 @w{RFC 3339/ISO 8601} style numeric time zone with
14937 @samp{:} (e.g., @samp{-06:00} or @samp{+05:30}), or nothing if no time
14938 zone is determinable.
14939 This is a GNU extension.
14941 Numeric time zone to the nearest second with @samp{:} (e.g.,
14942 @samp{-06:00:00} or @samp{+05:30:00}), or nothing if no time zone is
14944 This is a GNU extension.
14946 Numeric time zone with @samp{:} using the minimum necessary precision
14947 (e.g., @samp{-06}, @samp{+05:30}, or @samp{-04:56:02}), or nothing if
14948 no time zone is determinable.
14949 This is a GNU extension.
14951 alphabetic time zone abbreviation (e.g., @samp{EDT}), or nothing if no
14952 time zone is determinable. See @samp{%z} for how it is determined.
14956 @node Date conversion specifiers
14957 @subsection Date conversion specifiers
14959 @cindex date conversion specifiers
14960 @cindex conversion specifiers, date
14962 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to dates.
14966 locale's abbreviated weekday name (e.g., @samp{Sun})
14968 locale's full weekday name, variable length (e.g., @samp{Sunday})
14970 locale's abbreviated month name (e.g., @samp{Jan})
14972 locale's full month name, variable length (e.g., @samp{January})
14974 locale's date and time (e.g., @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 23:05:25 2005})
14976 century. This is like @samp{%Y}, except the last two digits are omitted.
14977 For example, it is @samp{20} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{2000},
14978 and is @samp{-0} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{-001}.
14979 It is normally at least two characters, but it may be more.
14981 day of month (e.g., @samp{01})
14983 date; same as @samp{%m/%d/%y}
14985 day of month, space padded; same as @samp{%_d}
14987 full date in ISO 8601 format; same as @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
14988 This is a good choice for a date format, as it is standard and
14989 is easy to sort in the usual case where years are in the range
14992 year corresponding to the ISO week number, but without the century
14993 (range @samp{00} through @samp{99}). This has the same format and value
14994 as @samp{%y}, except that if the ISO week number (see
14996 to the previous or next year, that year is used instead.
14998 year corresponding to the ISO week number. This has the
14999 same format and value as @samp{%Y}, except that if the ISO
15001 @samp{%V}) belongs to the previous or next year, that year is used
15003 It is normally useful only if @samp{%V} is also used;
15004 for example, the format @samp{%G-%m-%d} is probably a mistake,
15005 since it combines the ISO week number year with the conventional month and day.
15009 day of year (@samp{001}@dots{}@samp{366})
15011 month (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
15013 day of week (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{7}) with @samp{1} corresponding to Monday
15015 week number of year, with Sunday as the first day of the week
15016 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
15017 Days in a new year preceding the first Sunday are in week zero.
15019 ISO week number, that is, the
15020 week number of year, with Monday as the first day of the week
15021 (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{53}).
15022 If the week containing January 1 has four or more days in
15023 the new year, then it is considered week 1; otherwise, it is week 53 of
15024 the previous year, and the next week is week 1. (See the ISO 8601
15027 day of week (@samp{0}@dots{}@samp{6}) with 0 corresponding to Sunday
15029 week number of year, with Monday as first day of week
15030 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
15031 Days in a new year preceding the first Monday are in week zero.
15033 locale's date representation (e.g., @samp{12/31/99})
15035 last two digits of year (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{99})
15037 year. This is normally at least four characters, but it may be more.
15038 Year @samp{0000} precedes year @samp{0001}, and year @samp{-001}
15039 precedes year @samp{0000}.
15043 @node Literal conversion specifiers
15044 @subsection Literal conversion specifiers
15046 @cindex literal conversion specifiers
15047 @cindex conversion specifiers, literal
15049 @command{date} conversion specifiers that produce literal strings.
15061 @node Padding and other flags
15062 @subsection Padding and other flags
15064 @cindex numeric field padding
15065 @cindex padding of numeric fields
15066 @cindex fields, padding numeric
15068 Unless otherwise specified, @command{date} normally pads numeric fields
15069 with zeros, so that, for
15070 example, numeric months are always output as two digits.
15071 Seconds since the epoch are not padded, though,
15072 since there is no natural width for them.
15074 As a GNU extension, @command{date} recognizes any of the
15075 following optional flags after the @samp{%}:
15079 (hyphen) Do not pad the field; useful if the output is intended for
15082 (underscore) Pad with spaces; useful if you need a fixed
15083 number of characters in the output, but zeros are too distracting.
15085 (zero) Pad with zeros even if the conversion specifier
15086 would normally pad with spaces.
15088 Use upper case characters if possible.
15090 Use opposite case characters if possible.
15091 A field that is normally upper case becomes lower case, and vice versa.
15095 Here are some examples of padding:
15098 date +%d/%m -d "Feb 1"
15100 date +%-d/%-m -d "Feb 1"
15102 date +%_d/%_m -d "Feb 1"
15106 As a GNU extension, you can specify the field width
15107 (after any flag, if present) as a decimal number. If the natural size of the
15108 output of the field has less than the specified number of characters,
15109 the result is written right adjusted and padded to the given
15110 size. For example, @samp{%9B} prints the right adjusted month name in
15111 a field of width 9.
15113 An optional modifier can follow the optional flag and width
15114 specification. The modifiers are:
15118 Use the locale's alternate representation for date and time. This
15119 modifier applies to the @samp{%c}, @samp{%C}, @samp{%x}, @samp{%X},
15120 @samp{%y} and @samp{%Y} conversion specifiers. In a Japanese locale, for
15121 example, @samp{%Ex} might yield a date format based on the Japanese
15125 Use the locale's alternate numeric symbols for numbers. This modifier
15126 applies only to numeric conversion specifiers.
15129 If the format supports the modifier but no alternate representation
15130 is available, it is ignored.
15133 @node Setting the time
15134 @subsection Setting the time
15136 @cindex setting the time
15137 @cindex time setting
15138 @cindex appropriate privileges
15140 If given an argument that does not start with @samp{+}, @command{date} sets
15141 the system clock to the date and time specified by that argument (as
15142 described below). You must have appropriate privileges to set the
15143 system clock. Note for changes to persist across a reboot, the
15144 hardware clock may need to be updated from the system clock, which
15145 might not happen automatically on your system.
15147 The argument must consist entirely of digits, which have the following
15160 first two digits of year (optional)
15162 last two digits of year (optional)
15167 Note, the @option{--date} and @option{--set} options may not be used with an
15168 argument in the above format. The @option{--universal} option may be used
15169 with such an argument to indicate that the specified date and time are
15170 relative to Coordinated Universal Time rather than to the local time zone.
15173 @node Options for date
15174 @subsection Options for @command{date}
15176 @cindex @command{date} options
15177 @cindex options for @command{date}
15179 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15183 @item -d @var{datestr}
15184 @itemx --date=@var{datestr}
15187 @cindex parsing date strings
15188 @cindex date strings, parsing
15189 @cindex arbitrary date strings, parsing
15192 @opindex next @var{day}
15193 @opindex last @var{day}
15194 Display the date and time specified in @var{datestr} instead of the
15195 current date and time. @var{datestr} can be in almost any common
15196 format. It can contain month names, time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm},
15197 @samp{yesterday}, etc. For example, @option{--date="2004-02-27
15198 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"} specifies the instant of time that is
15199 489,392,193 nanoseconds after February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a
15200 time zone that is 5 hours and 30 minutes east of UTC.@*
15201 Note: input currently must be in locale independent format. E.g., the
15202 LC_TIME=C below is needed to print back the correct date in many locales:
15204 date -d "$(LC_TIME=C date)"
15206 @xref{Date input formats}.
15208 @item -f @var{datefile}
15209 @itemx --file=@var{datefile}
15212 Parse each line in @var{datefile} as with @option{-d} and display the
15213 resulting date and time. If @var{datefile} is @samp{-}, use standard
15214 input. This is useful when you have many dates to process, because the
15215 system overhead of starting up the @command{date} executable many times can
15218 @item -I[@var{timespec}]
15219 @itemx --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
15220 @opindex -I[@var{timespec}]
15221 @opindex --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
15222 Display the date using the ISO 8601 format, @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
15224 The argument @var{timespec} specifies the number of additional
15225 terms of the time to include. It can be one of the following:
15228 Print just the date. This is the default if @var{timespec} is omitted.
15231 Append the hour of the day to the date.
15234 Append the hours and minutes.
15237 Append the hours, minutes and seconds.
15240 Append the hours, minutes, seconds and nanoseconds.
15243 If showing any time terms, then include the time zone using the format
15246 @item -r @var{file}
15247 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
15249 @opindex --reference
15250 Display the date and time of the last modification of @var{file},
15251 instead of the current date and time.
15258 @opindex --rfc-2822
15259 Display the date and time using the format @samp{%a, %d %b %Y %H:%M:%S
15260 %z}, evaluated in the C locale so abbreviations are always in English.
15264 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
15267 This format conforms to
15268 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc2822.txt, Internet
15270 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc822.txt, 822}, the
15271 current and previous standards for Internet email.
15273 @item --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
15274 @opindex --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
15275 Display the date using a format specified by
15276 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc3339.txt, Internet
15277 RFC 3339}. This is a subset of the ISO 8601
15278 format, except that it also permits applications to use a space rather
15279 than a @samp{T} to separate dates from times. Unlike the other
15280 standard formats, RFC 3339 format is always suitable as
15281 input for the @option{--date} (@option{-d}) and @option{--file}
15282 (@option{-f}) options, regardless of the current locale.
15284 The argument @var{timespec} specifies how much of the time to include.
15285 It can be one of the following:
15289 Print just the full-date, e.g., @samp{2005-09-14}.
15290 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
15293 Print the full-date and full-time separated by a space, e.g.,
15294 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06+05:30}. The output ends with a numeric
15295 time-offset; here the @samp{+05:30} means that local time is five
15296 hours and thirty minutes east of UTC@. This is equivalent to
15297 the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S%:z}.
15300 Like @samp{seconds}, but also print nanoseconds, e.g.,
15301 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06.998458565+05:30}.
15302 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N%:z}.
15306 @item -s @var{datestr}
15307 @itemx --set=@var{datestr}
15310 Set the date and time to @var{datestr}. See @option{-d} above.
15311 See also @ref{Setting the time}.
15318 @opindex --universal
15319 @cindex Coordinated Universal Time
15321 @cindex Greenwich Mean Time
15323 @cindex leap seconds
15325 Use Coordinated Universal Time (UTC) by operating as if the
15326 @env{TZ} environment variable were set to the string @samp{UTC0}.
15328 Universal Time is often called ``Greenwich Mean Time'' (GMT) for
15329 historical reasons.
15330 Typically, systems ignore leap seconds and thus implement an
15331 approximation to UTC rather than true UTC.
15335 @node Examples of date
15336 @subsection Examples of @command{date}
15338 @cindex examples of @command{date}
15340 Here are a few examples. Also see the documentation for the @option{-d}
15341 option in the previous section.
15346 To print the date of the day before yesterday:
15349 date --date='2 days ago'
15353 To print the date of the day three months and one day hence:
15356 date --date='3 months 1 day'
15360 To print the day of year of Christmas in the current year:
15363 date --date='25 Dec' +%j
15367 To print the current full month name and the day of the month:
15373 But this may not be what you want because for the first nine days of
15374 the month, the @samp{%d} expands to a zero-padded two-digit field,
15375 for example @samp{date -d 1may '+%B %d'} will print @samp{May 01}.
15378 To print a date without the leading zero for one-digit days
15379 of the month, you can use the (GNU extension)
15380 @samp{-} flag to suppress
15381 the padding altogether:
15384 date -d 1may '+%B %-d
15388 To print the current date and time in the format required by many
15389 non-GNU versions of @command{date} when setting the system clock:
15392 date +%m%d%H%M%Y.%S
15396 To set the system clock forward by two minutes:
15399 date --set='+2 minutes'
15403 To print the date in RFC 2822 format,
15404 use @samp{date --rfc-2822}. Here is some example output:
15407 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
15410 @anchor{%s-examples}
15412 To convert a date string to the number of seconds since the epoch
15413 (which is 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC), use the @option{--date} option with
15414 the @samp{%s} format. That can be useful in sorting and/or graphing
15415 and/or comparing data by date. The following command outputs the
15416 number of the seconds since the epoch for the time two minutes after the
15420 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00 +0000' +%s
15424 If you do not specify time zone information in the date string,
15425 @command{date} uses your computer's idea of the time zone when
15426 interpreting the string. For example, if your computer's time zone is
15427 that of Cambridge, Massachusetts, which was then 5 hours (i.e., 18,000
15428 seconds) behind UTC:
15431 # local time zone used
15432 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00' +%s
15437 If you're sorting or graphing dated data, your raw date values may be
15438 represented as seconds since the epoch. But few people can look at
15439 the date @samp{946684800} and casually note ``Oh, that's the first second
15440 of the year 2000 in Greenwich, England.''
15443 date --date='2000-01-01 UTC' +%s
15447 An alternative is to use the @option{--utc} (@option{-u}) option.
15448 Then you may omit @samp{UTC} from the date string. Although this
15449 produces the same result for @samp{%s} and many other format sequences,
15450 with a time zone offset different from zero, it would give a different
15451 result for zone-dependent formats like @samp{%z}.
15454 date -u --date=2000-01-01 +%s
15458 To convert such an unwieldy number of seconds back to
15459 a more readable form, use a command like this:
15462 # local time zone used
15463 date -d '1970-01-01 UTC 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
15464 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
15467 Or if you do not mind depending on the @samp{@@} feature present since
15468 coreutils 5.3.0, you could shorten this to:
15471 date -d @@946684800 +"%F %T %z"
15472 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
15475 Often it is better to output UTC-relative date and time:
15478 date -u -d '1970-01-01 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
15479 2000-01-01 00:00:00 +0000
15483 @cindex leap seconds
15484 Typically the seconds count omits leap seconds, but some systems are
15485 exceptions. Because leap seconds are not predictable, the mapping
15486 between the seconds count and a future timestamp is not reliable on
15487 the atypical systems that include leap seconds in their counts.
15489 Here is how the two kinds of systems handle the leap second at
15490 2012-06-30 23:59:60 UTC:
15493 # Typical systems ignore leap seconds:
15494 date --date='2012-06-30 23:59:59 +0000' +%s
15496 date --date='2012-06-30 23:59:60 +0000' +%s
15497 date: invalid date '2012-06-30 23:59:60 +0000'
15498 date --date='2012-07-01 00:00:00 +0000' +%s
15503 # Atypical systems count leap seconds:
15504 date --date='2012-06-30 23:59:59 +0000' +%s
15506 date --date='2012-06-30 23:59:60 +0000' +%s
15508 date --date='2012-07-01 00:00:00 +0000' +%s
15515 @node arch invocation
15516 @section @command{arch}: Print machine hardware name
15519 @cindex print machine hardware name
15520 @cindex system information, printing
15522 @command{arch} prints the machine hardware name,
15523 and is equivalent to @samp{uname -m}.
15527 arch [@var{option}]
15530 The program accepts the @ref{Common options} only.
15532 @command{arch} is not installed by default, so portable scripts should
15533 not rely on its existence.
15538 @node nproc invocation
15539 @section @command{nproc}: Print the number of available processors
15542 @cindex Print the number of processors
15543 @cindex system information, printing
15545 Print the number of processing units available to the current process,
15546 which may be less than the number of online processors.
15547 If this information is not accessible, then print the number of
15548 processors installed. If the @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} environment variable is
15549 set, then it will determine the returned value. The result is guaranteed to be
15550 greater than zero. Synopsis:
15553 nproc [@var{option}]
15556 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15562 Print the number of installed processors on the system, which may
15563 be greater than the number online or available to the current process.
15564 The @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} environment variable is not honored in this case.
15566 @item --ignore=@var{number}
15568 If possible, exclude this @var{number} of processing units.
15575 @node uname invocation
15576 @section @command{uname}: Print system information
15579 @cindex print system information
15580 @cindex system information, printing
15582 @command{uname} prints information about the machine and operating system
15583 it is run on. If no options are given, @command{uname} acts as if the
15584 @option{-s} option were given. Synopsis:
15587 uname [@var{option}]@dots{}
15590 If multiple options or @option{-a} are given, the selected information is
15591 printed in this order:
15594 @var{kernel-name} @var{nodename} @var{kernel-release} @var{kernel-version}
15595 @var{machine} @var{processor} @var{hardware-platform} @var{operating-system}
15598 The information may contain internal spaces, so such output cannot be
15599 parsed reliably. In the following example, @var{release} is
15600 @samp{2.2.18ss.e820-bda652a #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001}:
15604 @result{} Linux dumdum 2.2.18 #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001 i686@c
15605 unknown unknown GNU/Linux
15609 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15617 Print all of the below information, except omit the processor type
15618 and the hardware platform name if they are unknown.
15621 @itemx --hardware-platform
15623 @opindex --hardware-platform
15624 @cindex implementation, hardware
15625 @cindex hardware platform
15626 @cindex platform, hardware
15627 Print the hardware platform name
15628 (sometimes called the hardware implementation).
15629 Print @samp{unknown} if this information is not available.
15630 Note this is non-portable (even across GNU/Linux distributions).
15636 @cindex machine type
15637 @cindex hardware class
15638 @cindex hardware type
15639 Print the machine hardware name (sometimes called the hardware class
15645 @opindex --nodename
15648 @cindex network node name
15649 Print the network node hostname.
15654 @opindex --processor
15655 @cindex host processor type
15656 Print the processor type (sometimes called the instruction set
15657 architecture or ISA).
15658 Print @samp{unknown} if this information is not available.
15659 Note this is non-portable (even across GNU/Linux distributions).
15662 @itemx --operating-system
15664 @opindex --operating-system
15665 @cindex operating system name
15666 Print the name of the operating system.
15669 @itemx --kernel-release
15671 @opindex --kernel-release
15672 @cindex kernel release
15673 @cindex release of kernel
15674 Print the kernel release.
15677 @itemx --kernel-name
15679 @opindex --kernel-name
15680 @cindex kernel name
15681 @cindex name of kernel
15682 Print the kernel name.
15683 POSIX 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) calls this
15684 ``the implementation of the operating system'', because the
15685 POSIX specification itself has no notion of ``kernel''.
15686 The kernel name might be the same as the operating system name printed
15687 by the @option{-o} or @option{--operating-system} option, but it might
15688 differ. Some operating systems (e.g., FreeBSD, HP-UX) have the same
15689 name as their underlying kernels; others (e.g., GNU/Linux, Solaris)
15693 @itemx --kernel-version
15695 @opindex --kernel-version
15696 @cindex kernel version
15697 @cindex version of kernel
15698 Print the kernel version.
15705 @node hostname invocation
15706 @section @command{hostname}: Print or set system name
15709 @cindex setting the hostname
15710 @cindex printing the hostname
15711 @cindex system name, printing
15712 @cindex appropriate privileges
15714 With no arguments, @command{hostname} prints the name of the current host
15715 system. With one argument, it sets the current host name to the
15716 specified string. You must have appropriate privileges to set the host
15720 hostname [@var{name}]
15723 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
15726 @command{hostname} is not installed by default, and other packages
15727 also supply a @command{hostname} command, so portable scripts should
15728 not rely on its existence or on the exact behavior documented above.
15733 @node hostid invocation
15734 @section @command{hostid}: Print numeric host identifier
15737 @cindex printing the host identifier
15739 @command{hostid} prints the numeric identifier of the current host
15740 in hexadecimal. This command accepts no arguments.
15741 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
15742 @xref{Common options}.
15744 For example, here's what it prints on one system I use:
15751 On that system, the 32-bit quantity happens to be closely
15752 related to the system's Internet address, but that isn't always
15755 @command{hostid} is installed only on systems that have the
15756 @code{gethostid} function, so portable scripts should not rely on its
15761 @node uptime invocation
15762 @section @command{uptime}: Print system uptime and load
15765 @cindex printing the system uptime and load
15767 @command{uptime} prints the current time, the system's uptime, the
15768 number of logged-in users and the current load average.
15770 If an argument is specified, it is used as the file to be read
15771 to discover how many users are logged in. If no argument is
15772 specified, a system default is used (@command{uptime --help} indicates
15773 the default setting).
15775 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
15776 @xref{Common options}.
15778 For example, here's what it prints right now on one system I use:
15782 14:07 up 3:35, 3 users, load average: 1.39, 1.15, 1.04
15785 The precise method of calculation of load average varies somewhat
15786 between systems. Some systems calculate it as the average number of
15787 runnable processes over the last 1, 5 and 15 minutes, but some systems
15788 also include processes in the uninterruptible sleep state (that is,
15789 those processes which are waiting for disk I/O). The Linux kernel
15790 includes uninterruptible processes.
15792 @command{uptime} is installed only on platforms with infrastructure
15793 for obtaining the boot time, and other packages also supply an
15794 @command{uptime} command, so portable scripts should not rely on its
15795 existence or on the exact behavior documented above.
15799 @node SELinux context
15800 @chapter SELinux context
15802 @cindex SELinux context
15803 @cindex SELinux, context
15804 @cindex commands for SELinux context
15806 This section describes commands for operations with SELinux
15810 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
15811 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
15814 @node chcon invocation
15815 @section @command{chcon}: Change SELinux context of file
15818 @cindex changing security context
15819 @cindex change SELinux context
15821 @command{chcon} changes the SELinux security context of the selected files.
15825 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{context} @var{file}@dots{}
15826 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-l @var{range}]@c
15827 [-t @var{type}] @var{file}@dots{}
15828 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} --reference=@var{rfile} @var{file}@dots{}
15831 Change the SELinux security context of each @var{file} to @var{context}.
15832 With @option{--reference}, change the security context of each @var{file}
15833 to that of @var{rfile}.
15835 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15839 @item --dereference
15840 @opindex --dereference
15841 Do not affect symbolic links but what they refer to; this is the default.
15844 @itemx --no-dereference
15846 @opindex --no-dereference
15847 @cindex no dereference
15848 Affect the symbolic links themselves instead of any referenced file.
15850 @item --reference=@var{rfile}
15851 @opindex --reference
15852 @cindex reference file
15853 Use @var{rfile}'s security context rather than specifying a @var{context} value.
15858 @opindex --recursive
15859 Operate on files and directories recursively.
15861 @item --preserve-root
15862 @opindex --preserve-root
15863 Refuse to operate recursively on the root directory, @file{/},
15864 when used together with the @option{--recursive} option.
15865 @xref{Treating / specially}.
15867 @item --no-preserve-root
15868 @opindex --no-preserve-root
15869 Do not treat the root directory, @file{/}, specially when operating
15870 recursively; this is the default.
15871 @xref{Treating / specially}.
15874 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
15877 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
15880 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
15887 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
15889 @item -u @var{user}
15890 @itemx --user=@var{user}
15893 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
15895 @item -r @var{role}
15896 @itemx --role=@var{role}
15899 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
15901 @item -t @var{type}
15902 @itemx --type=@var{type}
15905 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
15907 @item -l @var{range}
15908 @itemx --range=@var{range}
15911 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
15917 @node runcon invocation
15918 @section @command{runcon}: Run a command in specified SELinux context
15921 @cindex run with security context
15924 @command{runcon} runs file in specified SELinux security context.
15928 runcon @var{context} @var{command} [@var{args}]
15929 runcon [ -c ] [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-t @var{type}]@c
15930 [-l @var{range}] @var{command} [@var{args}]
15933 Run @var{command} with completely-specified @var{context}, or with
15934 current or transitioned security context modified by one or more of @var{level},
15935 @var{role}, @var{type} and @var{user}.
15937 If none of @option{-c}, @option{-t}, @option{-u}, @option{-r}, or @option{-l}
15938 is specified, the first argument is used as the complete context.
15939 Any additional arguments after @var{command}
15940 are interpreted as arguments to the command.
15942 With neither @var{context} nor @var{command}, print the current
15945 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15953 Compute process transition context before modifying.
15955 @item -u @var{user}
15956 @itemx --user=@var{user}
15959 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
15961 @item -r @var{role}
15962 @itemx --role=@var{role}
15965 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
15967 @item -t @var{type}
15968 @itemx --type=@var{type}
15971 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
15973 @item -l @var{range}
15974 @itemx --range=@var{range}
15977 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
15981 @cindex exit status of @command{runcon}
15985 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
15986 127 if @command{runcon} itself fails or if @var{command} cannot be found
15987 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
15990 @node Modified command invocation
15991 @chapter Modified command invocation
15993 @cindex modified command invocation
15994 @cindex invocation of commands, modified
15995 @cindex commands for invoking other commands
15997 This section describes commands that run other commands in some context
15998 different than the current one: a modified environment, as a different
16002 * chroot invocation:: Modify the root directory.
16003 * env invocation:: Modify environment variables.
16004 * nice invocation:: Modify niceness.
16005 * nohup invocation:: Immunize to hangups.
16006 * stdbuf invocation:: Modify buffering of standard streams.
16007 * timeout invocation:: Run with time limit.
16011 @node chroot invocation
16012 @section @command{chroot}: Run a command with a different root directory
16015 @cindex running a program in a specified root directory
16016 @cindex root directory, running a program in a specified
16018 @command{chroot} runs a command with a specified root directory.
16019 On many systems, only the super-user can do this.@footnote{However,
16020 some systems (e.g., FreeBSD) can be configured to allow certain regular
16021 users to use the @code{chroot} system call, and hence to run this program.
16022 Also, on Cygwin, anyone can run the @command{chroot} command, because the
16023 underlying function is non-privileged due to lack of support in MS-Windows.
16024 Furthermore, the @command{chroot} command avoids the @code{chroot} system call
16025 when @var{newroot} is identical to the old @file{/} directory for consistency
16026 with systems where this is allowed for non-privileged users.}.
16030 chroot @var{option} @var{newroot} [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
16031 chroot @var{option}
16034 Ordinarily, file names are looked up starting at the root of the
16035 directory structure, i.e., @file{/}. @command{chroot} changes the root to
16036 the directory @var{newroot} (which must exist), then changes the working
16037 directory to @file{/}, and finally runs @var{command} with optional @var{args}.
16038 If @var{command} is not specified, the default is the value of the @env{SHELL}
16039 environment variable or @command{/bin/sh} if not set, invoked with the
16040 @option{-i} option.
16041 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility
16042 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
16044 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16045 Options must precede operands.
16049 @item --groups=@var{groups}
16051 Use this option to override the supplementary @var{groups} to be
16052 used by the new process.
16053 The items in the list (names or numeric IDs) must be separated by commas.
16054 Use @samp{--groups=''} to disable the supplementary group look-up
16055 implicit in the @option{--userspec} option.
16057 @item --userspec=@var{user}[:@var{group}]
16058 @opindex --userspec
16059 By default, @var{command} is run with the same credentials
16060 as the invoking process.
16061 Use this option to run it as a different @var{user} and/or with a
16062 different primary @var{group}.
16063 If a @var{user} is specified then the supplementary groups
16064 are set according to the system defined list for that user,
16065 unless overridden with the @option{--groups} option.
16068 @opindex --skip-chdir
16069 Use this option to not change the working directory to @file{/} after changing
16070 the root directory to @var{newroot}, i.e., inside the chroot.
16071 This option is only permitted when @var{newroot} is the old @file{/} directory,
16072 and therefore is mostly useful together with the @option{--groups} and
16073 @option{--userspec} options to retain the previous working directory.
16077 The user and group name look-up performed by the @option{--userspec}
16078 and @option{--groups} options, is done both outside and inside
16079 the chroot, with successful look-ups inside the chroot taking precedence.
16080 If the specified user or group items are intended to represent a numeric ID,
16081 then a name to ID resolving step is avoided by specifying a leading @samp{+}.
16082 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
16084 Here are a few tips to help avoid common problems in using chroot.
16085 To start with a simple example, make @var{command} refer to a statically
16086 linked binary. If you were to use a dynamically linked executable, then
16087 you'd have to arrange to have the shared libraries in the right place under
16088 your new root directory.
16090 For example, if you create a statically linked @command{ls} executable,
16091 and put it in @file{/tmp/empty}, you can run this command as root:
16094 $ chroot /tmp/empty /ls -Rl /
16097 Then you'll see output like this:
16102 -rwxr-xr-x 1 0 0 1041745 Aug 16 11:17 ls
16105 If you want to use a dynamically linked executable, say @command{bash},
16106 then first run @samp{ldd bash} to see what shared objects it needs.
16107 Then, in addition to copying the actual binary, also copy the listed
16108 files to the required positions under your intended new root directory.
16109 Finally, if the executable requires any other files (e.g., data, state,
16110 device files), copy them into place, too.
16112 @command{chroot} is installed only on systems that have the
16113 @code{chroot} function, so portable scripts should not rely on its
16116 @cindex exit status of @command{chroot}
16120 125 if @command{chroot} itself fails
16121 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16122 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16123 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16127 @node env invocation
16128 @section @command{env}: Run a command in a modified environment
16131 @cindex environment, running a program in a modified
16132 @cindex modified environment, running a program in a
16133 @cindex running a program in a modified environment
16135 @command{env} runs a command with a modified environment. Synopses:
16138 env [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
16139 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
16143 Operands of the form @samp{@var{variable}=@var{value}} set
16144 the environment variable @var{variable} to value @var{value}.
16145 @var{value} may be empty (@samp{@var{variable}=}). Setting a variable
16146 to an empty value is different from unsetting it.
16147 These operands are evaluated left-to-right, so if two operands
16148 mention the same variable the earlier is ignored.
16150 Environment variable names can be empty, and can contain any
16151 characters other than @samp{=} and ASCII NUL.
16152 However, it is wise to limit yourself to names that
16153 consist solely of underscores, digits, and ASCII letters,
16154 and that begin with a non-digit, as applications like the shell do not
16155 work well with other names.
16158 The first operand that does not contain the character @samp{=}
16159 specifies the program to invoke; it is
16160 searched for according to the @env{PATH} environment variable. Any
16161 remaining arguments are passed as arguments to that program.
16162 The program should not be a special built-in utility
16163 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
16165 Modifications to @env{PATH} take effect prior to searching for
16166 @var{command}. Use caution when reducing @env{PATH}; behavior is
16167 not portable when @env{PATH} is undefined or omits key directories
16168 such as @file{/bin}.
16170 In the rare case that a utility contains a @samp{=} in the name, the
16171 only way to disambiguate it from a variable assignment is to use an
16172 intermediate command for @var{command}, and pass the problematic
16173 program name via @var{args}. For example, if @file{./prog=} is an
16174 executable in the current @env{PATH}:
16177 env prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
16178 env ./prog= true # runs 'true', with ./prog= in environment
16179 env -- prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
16180 env sh -c '\prog= true' # runs 'prog=' with argument 'true'
16181 env sh -c 'exec "$@@"' sh prog= true # also runs 'prog='
16184 @cindex environment, printing
16186 If no command name is specified following the environment
16187 specifications, the resulting environment is printed. This is like
16188 specifying the @command{printenv} program.
16190 For some examples, suppose the environment passed to @command{env}
16191 contains @samp{LOGNAME=rms}, @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and
16192 @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}:
16197 Output the current environment.
16199 $ env | LC_ALL=C sort
16202 PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks
16206 Run @command{foo} with a reduced environment, preserving only the
16207 original @env{PATH} to avoid problems in locating @command{foo}.
16209 env - PATH="$PATH" foo
16213 Run @command{foo} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=rms},
16214 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and guarantees
16215 that @command{foo} was found in the file system rather than as a shell
16222 Run @command{nemacs} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=foo},
16223 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and
16224 @samp{DISPLAY=gnu:0}.
16226 env DISPLAY=gnu:0 LOGNAME=foo nemacs
16230 Attempt to run the program @command{/energy/--} (as that is the only
16231 possible path search result); if the command exists, the environment
16232 will contain @samp{LOGNAME=rms} and @samp{PATH=/energy}, and the
16233 arguments will be @samp{e=mc2}, @samp{bar}, and @samp{baz}.
16235 env -u EDITOR PATH=/energy -- e=mc2 bar baz
16241 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16242 Options must precede operands.
16248 @item -u @var{name}
16249 @itemx --unset=@var{name}
16252 Remove variable @var{name} from the environment, if it was in the
16257 @itemx --ignore-environment
16260 @opindex --ignore-environment
16261 Start with an empty environment, ignoring the inherited environment.
16265 @cindex exit status of @command{env}
16269 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the environment is output
16270 125 if @command{env} itself fails
16271 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16272 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16273 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16277 @node nice invocation
16278 @section @command{nice}: Run a command with modified niceness
16282 @cindex scheduling, affecting
16283 @cindex appropriate privileges
16285 @command{nice} prints a process's @dfn{niceness}, or runs
16286 a command with modified niceness. @dfn{niceness} affects how
16287 favorably the process is scheduled in the system.
16291 nice [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
16294 If no arguments are given, @command{nice} prints the current niceness.
16295 Otherwise, @command{nice} runs the given @var{command} with its
16296 niceness adjusted. By default, its niceness is incremented by 10.
16298 Niceness values range at least from @minus{}20 (process has high priority
16299 and gets more resources, thus slowing down other processes) through 19
16300 (process has lower priority and runs slowly itself, but has less impact
16301 on the speed of other running processes). Some systems
16302 may have a wider range of niceness values; conversely, other systems may
16303 enforce more restrictive limits. An attempt to set the niceness
16304 outside the supported range is treated as an attempt to use the
16305 minimum or maximum supported value.
16307 A niceness should not be confused with a scheduling priority, which
16308 lets applications determine the order in which threads are scheduled
16309 to run. Unlike a priority, a niceness is merely advice to the
16310 scheduler, which the scheduler is free to ignore. Also, as a point of
16311 terminology, POSIX defines the behavior of @command{nice} in
16312 terms of a @dfn{nice value}, which is the non-negative difference
16313 between a niceness and the minimum niceness. Though @command{nice}
16314 conforms to POSIX, its documentation and diagnostics use the
16315 term ``niceness'' for compatibility with historical practice.
16317 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
16318 built-in utilities}).
16320 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{nice}
16322 Note to change the @dfn{niceness} of an existing process,
16323 one needs to use the @command{renice} command.
16325 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16326 Options must precede operands.
16329 @item -n @var{adjustment}
16330 @itemx --adjustment=@var{adjustment}
16332 @opindex --adjustment
16333 Add @var{adjustment} instead of 10 to the command's niceness. If
16334 @var{adjustment} is negative and you lack appropriate privileges,
16335 @command{nice} issues a warning but otherwise acts as if you specified
16338 For compatibility @command{nice} also supports an obsolete
16339 option syntax @option{-@var{adjustment}}. New scripts should use
16340 @option{-n @var{adjustment}} instead.
16344 @command{nice} is installed only on systems that have the POSIX
16345 @code{setpriority} function, so portable scripts should not rely on
16346 its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
16348 @cindex exit status of @command{nice}
16352 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the niceness is output
16353 125 if @command{nice} itself fails
16354 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16355 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16356 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16359 It is sometimes useful to run a non-interactive program with reduced niceness.
16362 $ nice factor 4611686018427387903
16365 Since @command{nice} prints the current niceness,
16366 you can invoke it through itself to demonstrate how it works.
16368 The default behavior is to increase the niceness by @samp{10}:
16379 The @var{adjustment} is relative to the current niceness. In the
16380 next example, the first @command{nice} invocation runs the second one
16381 with niceness 10, and it in turn runs the final one with a niceness
16385 $ nice nice -n 3 nice
16389 Specifying a niceness larger than the supported range
16390 is the same as specifying the maximum supported value:
16393 $ nice -n 10000000000 nice
16397 Only a privileged user may run a process with lower niceness:
16401 nice: cannot set niceness: Permission denied
16403 $ sudo nice -n -1 nice
16408 @node nohup invocation
16409 @section @command{nohup}: Run a command immune to hangups
16412 @cindex hangups, immunity to
16413 @cindex immunity to hangups
16414 @cindex logging out and continuing to run
16417 @command{nohup} runs the given @var{command} with hangup signals ignored,
16418 so that the command can continue running in the background after you log
16422 nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
16425 If standard input is a terminal, redirect it so that terminal sessions
16426 do not mistakenly consider the terminal to be used by the command.
16427 Make the substitute file descriptor unreadable, so that commands that
16428 mistakenly attempt to read from standard input can report an error.
16429 This redirection is a GNU extension; programs intended to be portable
16430 to non-GNU hosts can use @samp{nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
16431 0>/dev/null} instead.
16434 If standard output is a terminal, the command's standard output is appended
16435 to the file @file{nohup.out}; if that cannot be written to, it is appended
16436 to the file @file{$HOME/nohup.out}; and if that cannot be written to, the
16437 command is not run.
16438 Any @file{nohup.out} or @file{$HOME/nohup.out} file created by
16439 @command{nohup} is made readable and writable only to the user,
16440 regardless of the current umask settings.
16442 If standard error is a terminal, it is normally redirected to the same file
16443 descriptor as the (possibly-redirected) standard output.
16444 However, if standard output is closed, standard error terminal output
16445 is instead appended to the file @file{nohup.out} or
16446 @file{$HOME/nohup.out} as above.
16448 To capture the command's output to a file other than @file{nohup.out}
16449 you can redirect it. For example, to capture the output of
16453 nohup make > make.log
16456 @command{nohup} does not automatically put the command it runs in the
16457 background; you must do that explicitly, by ending the command line
16458 with an @samp{&}. Also, @command{nohup} does not alter the
16459 niceness of @var{command}; use @command{nice} for that,
16460 e.g., @samp{nohup nice @var{command}}.
16462 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
16463 built-in utilities}).
16465 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16466 options}. Options must precede operands.
16468 @cindex exit status of @command{nohup}
16472 125 if @command{nohup} itself fails, and @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set
16473 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16474 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16475 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16478 If @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, internal failures give status 127
16482 @node stdbuf invocation
16483 @section @command{stdbuf}: Run a command with modified I/O stream buffering
16486 @cindex standard streams, buffering
16487 @cindex line buffered
16489 @command{stdbuf} allows one to modify the buffering operations of the
16490 three standard I/O streams associated with a program. Synopsis:
16493 stdbuf @var{option}@dots{} @var{command}
16496 @var{command} must start with the name of a program that
16499 uses the ISO C @code{FILE} streams for input/output (note the
16500 programs @command{dd} and @command{cat} don't do that),
16503 does not adjust the buffering of its standard streams (note the
16504 program @command{tee} is not in this category).
16507 Any additional @var{arg}s are passed as additional arguments to the
16510 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16514 @item -i @var{mode}
16515 @itemx --input=@var{mode}
16518 Adjust the standard input stream buffering.
16520 @item -o @var{mode}
16521 @itemx --output=@var{mode}
16524 Adjust the standard output stream buffering.
16526 @item -e @var{mode}
16527 @itemx --error=@var{mode}
16530 Adjust the standard error stream buffering.
16534 The @var{mode} can be specified as follows:
16539 Set the stream to line buffered mode.
16540 In this mode data is coalesced until a newline is output or
16541 input is read from any stream attached to a terminal device.
16542 This option is invalid with standard input.
16545 Disable buffering of the selected stream.
16546 In this mode, data is output immediately and only the
16547 amount of data requested is read from input.
16548 Note the difference in function for input and output.
16549 Disabling buffering for input will not influence the responsiveness
16550 or blocking behavior of the stream input functions.
16551 For example @code{fread} will still block until @code{EOF} or error,
16552 even if the underlying @code{read} returns less data than requested.
16555 Specify the size of the buffer to use in fully buffered mode.
16556 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
16560 @command{stdbuf} is installed only on platforms that use the
16561 Executable and Linkable Format (ELF) and support the
16562 @code{constructor} attribute, so portable scripts should not rely on
16565 @cindex exit status of @command{stdbuf}
16569 125 if @command{stdbuf} itself fails
16570 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16571 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16572 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16576 @node timeout invocation
16577 @section @command{timeout}: Run a command with a time limit
16581 @cindex run commands with bounded time
16583 @command{timeout} runs the given @var{command} and kills it if it is
16584 still running after the specified time interval. Synopsis:
16587 timeout [@var{option}] @var{duration} @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
16590 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
16591 built-in utilities}).
16593 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16594 Options must precede operands.
16597 @item --preserve-status
16598 @opindex --preserve-status
16599 Return the exit status of the managed @var{command} on timeout, rather than
16600 a specific exit status indicating a timeout. This is useful if the
16601 managed @var{command} supports running for an indeterminate amount of time.
16604 @opindex --foreground
16605 Don't create a separate background program group, so that
16606 the managed @var{command} can use the foreground TTY normally.
16607 This is needed to support timing out commands not started
16608 directly from an interactive shell, in two situations.
16611 @var{command} is interactive and needs to read from the terminal for example
16613 the user wants to support sending signals directly to @var{command}
16614 from the terminal (like Ctrl-C for example)
16617 Note in this mode of operation, any children of @var{command}
16618 will not be timed out. Also SIGCONT will not be sent to @var{command},
16619 as it's generally not needed with foreground processes, and can
16620 cause intermittent signal delivery issues with programs that are monitors
16621 themselves (like GDB for example).
16623 @item -k @var{duration}
16624 @itemx --kill-after=@var{duration}
16626 @opindex --kill-after
16627 Ensure the monitored @var{command} is killed by also sending a @samp{KILL}
16628 signal, after the specified @var{duration}. Without this option, if the
16629 selected signal proves not to be fatal, @command{timeout} does not kill
16632 @item -s @var{signal}
16633 @itemx --signal=@var{signal}
16636 Send this @var{signal} to @var{command} on timeout, rather than the
16637 default @samp{TERM} signal. @var{signal} may be a name like @samp{HUP}
16638 or a number. @xref{Signal specifications}.
16642 @var{duration} is a floating point number followed by an optional unit:
16644 @samp{s} for seconds (the default)
16645 @samp{m} for minutes
16649 A duration of 0 disables the associated timeout.
16650 Note that the actual timeout duration is dependent on system conditions,
16651 which should be especially considered when specifying sub-second timeouts.
16653 @cindex exit status of @command{timeout}
16657 124 if @var{command} times out
16658 125 if @command{timeout} itself fails
16659 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16660 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16661 137 if @var{command} is sent the KILL(9) signal (128+9)
16662 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16666 @node Process control
16667 @chapter Process control
16669 @cindex processes, commands for controlling
16670 @cindex commands for controlling processes
16673 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
16677 @node kill invocation
16678 @section @command{kill}: Send a signal to processes
16681 @cindex send a signal to processes
16683 The @command{kill} command sends a signal to processes, causing them
16684 to terminate or otherwise act upon receiving the signal in some way.
16685 Alternatively, it lists information about signals. Synopses:
16688 kill [-s @var{signal} | --signal @var{signal} | -@var{signal}] @var{pid}@dots{}
16689 kill [-l | --list | -t | --table] [@var{signal}]@dots{}
16692 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{kill}
16694 The first form of the @command{kill} command sends a signal to all
16695 @var{pid} arguments. The default signal to send if none is specified
16696 is @samp{TERM}@. The special signal number @samp{0} does not denote a
16697 valid signal, but can be used to test whether the @var{pid} arguments
16698 specify processes to which a signal could be sent.
16700 If @var{pid} is positive, the signal is sent to the process with the
16701 process ID @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, the signal is sent to all
16702 processes in the process group of the current process. If @var{pid}
16703 is @minus{}1, the signal is sent to all processes for which the user has
16704 permission to send a signal. If @var{pid} is less than @minus{}1, the signal
16705 is sent to all processes in the process group that equals the absolute
16706 value of @var{pid}.
16708 If @var{pid} is not positive, a system-dependent set of system
16709 processes is excluded from the list of processes to which the signal
16712 If a negative @var{pid} argument is desired as the first one, it
16713 should be preceded by @option{--}. However, as a common extension to
16714 POSIX, @option{--} is not required with @samp{kill
16715 -@var{signal} -@var{pid}}. The following commands are equivalent:
16724 The first form of the @command{kill} command succeeds if every @var{pid}
16725 argument specifies at least one process that the signal was sent to.
16727 The second form of the @command{kill} command lists signal information.
16728 Either the @option{-l} or @option{--list} option, or the @option{-t}
16729 or @option{--table} option must be specified. Without any
16730 @var{signal} argument, all supported signals are listed. The output
16731 of @option{-l} or @option{--list} is a list of the signal names, one
16732 per line; if @var{signal} is already a name, the signal number is
16733 printed instead. The output of @option{-t} or @option{--table} is a
16734 table of signal numbers, names, and descriptions. This form of the
16735 @command{kill} command succeeds if all @var{signal} arguments are valid
16736 and if there is no output error.
16738 The @command{kill} command also supports the @option{--help} and
16739 @option{--version} options. @xref{Common options}.
16741 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
16742 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
16743 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
16744 @samp{SIG}@. The case of the letters is ignored, except for the
16745 @option{-@var{signal}} option which must use upper case to avoid
16746 ambiguity with lower case option letters.
16747 @xref{Signal specifications}, for a list of supported
16748 signal names and numbers.
16753 @cindex delaying commands
16754 @cindex commands for delaying
16756 @c Perhaps @command{wait} or other commands should be described here also?
16759 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time.
16763 @node sleep invocation
16764 @section @command{sleep}: Delay for a specified time
16767 @cindex delay for a specified time
16769 @command{sleep} pauses for an amount of time specified by the sum of
16770 the values of the command line arguments.
16774 sleep @var{number}[smhd]@dots{}
16778 Each argument is a number followed by an optional unit; the default
16779 is seconds. The units are:
16792 Historical implementations of @command{sleep} have required that
16793 @var{number} be an integer, and only accepted a single argument
16794 without a suffix. However, GNU @command{sleep} accepts
16795 arbitrary floating point numbers. @xref{Floating point}.
16797 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16800 @c sleep is a shell built-in at least with Solaris 11's /bin/sh
16801 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{sleep}
16806 @node Numeric operations
16807 @chapter Numeric operations
16809 @cindex numeric operations
16810 These programs do numerically-related operations.
16813 * factor invocation:: Show factors of numbers.
16814 * numfmt invocation:: Reformat numbers.
16815 * seq invocation:: Print sequences of numbers.
16819 @node factor invocation
16820 @section @command{factor}: Print prime factors
16823 @cindex prime factors
16825 @command{factor} prints prime factors. Synopses:
16828 factor [@var{number}]@dots{}
16829 factor @var{option}
16832 If no @var{number} is specified on the command line, @command{factor} reads
16833 numbers from standard input, delimited by newlines, tabs, or spaces.
16835 The @command{factor} command supports only a small number of options:
16839 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
16843 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
16847 Factoring the product of the eighth and ninth Mersenne primes
16848 takes about 30 milliseconds of CPU time on a 2.2 GHz Athlon.
16851 M8=$(echo 2^31-1|bc)
16852 M9=$(echo 2^61-1|bc)
16853 n=$(echo "$M8 * $M9" | bc)
16854 /usr/bin/time -f %U factor $n
16855 4951760154835678088235319297: 2147483647 2305843009213693951
16859 Similarly, factoring the eighth Fermat number @math{2^{256}+1} takes
16860 about 20 seconds on the same machine.
16862 Factoring large numbers is, in general, hard. The Pollard Rho
16863 algorithm used by @command{factor} is particularly effective for
16864 numbers with relatively small factors. If you wish to factor large
16865 numbers which do not have small factors (for example, numbers which
16866 are the product of two large primes), other methods are far better.
16868 If @command{factor} is built without using GNU MP, only
16869 single-precision arithmetic is available, and so large numbers
16870 (typically @math{2^{64}} and above) will not be supported. The single-precision
16871 code uses an algorithm which is designed for factoring smaller
16877 @node numfmt invocation
16878 @section @command{numfmt}: Reformat numbers
16882 @command{numfmt} reads numbers in various representations and reformats them
16883 as requested. The most common usage is converting numbers to/from @emph{human}
16884 representation (e.g. @samp{4G} @expansion{} @samp{4,000,000,000}).
16887 numfmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{number}]
16890 @command{numfmt} converts each @var{number} on the command-line according to the
16891 specified options (see below). If no @var{number}s are given, it reads numbers
16892 from standard input. @command{numfmt} can optionally extract numbers from
16893 specific columns, maintaining proper line padding and alignment.
16897 See @option{--invalid} for additional information regarding exit status.
16899 @subsection General options
16901 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16907 Print (to standard error) warning messages about possible erroneous usage.
16910 @itemx --delimiter=@var{d}
16912 @opindex --delimiter
16913 Use the character @var{d} as input field separator (default: whitespace).
16914 @emph{Note}: Using non-default delimiter turns off automatic padding.
16916 @item --field=@var{fields}
16918 Convert the number in input field @var{fields} (default: 1).
16919 @var{fields} supports @command{cut} style field ranges:
16922 N N'th field, counted from 1
16923 N- from N'th field, to end of line
16924 N-M from N'th to M'th field (inclusive)
16925 -M from first to M'th field (inclusive)
16930 @item --format=@var{format}
16932 Use printf-style floating FORMAT string. The @var{format} string must contain
16933 one @samp{%f} directive, optionally with @samp{'}, @samp{-}, @samp{0}, width
16934 or precision modifiers. The @samp{'} modifier will enable @option{--grouping},
16935 the @samp{-} modifier will enable left-aligned @option{--padding} and the width
16936 modifier will enable right-aligned @option{--padding}. The @samp{0} width
16937 modifier (without the @samp{-} modifier) will generate leading zeros on the
16938 number, up to the specified width. A precision specification like @samp{%.1f}
16939 will override the precision determined from the input data or set due to
16940 @option{--to} option auto scaling.
16942 @item --from=@var{unit}
16944 Auto-scales input numbers according to @var{unit}. See UNITS below.
16945 The default is no scaling, meaning suffixes (e.g. @samp{M}, @samp{G}) will
16948 @item --from-unit=@var{n}
16949 @opindex --from-unit
16950 Specify the input unit size (instead of the default 1). Use this option when
16951 the input numbers represent other units (e.g. if the input number @samp{10}
16952 represents 10 units of 512 bytes, use @samp{--from-unit=512}).
16953 Suffixes are handled as with @samp{--from=auto}.
16956 @opindex --grouping
16957 Group digits in output numbers according to the current locale's grouping rules
16958 (e.g @emph{Thousands Separator} character, commonly @samp{.} (dot) or @samp{,}
16959 comma). This option has no effect in @samp{POSIX/C} locale.
16961 @item --header[=@var{n}]
16963 @opindex --header=N
16964 Print the first @var{n} (default: 1) lines without any conversion.
16966 @item --invalid=@var{mode}
16968 The default action on input errors is to exit immediately with status code 2.
16969 @option{--invalid=@samp{abort}} explicitly specifies this default mode.
16970 With a @var{mode} of @samp{fail}, print a warning for @emph{each} conversion
16971 error, and exit with status 2. With a @var{mode} of @samp{warn}, exit with
16972 status 0, even in the presence of conversion errors, and with a @var{mode} of
16973 @samp{ignore} do not even print diagnostics.
16975 @item --padding=@var{n}
16977 Pad the output numbers to @var{n} characters, by adding spaces. If @var{n} is
16978 a positive number, numbers will be right-aligned. If @var{n} is a negative
16979 number, numbers will be left-aligned. By default, numbers are automatically
16980 aligned based on the input line's width (only with the default delimiter).
16982 @item --round=@var{method}
16984 @opindex --round=up
16985 @opindex --round=down
16986 @opindex --round=from-zero
16987 @opindex --round=towards-zero
16988 @opindex --round=nearest
16989 When converting number representations, round the number according to
16990 @var{method}, which can be @samp{up}, @samp{down},
16991 @samp{from-zero} (the default), @samp{towards-zero}, @samp{nearest}.
16993 @item --suffix=@var{suffix}
16995 Add @samp{SUFFIX} to the output numbers, and accept optional @samp{SUFFIX} in
16998 @item --to=@var{unit}
17000 Auto-scales output numbers according to @var{unit}. See @emph{Units} below.
17001 The default is no scaling, meaning all the digits of the number are printed.
17003 @item --to-unit=@var{n}
17005 Specify the output unit size (instead of the default 1). Use this option when
17006 the output numbers represent other units (e.g. to represent @samp{4,000,000}
17007 bytes in blocks of 1KB, use @samp{--to=si --to-unit=1000}).
17008 Suffixes are handled as with @samp{--from=auto}.
17012 @subsection Possible @var{unit}s:
17014 The following are the possible @var{unit} options with @option{--from=UNITS} and
17015 @option{--to=UNITS}:
17020 No scaling is performed. For input numbers, no suffixes are accepted, and any
17021 trailing characters following the number will trigger an error. For output
17022 numbers, all digits of the numbers will be printed.
17025 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International System of Units (SI)}
17027 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
17028 For output numbers, values larger than 1000 will be rounded, and printed with
17029 one of the following suffixes:
17032 @samp{K} => @math{1000^1 = 10^3} (Kilo)
17033 @samp{M} => @math{1000^2 = 10^6} (Mega)
17034 @samp{G} => @math{1000^3 = 10^9} (Giga)
17035 @samp{T} => @math{1000^4 = 10^{12}} (Tera)
17036 @samp{P} => @math{1000^5 = 10^{15}} (Peta)
17037 @samp{E} => @math{1000^6 = 10^{18}} (Exa)
17038 @samp{Z} => @math{1000^7 = 10^{21}} (Zetta)
17039 @samp{Y} => @math{1000^8 = 10^{24}} (Yotta)
17043 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International Electrotechnical
17044 Commission (IEC)} standard.
17045 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
17046 For output numbers, values larger than 1024 will be rounded, and printed with
17047 one of the following suffixes:
17050 @samp{K} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi)
17051 @samp{M} => @math{1024^2 = 2^{20}} (Mebi)
17052 @samp{G} => @math{1024^3 = 2^{30}} (Gibi)
17053 @samp{T} => @math{1024^4 = 2^{40}} (Tebi)
17054 @samp{P} => @math{1024^5 = 2^{50}} (Pebi)
17055 @samp{E} => @math{1024^6 = 2^{60}} (Exbi)
17056 @samp{Z} => @math{1024^7 = 2^{70}} (Zebi)
17057 @samp{Y} => @math{1024^8 = 2^{80}} (Yobi)
17060 The @option{iec} option uses a single letter suffix (e.g. @samp{G}), which is
17061 not fully standard, as the @emph{iec} standard recommends a two-letter symbol
17062 (e.g @samp{Gi}) - but in practice, this method common. Compare with
17063 the @option{iec-i} option.
17066 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International Electrotechnical
17067 Commission (IEC)} standard.
17068 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
17069 For output numbers, values larger than 1024 will be rounded, and printed with
17070 one of the following suffixes:
17073 @samp{Ki} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi)
17074 @samp{Mi} => @math{1024^2 = 2^{20}} (Mebi)
17075 @samp{Gi} => @math{1024^3 = 2^{30}} (Gibi)
17076 @samp{Ti} => @math{1024^4 = 2^{40}} (Tebi)
17077 @samp{Pi} => @math{1024^5 = 2^{50}} (Pebi)
17078 @samp{Ei} => @math{1024^6 = 2^{60}} (Exbi)
17079 @samp{Zi} => @math{1024^7 = 2^{70}} (Zebi)
17080 @samp{Yi} => @math{1024^8 = 2^{80}} (Yobi)
17083 The @option{iec-i} option uses a two-letter suffix symbol (e.g. @samp{Gi}),
17084 as the @emph{iec} standard recommends, but this is not always common in
17085 practice. Compare with the @option{iec} option.
17088 @samp{auto} can only be used with @option{--from}. With this method, numbers
17089 with @samp{K},@samp{M},@samp{G},@samp{T},@samp{P},@samp{E},@samp{Z},@samp{Y}
17090 suffixes are interpreted as @emph{SI} values, and numbers with @samp{Ki},
17091 @samp{Mi},@samp{Gi},@samp{Ti},@samp{Pi},@samp{Ei},@samp{Zi},@samp{Yi} suffixes
17092 are interpreted as @emph{IEC} values.
17096 @subsection Examples of using @command{numfmt}
17098 Converting a single number from/to @emph{human} representation:
17100 $ numfmt --to=si 500000
17103 $ numfmt --to=iec 500000
17106 $ numfmt --to=iec-i 500000
17109 $ numfmt --from=si 1M
17112 $ numfmt --from=iec 1M
17115 # with '--from=auto', M=Mega, Mi=Mebi
17116 $ numfmt --from=auto 1M
17118 $ numfmt --from=auto 1Mi
17122 Converting from @samp{SI} to @samp{IEC} scales (e.g. when a harddisk capacity is
17123 advertised as @samp{1TB}, while checking the drive's capacity gives lower
17127 $ numfmt --from=si --to=iec 1T
17132 Converting a single field from an input file / piped input (these contrived
17133 examples are for demonstration purposes only, as both @command{ls} and
17134 @command{df} support the @option{--human-readable} option to
17135 output sizes in human-readable format):
17138 # Third field (file size) will be shown in SI representation
17139 $ ls -log | numfmt --field 3 --header --to=si | head -n4
17140 -rw-r--r-- 1 94K Aug 23 2011 ABOUT-NLS
17141 -rw-r--r-- 1 3.7K Jan 7 16:15 AUTHORS
17142 -rw-r--r-- 1 36K Jun 1 2011 COPYING
17143 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jan 7 15:15 ChangeLog
17145 # Second field (size) will be shown in IEC representation
17146 $ df --block-size=1 | numfmt --field 2 --header --to=iec | head -n4
17147 File system 1B-blocks Used Available Use% Mounted on
17148 rootfs 132G 104741408 26554036 80% /
17149 tmpfs 794M 7580 804960 1% /run/shm
17150 /dev/sdb1 694G 651424756 46074696 94% /home
17154 Output can be tweaked using @option{--padding} or @option{--format}:
17157 # Pad to 10 characters, right-aligned
17158 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding=10
17164 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned
17165 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding=-10
17171 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned, using 'format'
17172 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --format="%10f"
17178 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned, using 'format'
17179 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding="%-10f"
17186 With locales that support grouping digits, using @option{--grouping} or
17187 @option{--format} enables grouping. In @samp{POSIX} locale, grouping is
17191 $ LC_ALL=C numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
17194 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
17197 $ LC_ALL=ta_IN numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
17200 $ LC_ALL=C ./src/numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
17203 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 ./src/numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
17206 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 ./src/numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'-15f==" 2G
17209 $ LC_ALL=ta_IN ./src/numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
17210 == 2,14,74,83,648==
17214 @node seq invocation
17215 @section @command{seq}: Print numeric sequences
17218 @cindex numeric sequences
17219 @cindex sequence of numbers
17221 @command{seq} prints a sequence of numbers to standard output. Synopses:
17224 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{last}
17225 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{last}
17226 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{increment} @var{last}
17229 @command{seq} prints the numbers from @var{first} to @var{last} by
17230 @var{increment}. By default, each number is printed on a separate line.
17231 When @var{increment} is not specified, it defaults to @samp{1},
17232 even when @var{first} is larger than @var{last}.
17233 @var{first} also defaults to @samp{1}. So @code{seq 1} prints
17234 @samp{1}, but @code{seq 0} and @code{seq 10 5} produce no output.
17235 The sequence of numbers ends when the sum of the current number and
17236 @var{increment} would become greater than @var{last},
17237 so @code{seq 1 10 10} only produces @samp{1}.
17238 Floating-point numbers may be specified. @xref{Floating point}.
17240 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17241 Options must precede operands.
17244 @item -f @var{format}
17245 @itemx --format=@var{format}
17246 @opindex -f @var{format}
17247 @opindex --format=@var{format}
17248 @cindex formatting of numbers in @command{seq}
17249 Print all numbers using @var{format}.
17250 @var{format} must contain exactly one of the @samp{printf}-style
17251 floating point conversion specifications @samp{%a}, @samp{%e},
17252 @samp{%f}, @samp{%g}, @samp{%A}, @samp{%E}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}@.
17253 The @samp{%} may be followed by zero or more flags taken from the set
17254 @samp{-+#0 '}, then an optional width containing one or more digits,
17255 then an optional precision consisting of a @samp{.} followed by zero
17256 or more digits. @var{format} may also contain any number of @samp{%%}
17257 conversion specifications. All conversion specifications have the
17258 same meaning as with @samp{printf}.
17260 The default format is derived from @var{first}, @var{step}, and
17261 @var{last}. If these all use a fixed point decimal representation,
17262 the default format is @samp{%.@var{p}f}, where @var{p} is the minimum
17263 precision that can represent the output numbers exactly. Otherwise,
17264 the default format is @samp{%g}.
17266 @item -s @var{string}
17267 @itemx --separator=@var{string}
17268 @cindex separator for numbers in @command{seq}
17269 Separate numbers with @var{string}; default is a newline.
17270 The output always terminates with a newline.
17273 @itemx --equal-width
17274 Print all numbers with the same width, by padding with leading zeros.
17275 @var{first}, @var{step}, and @var{last} should all use a fixed point
17276 decimal representation.
17277 (To have other kinds of padding, use @option{--format}).
17281 You can get finer-grained control over output with @option{-f}:
17284 $ seq -f '(%9.2E)' -9e5 1.1e6 1.3e6
17290 If you want hexadecimal integer output, you can use @command{printf}
17291 to perform the conversion:
17294 $ printf '%x\n' $(seq 1048575 1024 1050623)
17300 For very long lists of numbers, use xargs to avoid
17301 system limitations on the length of an argument list:
17304 $ seq 1000000 | xargs printf '%x\n' | tail -n 3
17310 To generate octal output, use the printf @code{%o} format instead
17313 On most systems, seq can produce whole-number output for values up to
17314 at least @math{2^{53}}. Larger integers are approximated. The details
17315 differ depending on your floating-point implementation.
17316 @xref{Floating point}. A common
17317 case is that @command{seq} works with integers through @math{2^{64}},
17318 and larger integers may not be numerically correct:
17321 $ seq 50000000000000000000 2 50000000000000000004
17322 50000000000000000000
17323 50000000000000000000
17324 50000000000000000004
17327 However, note that when limited to non-negative whole numbers,
17328 an increment of 1 and no format-specifying option, seq can print
17329 arbitrarily large numbers.
17331 Be careful when using @command{seq} with outlandish values: otherwise
17332 you may see surprising results, as @command{seq} uses floating point
17333 internally. For example, on the x86 platform, where the internal
17334 representation uses a 64-bit fraction, the command:
17337 seq 1 0.0000000000000000001 1.0000000000000000009
17340 outputs 1.0000000000000000007 twice and skips 1.0000000000000000008.
17345 @node File permissions
17346 @chapter File permissions
17349 @include parse-datetime.texi
17353 @node Opening the software toolbox
17354 @chapter Opening the Software Toolbox
17356 An earlier version of this chapter appeared in
17357 @uref{http://www.linuxjournal.com/article.php?sid=2762, the
17358 @cite{What's GNU@?} column of the June 1994 @cite{Linux Journal}}.
17359 It was written by Arnold Robbins.
17362 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
17363 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
17364 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
17365 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
17366 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
17367 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
17368 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
17372 @node Toolbox introduction
17373 @unnumberedsec Toolbox Introduction
17375 This month's column is only peripherally related to the GNU Project, in
17376 that it describes a number of the GNU tools on your GNU/Linux system
17378 might be used. What it's really about is the ``Software Tools'' philosophy
17379 of program development and usage.
17381 The software tools philosophy was an important and integral concept
17382 in the initial design and development of Unix (of which Linux and GNU are
17383 essentially clones). Unfortunately, in the modern day press of
17384 Internetworking and flashy GUIs, it seems to have fallen by the
17385 wayside. This is a shame, since it provides a powerful mental model
17386 for solving many kinds of problems.
17388 Many people carry a Swiss Army knife around in their pants pockets (or
17389 purse). A Swiss Army knife is a handy tool to have: it has several knife
17390 blades, a screwdriver, tweezers, toothpick, nail file, corkscrew, and perhaps
17391 a number of other things on it. For the everyday, small miscellaneous jobs
17392 where you need a simple, general purpose tool, it's just the thing.
17394 On the other hand, an experienced carpenter doesn't build a house using
17395 a Swiss Army knife. Instead, he has a toolbox chock full of specialized
17396 tools---a saw, a hammer, a screwdriver, a plane, and so on. And he knows
17397 exactly when and where to use each tool; you won't catch him hammering nails
17398 with the handle of his screwdriver.
17400 The Unix developers at Bell Labs were all professional programmers and trained
17401 computer scientists. They had found that while a one-size-fits-all program
17402 might appeal to a user because there's only one program to use, in practice
17407 difficult to write,
17410 difficult to maintain and
17414 difficult to extend to meet new situations.
17417 Instead, they felt that programs should be specialized tools. In short, each
17418 program ``should do one thing well.'' No more and no less. Such programs are
17419 simpler to design, write, and get right---they only do one thing.
17421 Furthermore, they found that with the right machinery for hooking programs
17422 together, that the whole was greater than the sum of the parts. By combining
17423 several special purpose programs, you could accomplish a specific task
17424 that none of the programs was designed for, and accomplish it much more
17425 quickly and easily than if you had to write a special purpose program.
17426 We will see some (classic) examples of this further on in the column.
17427 (An important additional point was that, if necessary, take a detour
17428 and build any software tools you may need first, if you don't already
17429 have something appropriate in the toolbox.)
17431 @node I/O redirection
17432 @unnumberedsec I/O Redirection
17434 Hopefully, you are familiar with the basics of I/O redirection in the
17435 shell, in particular the concepts of ``standard input,'' ``standard output,''
17436 and ``standard error''. Briefly, ``standard input'' is a data source, where
17437 data comes from. A program should not need to either know or care if the
17438 data source is a disk file, a keyboard, a magnetic tape, or even a punched
17439 card reader. Similarly, ``standard output'' is a data sink, where data goes
17440 to. The program should neither know nor care where this might be.
17441 Programs that only read their standard input, do something to the data,
17442 and then send it on, are called @dfn{filters}, by analogy to filters in a
17445 With the Unix shell, it's very easy to set up data pipelines:
17448 program_to_create_data | filter1 | ... | filterN > final.pretty.data
17451 We start out by creating the raw data; each filter applies some successive
17452 transformation to the data, until by the time it comes out of the pipeline,
17453 it is in the desired form.
17455 This is fine and good for standard input and standard output. Where does the
17456 standard error come in to play? Well, think about @command{filter1} in
17457 the pipeline above. What happens if it encounters an error in the data it
17458 sees? If it writes an error message to standard output, it will just
17459 disappear down the pipeline into @command{filter2}'s input, and the
17460 user will probably never see it. So programs need a place where they can send
17461 error messages so that the user will notice them. This is standard error,
17462 and it is usually connected to your console or window, even if you have
17463 redirected standard output of your program away from your screen.
17465 For filter programs to work together, the format of the data has to be
17466 agreed upon. The most straightforward and easiest format to use is simply
17467 lines of text. Unix data files are generally just streams of bytes, with
17468 lines delimited by the ASCII LF (Line Feed) character,
17469 conventionally called a ``newline'' in the Unix literature. (This is
17470 @code{'\n'} if you're a C programmer.) This is the format used by all
17471 the traditional filtering programs. (Many earlier operating systems
17472 had elaborate facilities and special purpose programs for managing
17473 binary data. Unix has always shied away from such things, under the
17474 philosophy that it's easiest to simply be able to view and edit your
17475 data with a text editor.)
17477 OK, enough introduction. Let's take a look at some of the tools, and then
17478 we'll see how to hook them together in interesting ways. In the following
17479 discussion, we will only present those command line options that interest
17480 us. As you should always do, double check your system documentation
17481 for the full story.
17483 @node The who command
17484 @unnumberedsec The @command{who} Command
17486 The first program is the @command{who} command. By itself, it generates a
17487 list of the users who are currently logged in. Although I'm writing
17488 this on a single-user system, we'll pretend that several people are
17493 @print{} arnold console Jan 22 19:57
17494 @print{} miriam ttyp0 Jan 23 14:19(:0.0)
17495 @print{} bill ttyp1 Jan 21 09:32(:0.0)
17496 @print{} arnold ttyp2 Jan 23 20:48(:0.0)
17499 Here, the @samp{$} is the usual shell prompt, at which I typed @samp{who}.
17500 There are three people logged in, and I am logged in twice. On traditional
17501 Unix systems, user names are never more than eight characters long. This
17502 little bit of trivia will be useful later. The output of @command{who} is nice,
17503 but the data is not all that exciting.
17505 @node The cut command
17506 @unnumberedsec The @command{cut} Command
17508 The next program we'll look at is the @command{cut} command. This program
17509 cuts out columns or fields of input data. For example, we can tell it
17510 to print just the login name and full name from the @file{/etc/passwd}
17511 file. The @file{/etc/passwd} file has seven fields, separated by
17515 arnold:xyzzy:2076:10:Arnold D. Robbins:/home/arnold:/bin/bash
17518 To get the first and fifth fields, we would use @command{cut} like this:
17521 $ cut -d: -f1,5 /etc/passwd
17522 @print{} root:Operator
17524 @print{} arnold:Arnold D. Robbins
17525 @print{} miriam:Miriam A. Robbins
17529 With the @option{-c} option, @command{cut} will cut out specific characters
17530 (i.e., columns) in the input lines. This is useful for input data
17531 that has fixed width fields, and does not have a field separator. For
17532 example, list the Monday dates for the current month:
17534 @c Is using cal ok? Looked at gcal, but I don't like it.
17545 @node The sort command
17546 @unnumberedsec The @command{sort} Command
17548 Next we'll look at the @command{sort} command. This is one of the most
17549 powerful commands on a Unix-style system; one that you will often find
17550 yourself using when setting up fancy data plumbing.
17553 command reads and sorts each file named on the command line. It then
17554 merges the sorted data and writes it to standard output. It will read
17555 standard input if no files are given on the command line (thus
17556 making it into a filter). The sort is based on the character collating
17557 sequence or based on user-supplied ordering criteria.
17560 @node The uniq command
17561 @unnumberedsec The @command{uniq} Command
17563 Finally (at least for now), we'll look at the @command{uniq} program. When
17564 sorting data, you will often end up with duplicate lines, lines that
17565 are identical. Usually, all you need is one instance of each line.
17566 This is where @command{uniq} comes in. The @command{uniq} program reads its
17567 standard input. It prints only one
17568 copy of each repeated line. It does have several options. Later on,
17569 we'll use the @option{-c} option, which prints each unique line, preceded
17570 by a count of the number of times that line occurred in the input.
17573 @node Putting the tools together
17574 @unnumberedsec Putting the Tools Together
17576 Now, let's suppose this is a large ISP server system with dozens of users
17577 logged in. The management wants the system administrator to write a
17579 generate a sorted list of logged in users. Furthermore, even if a user
17580 is logged in multiple times, his or her name should only show up in the
17583 The administrator could sit down with the system documentation and write a C
17584 program that did this. It would take perhaps a couple of hundred lines
17585 of code and about two hours to write it, test it, and debug it.
17586 However, knowing the software toolbox, the administrator can instead start out
17587 by generating just a list of logged on users:
17597 Next, sort the list:
17600 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort
17607 Finally, run the sorted list through @command{uniq}, to weed out duplicates:
17610 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
17616 The @command{sort} command actually has a @option{-u} option that does what
17617 @command{uniq} does. However, @command{uniq} has other uses for which one
17618 cannot substitute @samp{sort -u}.
17620 The administrator puts this pipeline into a shell script, and makes it
17622 all the users on the system (@samp{#} is the system administrator,
17623 or @code{root}, prompt):
17626 # cat > /usr/local/bin/listusers
17627 who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
17629 # chmod +x /usr/local/bin/listusers
17632 There are four major points to note here. First, with just four
17633 programs, on one command line, the administrator was able to save about two
17634 hours worth of work. Furthermore, the shell pipeline is just about as
17635 efficient as the C program would be, and it is much more efficient in
17636 terms of programmer time. People time is much more expensive than
17637 computer time, and in our modern ``there's never enough time to do
17638 everything'' society, saving two hours of programmer time is no mean
17641 Second, it is also important to emphasize that with the
17642 @emph{combination} of the tools, it is possible to do a special
17643 purpose job never imagined by the authors of the individual programs.
17645 Third, it is also valuable to build up your pipeline in stages, as we did here.
17646 This allows you to view the data at each stage in the pipeline, which helps
17647 you acquire the confidence that you are indeed using these tools correctly.
17649 Finally, by bundling the pipeline in a shell script, other users can use
17650 your command, without having to remember the fancy plumbing you set up for
17651 them. In terms of how you run them, shell scripts and compiled programs are
17654 After the previous warm-up exercise, we'll look at two additional, more
17655 complicated pipelines. For them, we need to introduce two more tools.
17657 The first is the @command{tr} command, which stands for ``transliterate.''
17658 The @command{tr} command works on a character-by-character basis, changing
17659 characters. Normally it is used for things like mapping upper case to
17663 $ echo ThIs ExAmPlE HaS MIXED case! | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]'
17664 @print{} this example has mixed case!
17667 There are several options of interest:
17671 work on the complement of the listed characters, i.e.,
17672 operations apply to characters not in the given set
17675 delete characters in the first set from the output
17678 squeeze repeated characters in the output into just one character.
17681 We will be using all three options in a moment.
17683 The other command we'll look at is @command{comm}. The @command{comm}
17684 command takes two sorted input files as input data, and prints out the
17685 files' lines in three columns. The output columns are the data lines
17686 unique to the first file, the data lines unique to the second file, and
17687 the data lines that are common to both. The @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and
17688 @option{-3} command line options @emph{omit} the respective columns. (This is
17689 non-intuitive and takes a little getting used to.) For example:
17711 The file name @file{-} tells @command{comm} to read standard input
17712 instead of a regular file.
17714 Now we're ready to build a fancy pipeline. The first application is a word
17715 frequency counter. This helps an author determine if he or she is over-using
17718 The first step is to change the case of all the letters in our input file
17719 to one case. ``The'' and ``the'' are the same word when doing counting.
17722 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | ...
17725 The next step is to get rid of punctuation. Quoted words and unquoted words
17726 should be treated identically; it's easiest to just get the punctuation out of
17730 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' | ...
17733 The second @command{tr} command operates on the complement of the listed
17734 characters, which are all the letters, the digits, the underscore, and
17735 the blank. The @samp{\n} represents the newline character; it has to
17736 be left alone. (The ASCII tab character should also be included for
17737 good measure in a production script.)
17739 At this point, we have data consisting of words separated by blank space.
17740 The words only contain alphanumeric characters (and the underscore). The
17741 next step is break the data apart so that we have one word per line. This
17742 makes the counting operation much easier, as we will see shortly.
17745 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
17746 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | ...
17749 This command turns blanks into newlines. The @option{-s} option squeezes
17750 multiple newline characters in the output into just one. This helps us
17751 avoid blank lines. (The @samp{>} is the shell's ``secondary prompt.''
17752 This is what the shell prints when it notices you haven't finished
17753 typing in all of a command.)
17755 We now have data consisting of one word per line, no punctuation, all one
17756 case. We're ready to count each word:
17759 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
17760 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | ...
17763 At this point, the data might look something like this:
17776 The output is sorted by word, not by count! What we want is the most
17777 frequently used words first. Fortunately, this is easy to accomplish,
17778 with the help of two more @command{sort} options:
17782 do a numeric sort, not a textual one
17785 reverse the order of the sort
17788 The final pipeline looks like this:
17791 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
17792 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | sort -n -r
17801 Whew! That's a lot to digest. Yet, the same principles apply. With six
17802 commands, on two lines (really one long one split for convenience), we've
17803 created a program that does something interesting and useful, in much
17804 less time than we could have written a C program to do the same thing.
17806 A minor modification to the above pipeline can give us a simple spelling
17807 checker! To determine if you've spelled a word correctly, all you have to
17808 do is look it up in a dictionary. If it is not there, then chances are
17809 that your spelling is incorrect. So, we need a dictionary.
17810 The conventional location for a dictionary is @file{/usr/dict/words}.
17811 On my GNU/Linux system,@footnote{Redhat Linux 6.1, for the November 2000
17812 revision of this article.}
17813 this is a sorted, 45,402 word dictionary.
17815 Now, how to compare our file with the dictionary? As before, we generate
17816 a sorted list of words, one per line:
17819 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
17820 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u | ...
17823 Now, all we need is a list of words that are @emph{not} in the
17824 dictionary. Here is where the @command{comm} command comes in.
17827 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
17828 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u |
17829 > comm -23 - /usr/dict/words
17832 The @option{-2} and @option{-3} options eliminate lines that are only in the
17833 dictionary (the second file), and lines that are in both files. Lines
17834 only in the first file (standard input, our stream of words), are
17835 words that are not in the dictionary. These are likely candidates for
17836 spelling errors. This pipeline was the first cut at a production
17837 spelling checker on Unix.
17839 There are some other tools that deserve brief mention.
17843 search files for text that matches a regular expression
17846 count lines, words, characters
17849 a T-fitting for data pipes, copies data to files and to standard output
17852 the stream editor, an advanced tool
17855 a data manipulation language, another advanced tool
17858 The software tools philosophy also espoused the following bit of
17859 advice: ``Let someone else do the hard part.'' This means, take
17860 something that gives you most of what you need, and then massage it the
17861 rest of the way until it's in the form that you want.
17867 Each program should do one thing well. No more, no less.
17870 Combining programs with appropriate plumbing leads to results where
17871 the whole is greater than the sum of the parts. It also leads to novel
17872 uses of programs that the authors might never have imagined.
17875 Programs should never print extraneous header or trailer data, since these
17876 could get sent on down a pipeline. (A point we didn't mention earlier.)
17879 Let someone else do the hard part.
17882 Know your toolbox! Use each program appropriately. If you don't have an
17883 appropriate tool, build one.
17886 As of this writing, all the programs discussed are available from
17887 @uref{http://ftp.gnu.org/old-gnu/textutils/textutils-1.22.tar.gz},
17888 with more recent versions available from
17889 @uref{http://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/coreutils}.
17891 None of what I have presented in this column is new. The Software Tools
17892 philosophy was first introduced in the book @cite{Software Tools}, by
17893 Brian Kernighan and P.J. Plauger (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-03669-X).
17894 This book showed how to write and use software tools. It was written in
17895 1976, using a preprocessor for FORTRAN named @command{ratfor} (RATional
17896 FORtran). At the time, C was not as ubiquitous as it is now; FORTRAN
17897 was. The last chapter presented a @command{ratfor} to FORTRAN
17898 processor, written in @command{ratfor}. @command{ratfor} looks an awful
17899 lot like C; if you know C, you won't have any problem following the
17902 In 1981, the book was updated and made available as @cite{Software Tools
17903 in Pascal} (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-10342-7). Both books are
17904 still in print and are well worth
17905 reading if you're a programmer. They certainly made a major change in
17906 how I view programming.
17908 The programs in both books are available from
17909 @uref{http://cm.bell-labs.com/who/bwk, Brian Kernighan's home page}.
17910 For a number of years, there was an active
17911 Software Tools Users Group, whose members had ported the original
17912 @command{ratfor} programs to essentially every computer system with a
17913 FORTRAN compiler. The popularity of the group waned in the middle 1980s
17914 as Unix began to spread beyond universities.
17916 With the current proliferation of GNU code and other clones of Unix programs,
17917 these programs now receive little attention; modern C versions are
17918 much more efficient and do more than these programs do. Nevertheless, as
17919 exposition of good programming style, and evangelism for a still-valuable
17920 philosophy, these books are unparalleled, and I recommend them highly.
17922 Acknowledgment: I would like to express my gratitude to Brian Kernighan
17923 of Bell Labs, the original Software Toolsmith, for reviewing this column.
17925 @node GNU Free Documentation License
17926 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
17930 @node Concept index
17937 @c Local variables:
17938 @c texinfo-column-for-description: 32